OpenCores
URL https://opencores.org/ocsvn/or1k/or1k/trunk

Subversion Repositories or1k

[/] [or1k/] [trunk/] [insight/] [gdb/] [doc/] [gdb.texinfo] - Blame information for rev 1774

Go to most recent revision | Details | Compare with Previous | View Log

Line No. Rev Author Line
1 578 markom
\input texinfo      @c -*-texinfo-*-
2
@c Copyright 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1998,
3
@c 1999, 2000, 2001
4
@c Free Software Foundation, Inc.
5
@c
6
@c %**start of header
7
@c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
8
@c of @set vars.  However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
9
@setfilename gdb.info
10
@c
11
@include gdb-cfg.texi
12
@c
13
@settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
14
@setchapternewpage odd
15
@c %**end of header
16
 
17
@iftex
18
@c @smallbook
19
@c @cropmarks
20
@end iftex
21
 
22
@finalout
23
@syncodeindex ky cp
24
 
25
@c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable,
26
@c annotate.texi and gdbmi use @findex.
27
@syncodeindex vr cp
28
@syncodeindex fn cp
29
 
30
@c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
31
@set EDITION Ninth
32
 
33
@c !!set GDB manual's revision date
34
@set DATE April 2001
35
 
36
@c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 3.12 OR LATER.
37
 
38
@c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
39
@c manuals to an info tree.
40
@dircategory Programming & development tools.
41
@direntry
42
* Gdb: (gdb).                     The @sc{gnu} debugger.
43
@end direntry
44
 
45
@ifinfo
46
This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
47
 
48
 
49
This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, @value{DATE},
50
of @cite{Debugging with @value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger}
51
for @value{GDBN} Version @value{GDBVN}.
52
 
53
Copyright (C) 1988,1989,1990,1991,1992,1993,1994,1995,1996,1998,1999,2000,2001
54
   Free Software Foundation, Inc.
55
 
56
Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
57
under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
58
any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
59
Invariant Sections being ``A Sample GDB Session'' and ``Free
60
Software'', with the Front-Cover texts being ``A GNU Manual,'' and
61
with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
62
 
63
(a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have freedom to copy and modify
64
this GNU Manual, like GNU software.  Copies published by the Free
65
Software Foundation raise funds for GNU development.''
66
@end ifinfo
67
 
68
@titlepage
69
@title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
70
@subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
71
@sp 1
72
@subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
73
@subtitle @value{DATE}
74
@author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et al.
75
@page
76
@tex
77
{\parskip=0pt
78
\hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to bug-gdb\@gnu.org.)\par
79
\hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
80
\hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
81
}
82
@end tex
83
 
84
@vskip 0pt plus 1filll
85
Copyright @copyright{} 1988,1989,1990,1991,1992,1993,1994,1995,1996,1998,1999,2000,2001
86
   Free Software Foundation, Inc.
87
@sp 2
88
Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
89
59 Temple Place - Suite 330, @*
90
Boston, MA 02111-1307 USA @*
91
ISBN 1-882114-77-9 @*
92
 
93
Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
94
under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
95
any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
96
Invariant Sections being ``A Sample GDB Session'' and ``Free
97
Software'', with the Front-Cover texts being ``A GNU Manual,'' and
98
with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
99
 
100
(a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have freedom to copy and modify
101
this GNU Manual, like GNU software.  Copies published by the Free
102
Software Foundation raise funds for GNU development.''
103
@end titlepage
104
@page
105
 
106
@ifinfo
107
@node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir)
108
 
109
@top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
110
 
111
This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
112
 
113
This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, @value{DATE}, for @value{GDBN} Version
114
@value{GDBVN}.
115
 
116
Copyright (C) 1988-2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
117
 
118
@menu
119
* Summary::                     Summary of @value{GDBN}
120
* Sample Session::              A sample @value{GDBN} session
121
 
122
* Invocation::                  Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
123
* Commands::                    @value{GDBN} commands
124
* Running::                     Running programs under @value{GDBN}
125
* Stopping::                    Stopping and continuing
126
* Stack::                       Examining the stack
127
* Source::                      Examining source files
128
* Data::                        Examining data
129
* Tracepoints::                 Debugging remote targets non-intrusively
130
 
131
* Languages::                   Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
132
 
133
* Symbols::                     Examining the symbol table
134
* Altering::                    Altering execution
135
* GDB Files::                   @value{GDBN} files
136
* Targets::                     Specifying a debugging target
137
* Configurations::              Configuration-specific information
138
* Controlling GDB::             Controlling @value{GDBN}
139
* Sequences::                   Canned sequences of commands
140
* Emacs::                       Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
141
* Annotations::                 @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
142
* GDB/MI::                      @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
143
 
144
* GDB Bugs::                    Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
145
* Formatting Documentation::    How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
146
 
147
* Command Line Editing::        Command Line Editing
148
* Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
149
* Installing GDB::              Installing GDB
150
* Index::                       Index
151
@end menu
152
 
153
@end ifinfo
154
 
155
@c the replication sucks, but this avoids a texinfo 3.12 lameness
156
 
157
@ifhtml
158
@node Top
159
 
160
@top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
161
 
162
This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
163
 
164
This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, @value{DATE}, for @value{GDBN} Version
165
@value{GDBVN}.
166
 
167
Copyright (C) 1988-2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
168
 
169
@menu
170
* Summary::                     Summary of @value{GDBN}
171
* Sample Session::              A sample @value{GDBN} session
172
 
173
* Invocation::                  Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
174
* Commands::                    @value{GDBN} commands
175
* Running::                     Running programs under @value{GDBN}
176
* Stopping::                    Stopping and continuing
177
* Stack::                       Examining the stack
178
* Source::                      Examining source files
179
* Data::                        Examining data
180
 
181
* Languages::                   Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
182
 
183
* Symbols::                     Examining the symbol table
184
* Altering::                    Altering execution
185
* GDB Files::                   @value{GDBN} files
186
* Targets::                     Specifying a debugging target
187
* Configurations::              Configuration-specific information
188
* Controlling GDB::             Controlling @value{GDBN}
189
* Sequences::                   Canned sequences of commands
190
* Emacs::                       Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
191
* Annotations::                 @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
192
 
193
* GDB Bugs::                    Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
194
* Formatting Documentation::    How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
195
 
196
* Command Line Editing::        Command Line Editing
197
* Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
198
* Installing GDB::              Installing GDB
199
* Index::                       Index
200
@end menu
201
 
202
@end ifhtml
203
 
204
@c TeX can handle the contents at the start but makeinfo 3.12 can not
205
@iftex
206
@contents
207
@end iftex
208
 
209
@node Summary
210
@unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
211
 
212
The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
213
going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
214
program was doing at the moment it crashed.
215
 
216
@value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
217
these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
218
 
219
@itemize @bullet
220
@item
221
Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
222
 
223
@item
224
Make your program stop on specified conditions.
225
 
226
@item
227
Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
228
 
229
@item
230
Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
231
effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
232
@end itemize
233
 
234
You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C++.
235
For more information, see @ref{Support,,Supported languages}.
236
For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
237
 
238
@cindex Chill
239
@cindex Modula-2
240
Support for Modula-2 and Chill is partial.  For information on Modula-2,
241
see @ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}.  For information on Chill, see @ref{Chill}.
242
 
243
@cindex Pascal
244
Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
245
nested functions does not currently work.  @value{GDBN} does not support
246
entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
247
syntax.
248
 
249
@cindex Fortran
250
@value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
251
it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
252
underscore.
253
 
254
@menu
255
* Free Software::               Freely redistributable software
256
* Contributors::                Contributors to GDB
257
@end menu
258
 
259
@node Free Software
260
@unnumberedsec Free software
261
 
262
@value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
263
General Public License
264
(GPL).  The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
265
program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
266
freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
267
the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
268
Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
269
Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
270
 
271
Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
272
you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
273
from anyone else.
274
 
275
@node Contributors
276
@unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN}
277
 
278
Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many
279
other @sc{gnu} programs.  Many others have contributed to its
280
development.  This section attempts to credit major contributors.  One
281
of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute
282
to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here.  The
283
file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
284
blow-by-blow account.
285
 
286
Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
287
 
288
@quotation
289
@emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome.  If you
290
or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
291
omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
292
@end quotation
293
 
294
So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
295
particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
296
releases:
297
Andrew Cagney (releases 5.0 and 5.1);
298
Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
299
Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
300
Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
301
Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
302
Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
303
John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
304
Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
305
and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
306
 
307
Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
308
Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
309
 
310
Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} support
311
in @value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per
312
Bothner and Daniel Berlin.  James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
313
demangler.  Early work on C@t{++} was by Peter TerMaat (who also did
314
much general update work leading to release 3.0).
315
 
316
@value{GDBN} uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
317
object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
318
Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
319
 
320
David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
321
the original support for encapsulated COFF.
322
 
323
Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF2 support.
324
 
325
Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
326
Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
327
support.
328
Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
329
Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
330
Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
331
David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
332
Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
333
Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
334
Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
335
Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
336
Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
337
Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
338
Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
339
Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
340
Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
341
Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
342
Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
343
 
344
Andreas Schwab contributed M68K Linux support.
345
 
346
Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
347
libraries.
348
 
349
Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
350
about several machine instruction sets.
351
 
352
Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
353
remote debugging.  Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
354
contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
355
and RDI targets, respectively.
356
 
357
Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
358
command-line editing and command history.
359
 
360
Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
361
Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
362
 
363
Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
364
He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C@t{++} overloaded
365
symbols.
366
 
367
Hitachi America, Ltd. sponsored the support for H8/300, H8/500, and
368
Super-H processors.
369
 
370
NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
371
 
372
Mitsubishi sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D processors.
373
 
374
Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
375
 
376
Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
377
 
378
Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
379
 
380
Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
381
watchpoints.
382
 
383
Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
384
 
385
Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
386
 
387
Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
388
nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}.
389
 
390
The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
391
support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
392
(narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC@t{++}
393
compiler, and the terminal user interface: Ben Krepp, Richard Title,
394
John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann, Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve
395
Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni.  Kim Haase provided HP-specific
396
information in this manual.
397
 
398
DJ Delorie ported @value{GDBN} to MS-DOS, for the DJGPP project.
399
Robert Hoehne made significant contributions to the DJGPP port.
400
 
401
Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its
402
development since 1991.  Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN}
403
fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
404
Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
405
Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
406
Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
407
Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni.  In
408
addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
409
JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
410
Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
411
Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
412
Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
413
Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
414
Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
415
Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
416
 
417
 
418
@node Sample Session
419
@chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
420
 
421
You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
422
However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
423
debugger.  This chapter illustrates those commands.
424
 
425
@iftex
426
In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
427
to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
428
@end iftex
429
 
430
@c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
431
@c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
432
 
433
One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
434
processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
435
quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
436
definition within another stop working.  In the following short @code{m4}
437
session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
438
then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
439
same thing.  However, when we change the open quote string to
440
@code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
441
procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
442
 
443
@smallexample
444
$ @b{cd gnu/m4}
445
$ @b{./m4}
446
@b{define(foo,0000)}
447
 
448
@b{foo}
449
0000
450
@b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
451
 
452
@b{bar}
453
0000
454
@b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
455
 
456
@b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
457
@b{baz}
458
@b{C-d}
459
m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
460
@end smallexample
461
 
462
@noindent
463
Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
464
 
465
@smallexample
466
$ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
467
@c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
468
@c FIXME... format to come out better.
469
@value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
470
 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
471
 the conditions.
472
There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
473
 for details.
474
 
475
@value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
476
(@value{GDBP})
477
@end smallexample
478
 
479
@noindent
480
@value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
481
rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
482
We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
483
that examples fit in this manual.
484
 
485
@smallexample
486
(@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
487
@end smallexample
488
 
489
@noindent
490
We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
491
Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
492
@code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
493
@code{break} command.
494
 
495
@smallexample
496
(@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
497
Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
498
@end smallexample
499
 
500
@noindent
501
Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
502
control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
503
subroutine, the program runs as usual:
504
 
505
@smallexample
506
(@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
507
Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
508
@b{define(foo,0000)}
509
 
510
@b{foo}
511
0000
512
@end smallexample
513
 
514
@noindent
515
To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}.  @value{GDBN}
516
suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
517
context where it stops.
518
 
519
@smallexample
520
@b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
521
 
522
Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
523
    at builtin.c:879
524
879         if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
525
@end smallexample
526
 
527
@noindent
528
Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
529
the next line of the current function.
530
 
531
@smallexample
532
(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
533
882         set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
534
 : nil,
535
@end smallexample
536
 
537
@noindent
538
@code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine.  We can go into it
539
by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
540
@code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
541
subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
542
 
543
@smallexample
544
(@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
545
set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
546
    at input.c:530
547
530         if (lquote != def_lquote)
548
@end smallexample
549
 
550
@noindent
551
The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
552
suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display.  It
553
shows a summary of the stack.  We can use the @code{backtrace}
554
command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
555
in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
556
stack frame for each active subroutine.
557
 
558
@smallexample
559
(@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
560
#0  set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
561
    at input.c:530
562
#1  0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
563
    at builtin.c:882
564
#2  0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
565
#3  0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
566
    at macro.c:71
567
#4  0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
568
#5  0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
569
@end smallexample
570
 
571
@noindent
572
We step through a few more lines to see what happens.  The first two
573
times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
574
falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
575
 
576
@smallexample
577
(@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
578
0x3b5c  532         if (rquote != def_rquote)
579
(@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
580
0x3b80  535         lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ?  \
581
def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
582
(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
583
536         rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
584
 : xstrdup(rq);
585
(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
586
538         len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
587
@end smallexample
588
 
589
@noindent
590
The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
591
@code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
592
and right quotes we specified.  We use the command @code{p}
593
(@code{print}) to see their values.
594
 
595
@smallexample
596
(@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
597
$1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
598
(@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
599
$2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
600
@end smallexample
601
 
602
@noindent
603
@code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
604
To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
605
surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
606
 
607
@smallexample
608
(@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
609
533             xfree(rquote);
610
534
611
535         lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
612
 : xstrdup (lq);
613
536         rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
614
 : xstrdup (rq);
615
537
616
538         len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
617
539         len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
618
540     @}
619
541
620
542     void
621
@end smallexample
622
 
623
@noindent
624
Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
625
@code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
626
 
627
@smallexample
628
(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
629
539         len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
630
(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
631
540     @}
632
(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
633
$3 = 9
634
(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
635
$4 = 7
636
@end smallexample
637
 
638
@noindent
639
That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
640
@code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
641
@code{rquote} respectively.  We can set them to better values using
642
the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
643
any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
644
assignments.
645
 
646
@smallexample
647
(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
648
$5 = 7
649
(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
650
$6 = 9
651
@end smallexample
652
 
653
@noindent
654
Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
655
@code{m4} built-in @code{defn}?  We can allow @code{m4} to continue
656
executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
657
example that caused trouble initially:
658
 
659
@smallexample
660
(@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
661
Continuing.
662
 
663
@b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
664
 
665
baz
666
0000
667
@end smallexample
668
 
669
@noindent
670
Success!  The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones.  The
671
problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
672
lengths.  We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
673
 
674
@smallexample
675
@b{C-d}
676
Program exited normally.
677
@end smallexample
678
 
679
@noindent
680
The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
681
indicates @code{m4} has finished executing.  We can end our @value{GDBN}
682
session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
683
 
684
@smallexample
685
(@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
686
@end smallexample
687
 
688
@node Invocation
689
@chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
690
 
691
This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
692
The essentials are:
693
@itemize @bullet
694
@item
695
type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
696
@item
697
type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{C-d} to exit.
698
@end itemize
699
 
700
@menu
701
* Invoking GDB::                How to start @value{GDBN}
702
* Quitting GDB::                How to quit @value{GDBN}
703
* Shell Commands::              How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
704
@end menu
705
 
706
@node Invoking GDB
707
@section Invoking @value{GDBN}
708
 
709
Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}.  Once started,
710
@value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
711
 
712
You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
713
to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
714
 
715
The command-line options described here are designed
716
to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
717
options may effectively be unavailable.
718
 
719
The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
720
specifying an executable program:
721
 
722
@example
723
@value{GDBP} @var{program}
724
@end example
725
 
726
@noindent
727
You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
728
specified:
729
 
730
@example
731
@value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
732
@end example
733
 
734
You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
735
to debug a running process:
736
 
737
@example
738
@value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
739
@end example
740
 
741
@noindent
742
would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
743
named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
744
 
745
Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
746
complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
747
debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
748
``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump.  @value{GDBN}
749
will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
750
 
751
You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes
752
@value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{-silent}:
753
 
754
@smallexample
755
@value{GDBP} -silent
756
@end smallexample
757
 
758
@noindent
759
You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
760
options.  @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
761
 
762
@noindent
763
Type
764
 
765
@example
766
@value{GDBP} -help
767
@end example
768
 
769
@noindent
770
to display all available options and briefly describe their use
771
(@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
772
 
773
All options and command line arguments you give are processed
774
in sequential order.  The order makes a difference when the
775
@samp{-x} option is used.
776
 
777
 
778
@menu
779
* File Options::                Choosing files
780
* Mode Options::                Choosing modes
781
@end menu
782
 
783
@node File Options
784
@subsection Choosing files
785
 
786
When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
787
specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID).  This is
788
the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
789
@samp{-c} options respectively.  (@value{GDBN} reads the first argument
790
that does not have an associated option flag as equivalent to the
791
@samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the second argument
792
that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as equivalent to
793
the @samp{-c} option followed by that argument.)
794
 
795
If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
796
such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
797
argument and ignore it.
798
 
799
Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
800
following list.  @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
801
them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
802
(If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
803
than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
804
 
805
@c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE.  This
806
@c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
807
@c it.
808
 
809
@table @code
810
@item -symbols @var{file}
811
@itemx -s @var{file}
812
@cindex @code{--symbols}
813
@cindex @code{-s}
814
Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
815
 
816
@item -exec @var{file}
817
@itemx -e @var{file}
818
@cindex @code{--exec}
819
@cindex @code{-e}
820
Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
821
and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
822
 
823
@item -se @var{file}
824
@cindex @code{--se}
825
Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
826
file.
827
 
828
@item -core @var{file}
829
@itemx -c @var{file}
830
@cindex @code{--core}
831
@cindex @code{-c}
832
Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
833
 
834
@item -c @var{number}
835
Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command
836
(unless there is a file in core-dump format named @var{number}, in which
837
case @samp{-c} specifies that file as a core dump to read).
838
 
839
@item -command @var{file}
840
@itemx -x @var{file}
841
@cindex @code{--command}
842
@cindex @code{-x}
843
Execute @value{GDBN} commands from file @var{file}.  @xref{Command
844
Files,, Command files}.
845
 
846
@item -directory @var{directory}
847
@itemx -d @var{directory}
848
@cindex @code{--directory}
849
@cindex @code{-d}
850
Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source files.
851
 
852
@item -m
853
@itemx -mapped
854
@cindex @code{--mapped}
855
@cindex @code{-m}
856
@emph{Warning: this option depends on operating system facilities that are not
857
supported on all systems.}@*
858
If memory-mapped files are available on your system through the @code{mmap}
859
system call, you can use this option
860
to have @value{GDBN} write the symbols from your
861
program into a reusable file in the current directory.  If the program you are debugging is
862
called @file{/tmp/fred}, the mapped symbol file is @file{/tmp/fred.syms}.
863
Future @value{GDBN} debugging sessions notice the presence of this file,
864
and can quickly map in symbol information from it, rather than reading
865
the symbol table from the executable program.
866
 
867
The @file{.syms} file is specific to the host machine where @value{GDBN}
868
is run.  It holds an exact image of the internal @value{GDBN} symbol
869
table.  It cannot be shared across multiple host platforms.
870
 
871
@item -r
872
@itemx -readnow
873
@cindex @code{--readnow}
874
@cindex @code{-r}
875
Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
876
the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
877
This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
878
 
879
@end table
880
 
881
You typically combine the @code{-mapped} and @code{-readnow} options in
882
order to build a @file{.syms} file that contains complete symbol
883
information.  (@xref{Files,,Commands to specify files}, for information
884
on @file{.syms} files.)  A simple @value{GDBN} invocation to do nothing
885
but build a @file{.syms} file for future use is:
886
 
887
@example
888
gdb -batch -nx -mapped -readnow programname
889
@end example
890
 
891
@node Mode Options
892
@subsection Choosing modes
893
 
894
You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
895
batch mode or quiet mode.
896
 
897
@table @code
898
@item -nx
899
@itemx -n
900
@cindex @code{--nx}
901
@cindex @code{-n}
902
Do not execute commands found in any initialization files (normally
903
called @file{.gdbinit}, or @file{gdb.ini} on PCs).  Normally,
904
@value{GDBN} executes the commands in these files after all the command
905
options and arguments have been processed.  @xref{Command Files,,Command
906
files}.
907
 
908
@item -quiet
909
@itemx -silent
910
@itemx -q
911
@cindex @code{--quiet}
912
@cindex @code{--silent}
913
@cindex @code{-q}
914
``Quiet''.  Do not print the introductory and copyright messages.  These
915
messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
916
 
917
@item -batch
918
@cindex @code{--batch}
919
Run in batch mode.  Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
920
command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
921
initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}).  Exit with
922
nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
923
in the command files.
924
 
925
Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
926
example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
927
make this more useful, the message
928
 
929
@example
930
Program exited normally.
931
@end example
932
 
933
@noindent
934
(which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
935
@value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
936
mode.
937
 
938
@item -nowindows
939
@itemx -nw
940
@cindex @code{--nowindows}
941
@cindex @code{-nw}
942
``No windows''.  If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
943
(GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line
944
interface.  If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
945
 
946
@item -windows
947
@itemx -w
948
@cindex @code{--windows}
949
@cindex @code{-w}
950
If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
951
used if possible.
952
 
953
@item -cd @var{directory}
954
@cindex @code{--cd}
955
Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
956
instead of the current directory.
957
 
958
@item -fullname
959
@itemx -f
960
@cindex @code{--fullname}
961
@cindex @code{-f}
962
@sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
963
subprocess.  It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
964
number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
965
displayed (which includes each time your program stops).  This
966
recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
967
the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
968
and a newline.  The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
969
@samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
970
frame.
971
 
972
@item -epoch
973
@cindex @code{--epoch}
974
The Epoch Emacs-@value{GDBN} interface sets this option when it runs
975
@value{GDBN} as a subprocess.  It tells @value{GDBN} to modify its print
976
routines so as to allow Epoch to display values of expressions in a
977
separate window.
978
 
979
@item -annotate @var{level}
980
@cindex @code{--annotate}
981
This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}.  Its
982
effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
983
(@pxref{Annotations}).
984
Annotation level controls how much information does @value{GDBN} print
985
together with its prompt, values of expressions, source lines, and other
986
types of output.  Level 0 is the normal, level 1 is for use when
987
@value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 2 is the
988
maximum annotation suitable for programs that control @value{GDBN}.
989
 
990
@item -async
991
@cindex @code{--async}
992
Use the asynchronous event loop for the command-line interface.
993
@value{GDBN} processes all events, such as user keyboard input, via a
994
special event loop.  This allows @value{GDBN} to accept and process user
995
commands in parallel with the debugged process being
996
run@footnote{@value{GDBN} built with @sc{djgpp} tools for
997
MS-DOS/MS-Windows supports this mode of operation, but the event loop is
998
suspended when the debuggee runs.}, so you don't need to wait for
999
control to return to @value{GDBN} before you type the next command.
1000
(@emph{Note:} as of version 5.1, the target side of the asynchronous
1001
operation is not yet in place, so @samp{-async} does not work fully
1002
yet.)
1003
@c FIXME: when the target side of the event loop is done, the above NOTE
1004
@c should be removed.
1005
 
1006
When the standard input is connected to a terminal device, @value{GDBN}
1007
uses the asynchronous event loop by default, unless disabled by the
1008
@samp{-noasync} option.
1009
 
1010
@item -noasync
1011
@cindex @code{--noasync}
1012
Disable the asynchronous event loop for the command-line interface.
1013
 
1014
@item -baud @var{bps}
1015
@itemx -b @var{bps}
1016
@cindex @code{--baud}
1017
@cindex @code{-b}
1018
Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
1019
interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
1020
 
1021
@item -tty @var{device}
1022
@itemx -t @var{device}
1023
@cindex @code{--tty}
1024
@cindex @code{-t}
1025
Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
1026
@c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty.  Investigate.
1027
 
1028
@c resolve the situation of these eventually
1029
@c @item -tui
1030
@c @cindex @code{--tui}
1031
@c Use a Terminal User Interface.  For information, use your Web browser to
1032
@c read the file @file{TUI.html}, which is usually installed in the
1033
@c directory @code{/opt/langtools/wdb/doc} on HP-UX systems.  Do not use
1034
@c this option if you run @value{GDBN} from Emacs (see @pxref{Emacs, ,Using
1035
@c @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
1036
 
1037
@c @item -xdb
1038
@c @cindex @code{--xdb}
1039
@c Run in XDB compatibility mode, allowing the use of certain XDB commands.
1040
@c For information, see the file @file{xdb_trans.html}, which is usually
1041
@c installed in the directory @code{/opt/langtools/wdb/doc} on HP-UX
1042
@c systems.
1043
 
1044
@item -interpreter @var{interp}
1045
@cindex @code{--interpreter}
1046
Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
1047
program or device.  This option is meant to be set by programs which
1048
communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end.
1049
 
1050
@samp{--interpreter=mi} (or @samp{--interpreter=mi1}) causes
1051
@value{GDBN} to use the @dfn{gdb/mi interface} (@pxref{GDB/MI, , The
1052
@sc{gdb/mi} Interface}). The older @sc{gdb/mi} interface, included in
1053
@value{GDBN} version 5.0 can be selected with @samp{--interpreter=mi0}.
1054
 
1055
@item -write
1056
@cindex @code{--write}
1057
Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing.  This
1058
is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1059
(@pxref{Patching}).
1060
 
1061
@item -statistics
1062
@cindex @code{--statistics}
1063
This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1064
memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1065
 
1066
@item -version
1067
@cindex @code{--version}
1068
This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1069
no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1070
 
1071
@end table
1072
 
1073
@node Quitting GDB
1074
@section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1075
@cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1076
@cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1077
 
1078
@table @code
1079
@kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1080
@kindex q @r{(@code{quit})}
1081
@item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1082
@itemx q
1083
To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated
1084
@code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{C-d}).  If you
1085
do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally;
1086
otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the
1087
error code.
1088
@end table
1089
 
1090
@cindex interrupt
1091
An interrupt (often @kbd{C-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1092
terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1093
returns to @value{GDBN} command level.  It is safe to type the interrupt
1094
character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1095
until a time when it is safe.
1096
 
1097
If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1098
device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1099
(@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an already-running process}).
1100
 
1101
@node Shell Commands
1102
@section Shell commands
1103
 
1104
If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1105
debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1106
just use the @code{shell} command.
1107
 
1108
@table @code
1109
@kindex shell
1110
@cindex shell escape
1111
@item shell @var{command string}
1112
Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command string}.
1113
If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
1114
shell to run.  Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
1115
(@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
1116
@end table
1117
 
1118
The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1119
You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1120
@value{GDBN}:
1121
 
1122
@table @code
1123
@kindex make
1124
@cindex calling make
1125
@item make @var{make-args}
1126
Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1127
arguments.  This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1128
@end table
1129
 
1130
@node Commands
1131
@chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1132
 
1133
You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1134
name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1135
@value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}.  You can also use the @key{TAB}
1136
key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1137
show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1138
 
1139
@menu
1140
* Command Syntax::              How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1141
* Completion::                  Command completion
1142
* Help::                        How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1143
@end menu
1144
 
1145
@node Command Syntax
1146
@section Command syntax
1147
 
1148
A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input.  There is no limit on
1149
how long it can be.  It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1150
arguments whose meaning depends on the command name.  For example, the
1151
command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1152
step, as in @samp{step 5}.  You can also use the @code{step} command
1153
with no arguments.  Some commands do not allow any arguments.
1154
 
1155
@cindex abbreviation
1156
@value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1157
unambiguous.  Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1158
documentation for individual commands.  In some cases, even ambiguous
1159
abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1160
equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1161
names start with @code{s}.  You can test abbreviations by using them as
1162
arguments to the @code{help} command.
1163
 
1164
@cindex repeating commands
1165
@kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)}
1166
A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
1167
repeat the previous command.  Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
1168
will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1169
repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1170
repeat.
1171
 
1172
The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1173
@key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1174
exactly as typed.  This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1175
 
1176
@value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1177
output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1178
(@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen size}).  Since it is easy to press one
1179
@key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1180
repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1181
 
1182
@kindex # @r{(a comment)}
1183
@cindex comment
1184
Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1185
nothing.  This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1186
Files,,Command files}).
1187
 
1188
@node Completion
1189
@section Command completion
1190
 
1191
@cindex completion
1192
@cindex word completion
1193
@value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1194
only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1195
are for the next word in a command, at any time.  This works for @value{GDBN}
1196
commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1197
 
1198
Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1199
of a word.  If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1200
word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1201
enter it).  For example, if you type
1202
 
1203
@c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1204
@c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1205
@c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1206
@c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
1207
@example
1208
(@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
1209
@end example
1210
 
1211
@noindent
1212
@value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1213
the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1214
 
1215
@example
1216
(@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
1217
@end example
1218
 
1219
@noindent
1220
You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1221
breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1222
@samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected.  (If you
1223
were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1224
might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1225
to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1226
 
1227
If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1228
@key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell.  You can either supply more
1229
characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1230
@value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word.  For
1231
example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1232
begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1233
just sounds the bell.  Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1234
function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1235
example:
1236
 
1237
@example
1238
(@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1239
@exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
1240
make_a_section_from_file     make_environ
1241
make_abs_section             make_function_type
1242
make_blockvector             make_pointer_type
1243
make_cleanup                 make_reference_type
1244
make_command                 make_symbol_completion_list
1245
(@value{GDBP}) b make_
1246
@end example
1247
 
1248
@noindent
1249
After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1250
partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1251
command.
1252
 
1253
If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
1254
can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice.  @kbd{M-?}
1255
means @kbd{@key{META} ?}.  You can type this either by holding down a
1256
key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
1257
one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
1258
 
1259
@cindex quotes in commands
1260
@cindex completion of quoted strings
1261
Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
1262
parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1263
its notion of a word.  To permit word completion to work in this
1264
situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1265
@value{GDBN} commands.
1266
 
1267
The most likely situation where you might need this is in typing the
1268
name of a C@t{++} function.  This is because C@t{++} allows function
1269
overloading (multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished
1270
by argument type).  For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you
1271
may need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name}
1272
that takes an @code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version
1273
that takes a @code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}.  To use the
1274
word-completion facilities in this situation, type a single quote
1275
@code{'} at the beginning of the function name.  This alerts
1276
@value{GDBN} that it may need to consider more information than usual
1277
when you press @key{TAB} or @kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
1278
 
1279
@example
1280
(@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble( @kbd{M-?}
1281
bubble(double,double)    bubble(int,int)
1282
(@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1283
@end example
1284
 
1285
In some cases, @value{GDBN} can tell that completing a name requires using
1286
quotes.  When this happens, @value{GDBN} inserts the quote for you (while
1287
completing as much as it can) if you do not type the quote in the first
1288
place:
1289
 
1290
@example
1291
(@value{GDBP}) b bub @key{TAB}
1292
@exdent @value{GDBN} alters your input line to the following, and rings a bell:
1293
(@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1294
@end example
1295
 
1296
@noindent
1297
In general, @value{GDBN} can tell that a quote is needed (and inserts it) if
1298
you have not yet started typing the argument list when you ask for
1299
completion on an overloaded symbol.
1300
 
1301
For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C plus plus
1302
expressions, ,C@t{++} expressions}.  You can use the command @code{set
1303
overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
1304
see @ref{Debugging C plus plus, ,@value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}}.
1305
 
1306
 
1307
@node Help
1308
@section Getting help
1309
@cindex online documentation
1310
@kindex help
1311
 
1312
You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
1313
using the command @code{help}.
1314
 
1315
@table @code
1316
@kindex h @r{(@code{help})}
1317
@item help
1318
@itemx h
1319
You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1320
display a short list of named classes of commands:
1321
 
1322
@smallexample
1323
(@value{GDBP}) help
1324
List of classes of commands:
1325
 
1326
aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1327
breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
1328
data -- Examining data
1329
files -- Specifying and examining files
1330
internals -- Maintenance commands
1331
obscure -- Obscure features
1332
running -- Running the program
1333
stack -- Examining the stack
1334
status -- Status inquiries
1335
support -- Support facilities
1336
tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without@*
1337
               stopping the program
1338
user-defined -- User-defined commands
1339
 
1340
Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
1341
commands in that class.
1342
Type "help" followed by command name for full
1343
documentation.
1344
Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1345
(@value{GDBP})
1346
@end smallexample
1347
@c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull...
1348
 
1349
@item help @var{class}
1350
Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1351
list of the individual commands in that class.  For example, here is the
1352
help display for the class @code{status}:
1353
 
1354
@smallexample
1355
(@value{GDBP}) help status
1356
Status inquiries.
1357
 
1358
List of commands:
1359
 
1360
@c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1361
@c to fit in smallbook page size.
1362
info -- Generic command for showing things
1363
 about the program being debugged
1364
show -- Generic command for showing things
1365
 about the debugger
1366
 
1367
Type "help" followed by command name for full
1368
documentation.
1369
Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1370
(@value{GDBP})
1371
@end smallexample
1372
 
1373
@item help @var{command}
1374
With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1375
short paragraph on how to use that command.
1376
 
1377
@kindex apropos
1378
@item apropos @var{args}
1379
The @code{apropos @var{args}} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN}
1380
commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in
1381
@var{args}. It prints out all matches found. For example:
1382
 
1383
@smallexample
1384
apropos reload
1385
@end smallexample
1386
 
1387
@noindent
1388
results in:
1389
 
1390
@smallexample
1391
@c @group
1392
set symbol-reloading -- Set dynamic symbol table reloading
1393
                                 multiple times in one run
1394
show symbol-reloading -- Show dynamic symbol table reloading
1395
                                 multiple times in one run
1396
@c @end group
1397
@end smallexample
1398
 
1399
@kindex complete
1400
@item complete @var{args}
1401
The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1402
for the beginning of a command.  Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1403
command you want completed.  For example:
1404
 
1405
@smallexample
1406
complete i
1407
@end smallexample
1408
 
1409
@noindent results in:
1410
 
1411
@smallexample
1412
@group
1413
if
1414
ignore
1415
info
1416
inspect
1417
@end group
1418
@end smallexample
1419
 
1420
@noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1421
@end table
1422
 
1423
In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1424
and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1425
of @value{GDBN} itself.  Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1426
manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context.  The listings
1427
under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Index point to
1428
all the sub-commands.  @xref{Index}.
1429
 
1430
@c @group
1431
@table @code
1432
@kindex info
1433
@kindex i @r{(@code{info})}
1434
@item info
1435
This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1436
program.  For example, you can list the arguments given to your program
1437
with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1438
registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1439
You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1440
@w{@code{help info}}.
1441
 
1442
@kindex set
1443
@item set
1444
You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
1445
@code{set}.  For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1446
@code{set prompt $}.
1447
 
1448
@kindex show
1449
@item show
1450
In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
1451
@value{GDBN} itself.
1452
You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1453
related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1454
system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1455
which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1456
 
1457
@kindex info set
1458
To display all the settable parameters and their current
1459
values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1460
@code{info set}.  Both commands produce the same display.
1461
@c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1462
@c FIXME...program.  Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1463
@c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1464
@end table
1465
@c @end group
1466
 
1467
Here are three miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1468
exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1469
 
1470
@table @code
1471
@kindex show version
1472
@cindex version number
1473
@item show version
1474
Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running.  You should include this
1475
information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports.  If multiple versions of
1476
@value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
1477
version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
1478
commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away.  Also, many
1479
system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
1480
variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well.
1481
The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
1482
@value{GDBN}.
1483
 
1484
@kindex show copying
1485
@item show copying
1486
Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1487
 
1488
@kindex show warranty
1489
@item show warranty
1490
Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
1491
if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one.
1492
 
1493
@end table
1494
 
1495
@node Running
1496
@chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1497
 
1498
When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1499
debugging information when you compile it.
1500
 
1501
You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1502
of your choice.  If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1503
your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1504
kill a child process.
1505
 
1506
@menu
1507
* Compilation::                 Compiling for debugging
1508
* Starting::                    Starting your program
1509
* Arguments::                   Your program's arguments
1510
* Environment::                 Your program's environment
1511
 
1512
* Working Directory::           Your program's working directory
1513
* Input/Output::                Your program's input and output
1514
* Attach::                      Debugging an already-running process
1515
* Kill Process::                Killing the child process
1516
 
1517
* Threads::                     Debugging programs with multiple threads
1518
* Processes::                   Debugging programs with multiple processes
1519
@end menu
1520
 
1521
@node Compilation
1522
@section Compiling for debugging
1523
 
1524
In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1525
debugging information when you compile it.  This debugging information
1526
is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1527
variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1528
and addresses in the executable code.
1529
 
1530
To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
1531
the compiler.
1532
 
1533
Many C compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O}
1534
options together.  Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
1535
executables containing debugging information.
1536
 
1537
@value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
1538
without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code.  We
1539
recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
1540
program.  You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
1541
in pushing your luck.
1542
 
1543
@cindex optimized code, debugging
1544
@cindex debugging optimized code
1545
When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
1546
optimizer is rearranging your code; the debugger shows you what is
1547
really there.  Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
1548
exactly match your source file!  An extreme example: if you define a
1549
variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
1550
variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
1551
 
1552
Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
1553
@samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling.  If in
1554
doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
1555
please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
1556
 
1557
Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
1558
@w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information.  @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
1559
format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
1560
 
1561
@need 2000
1562
@node Starting
1563
@section Starting your program
1564
@cindex starting
1565
@cindex running
1566
 
1567
@table @code
1568
@kindex run
1569
@kindex r @r{(@code{run})}
1570
@item run
1571
@itemx r
1572
Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
1573
You must first specify the program name (except on VxWorks) with an
1574
argument to @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
1575
@value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file} command
1576
(@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
1577
 
1578
@end table
1579
 
1580
If you are running your program in an execution environment that
1581
supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
1582
that process run your program.  (In environments without processes,
1583
@code{run} jumps to the start of your program.)
1584
 
1585
The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
1586
receives from its superior.  @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
1587
information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program.  (You
1588
can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
1589
your program the next time you start it.)  This information may be
1590
divided into four categories:
1591
 
1592
@table @asis
1593
@item The @emph{arguments.}
1594
Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
1595
@code{run} command.  If a shell is available on your target, the shell
1596
is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
1597
(such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
1598
the arguments.
1599
In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
1600
@code{SHELL} environment variable.
1601
@xref{Arguments, ,Your program's arguments}.
1602
 
1603
@item The @emph{environment.}
1604
Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
1605
use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
1606
environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
1607
your program.  @xref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}.
1608
 
1609
@item The @emph{working directory.}
1610
Your program inherits its working directory from @value{GDBN}.  You can set
1611
the @value{GDBN} working directory with the @code{cd} command in @value{GDBN}.
1612
@xref{Working Directory, ,Your program's working directory}.
1613
 
1614
@item The @emph{standard input and output.}
1615
Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
1616
standard output as @value{GDBN} is using.  You can redirect input and output
1617
in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
1618
set a different device for your program.
1619
@xref{Input/Output, ,Your program's input and output}.
1620
 
1621
@cindex pipes
1622
@emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
1623
pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
1624
program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
1625
wrong program.
1626
@end table
1627
 
1628
When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
1629
immediately.  @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and continuing}, for discussion
1630
of how to arrange for your program to stop.  Once your program has
1631
stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
1632
or @code{call} commands.  @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
1633
 
1634
If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
1635
time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
1636
table, and reads it again.  When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
1637
your current breakpoints.
1638
 
1639
@node Arguments
1640
@section Your program's arguments
1641
 
1642
@cindex arguments (to your program)
1643
The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
1644
@code{run} command.
1645
They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
1646
performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program.  Your
1647
@code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
1648
@value{GDBN} uses.  If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
1649
the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
1650
 
1651
On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
1652
@value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
1653
calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
1654
the program, not by the shell.
1655
 
1656
@code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
1657
@code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
1658
 
1659
@table @code
1660
@kindex set args
1661
@item set args
1662
Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run.  If
1663
@code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
1664
with no arguments.  Once you have run your program with arguments,
1665
using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
1666
it again without arguments.
1667
 
1668
@kindex show args
1669
@item show args
1670
Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
1671
@end table
1672
 
1673
@node Environment
1674
@section Your program's environment
1675
 
1676
@cindex environment (of your program)
1677
The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
1678
their values.  Environment variables conventionally record such things as
1679
your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
1680
path for programs to run.  Usually you set up environment variables with
1681
the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run.  When
1682
debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
1683
environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
1684
 
1685
@table @code
1686
@kindex path
1687
@item path @var{directory}
1688
Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
1689
(the search path for executables) that will be passed to your program.
1690
The value of @code{PATH} used by @value{GDBN} does not change.
1691
You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
1692
system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
1693
MS-DOS and MS-Windows).  If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
1694
is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
1695
 
1696
You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
1697
working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path.  If you
1698
use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
1699
@code{path} command.  @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
1700
@var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
1701
@var{directory} to the search path.
1702
@c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
1703
@c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
1704
 
1705
@kindex show paths
1706
@item show paths
1707
Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
1708
environment variable).
1709
 
1710
@kindex show environment
1711
@item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
1712
Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
1713
your program when it starts.  If you do not supply @var{varname},
1714
print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
1715
your program.  You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
1716
 
1717
@kindex set environment
1718
@item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
1719
Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}.  The value
1720
changes for your program only, not for @value{GDBN} itself.  @var{value} may
1721
be any string; the values of environment variables are just strings, and
1722
any interpretation is supplied by your program itself.  The @var{value}
1723
parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
1724
null value.
1725
@c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
1726
@c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
1727
 
1728
For example, this command:
1729
 
1730
@example
1731
set env USER = foo
1732
@end example
1733
 
1734
@noindent
1735
tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
1736
@samp{foo}.  (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
1737
are not actually required.)
1738
 
1739
@kindex unset environment
1740
@item unset environment @var{varname}
1741
Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
1742
program.  This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
1743
@code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
1744
rather than assigning it an empty value.
1745
@end table
1746
 
1747
@emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
1748
the shell indicated
1749
by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it exists (or
1750
@code{/bin/sh} if not).  If your @code{SHELL} variable names a shell
1751
that runs an initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, or
1752
@file{.bashrc} for BASH---any variables you set in that file affect
1753
your program.  You may wish to move setting of environment variables to
1754
files that are only run when you sign on, such as @file{.login} or
1755
@file{.profile}.
1756
 
1757
@node Working Directory
1758
@section Your program's working directory
1759
 
1760
@cindex working directory (of your program)
1761
Each time you start your program with @code{run}, it inherits its
1762
working directory from the current working directory of @value{GDBN}.
1763
The @value{GDBN} working directory is initially whatever it inherited
1764
from its parent process (typically the shell), but you can specify a new
1765
working directory in @value{GDBN} with the @code{cd} command.
1766
 
1767
The @value{GDBN} working directory also serves as a default for the commands
1768
that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on.  @xref{Files, ,Commands to
1769
specify files}.
1770
 
1771
@table @code
1772
@kindex cd
1773
@item cd @var{directory}
1774
Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}.
1775
 
1776
@kindex pwd
1777
@item pwd
1778
Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
1779
@end table
1780
 
1781
@node Input/Output
1782
@section Your program's input and output
1783
 
1784
@cindex redirection
1785
@cindex i/o
1786
@cindex terminal
1787
By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
1788
the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses.  @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
1789
to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
1790
modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
1791
running your program.
1792
 
1793
@table @code
1794
@kindex info terminal
1795
@item info terminal
1796
Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
1797
program is using.
1798
@end table
1799
 
1800
You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
1801
redirection with the @code{run} command.  For example,
1802
 
1803
@example
1804
run > outfile
1805
@end example
1806
 
1807
@noindent
1808
starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
1809
 
1810
@kindex tty
1811
@cindex controlling terminal
1812
Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
1813
with the @code{tty} command.  This command accepts a file name as
1814
argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
1815
commands.  It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
1816
process, for future @code{run} commands.  For example,
1817
 
1818
@example
1819
tty /dev/ttyb
1820
@end example
1821
 
1822
@noindent
1823
directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
1824
default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
1825
that as their controlling terminal.
1826
 
1827
An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
1828
effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
1829
terminal.
1830
 
1831
When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
1832
command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected.  The input
1833
for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal.
1834
 
1835
@node Attach
1836
@section Debugging an already-running process
1837
@kindex attach
1838
@cindex attach
1839
 
1840
@table @code
1841
@item attach @var{process-id}
1842
This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
1843
outside @value{GDBN}.  (@code{info files} shows your active
1844
targets.)  The command takes as argument a process ID.  The usual way to
1845
find out the process-id of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
1846
or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
1847
 
1848
@code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
1849
executing the command.
1850
@end table
1851
 
1852
To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
1853
which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
1854
programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system.  You must
1855
also have permission to send the process a signal.
1856
 
1857
When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
1858
the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
1859
the program is not found) by using the source file search path
1860
(@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying source directories}).  You can also use
1861
the @code{file} command to load the program.  @xref{Files, ,Commands to
1862
Specify Files}.
1863
 
1864
The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
1865
process is to stop it.  You can examine and modify an attached process
1866
with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
1867
you start processes with @code{run}.  You can insert breakpoints; you
1868
can step and continue; you can modify storage.  If you would rather the
1869
process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
1870
attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
1871
 
1872
@table @code
1873
@kindex detach
1874
@item detach
1875
When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
1876
@code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control.  Detaching
1877
the process continues its execution.  After the @code{detach} command,
1878
that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
1879
are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
1880
@code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
1881
executing the command.
1882
@end table
1883
 
1884
If you exit @value{GDBN} or use the @code{run} command while you have an
1885
attached process, you kill that process.  By default, @value{GDBN} asks
1886
for confirmation if you try to do either of these things; you can
1887
control whether or not you need to confirm by using the @code{set
1888
confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
1889
messages}).
1890
 
1891
@node Kill Process
1892
@section Killing the child process
1893
 
1894
@table @code
1895
@kindex kill
1896
@item kill
1897
Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
1898
@end table
1899
 
1900
This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
1901
running process.  @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
1902
is running.
1903
 
1904
On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
1905
while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}.  You can use the
1906
@code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
1907
outside the debugger.
1908
 
1909
The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
1910
relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
1911
executable file while it is running in a process.  In this case, when you
1912
next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
1913
reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
1914
breakpoint settings).
1915
 
1916
@node Threads
1917
@section Debugging programs with multiple threads
1918
 
1919
@cindex threads of execution
1920
@cindex multiple threads
1921
@cindex switching threads
1922
In some operating systems, such as HP-UX and Solaris, a single program
1923
may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution.  The precise semantics
1924
of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
1925
the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
1926
that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
1927
modify the same variables).  On the other hand, each thread has its own
1928
registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
1929
 
1930
@value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
1931
programs:
1932
 
1933
@itemize @bullet
1934
@item automatic notification of new threads
1935
@item @samp{thread @var{threadno}}, a command to switch among threads
1936
@item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
1937
@item @samp{thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}},
1938
a command to apply a command to a list of threads
1939
@item thread-specific breakpoints
1940
@end itemize
1941
 
1942
@quotation
1943
@emph{Warning:} These facilities are not yet available on every
1944
@value{GDBN} configuration where the operating system supports threads.
1945
If your @value{GDBN} does not support threads, these commands have no
1946
effect.  For example, a system without thread support shows no output
1947
from @samp{info threads}, and always rejects the @code{thread} command,
1948
like this:
1949
 
1950
@smallexample
1951
(@value{GDBP}) info threads
1952
(@value{GDBP}) thread 1
1953
Thread ID 1 not known.  Use the "info threads" command to
1954
see the IDs of currently known threads.
1955
@end smallexample
1956
@c FIXME to implementors: how hard would it be to say "sorry, this GDB
1957
@c                        doesn't support threads"?
1958
@end quotation
1959
 
1960
@cindex focus of debugging
1961
@cindex current thread
1962
The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
1963
threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
1964
control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
1965
This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}.  Debugging commands show
1966
program information from the perspective of the current thread.
1967
 
1968
@cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message
1969
@cindex thread identifier (system)
1970
@c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
1971
@c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
1972
@c thread without first checking `info threads'.
1973
Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
1974
the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
1975
form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}.  @var{systag} is a thread identifier
1976
whose form varies depending on the particular system.  For example, on
1977
LynxOS, you might see
1978
 
1979
@example
1980
[New process 35 thread 27]
1981
@end example
1982
 
1983
@noindent
1984
when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread.  In contrast, on an SGI system,
1985
the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
1986
further qualifier.
1987
 
1988
@c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
1989
@c         thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
1990
@c         second---i.e., when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
1991
@c         program?
1992
@c         (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always?  Or do some
1993
@c         multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
1994
@c         threads ab initio?
1995
 
1996
@cindex thread number
1997
@cindex thread identifier (GDB)
1998
For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
1999
number---always a single integer---with each thread in your program.
2000
 
2001
@table @code
2002
@kindex info threads
2003
@item info threads
2004
Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2005
program.  @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2006
 
2007
@enumerate
2008
@item the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2009
 
2010
@item the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2011
 
2012
@item the current stack frame summary for that thread
2013
@end enumerate
2014
 
2015
@noindent
2016
An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2017
indicates the current thread.
2018
 
2019
For example,
2020
@end table
2021
@c end table here to get a little more width for example
2022
 
2023
@smallexample
2024
(@value{GDBP}) info threads
2025
  3 process 35 thread 27  0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2026
  2 process 35 thread 23  0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2027
* 1 process 35 thread 13  main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
2028
    at threadtest.c:68
2029
@end smallexample
2030
 
2031
On HP-UX systems:
2032
 
2033
@cindex thread number
2034
@cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2035
For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2036
number---a small integer assigned in thread-creation order---with each
2037
thread in your program.
2038
 
2039
@cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message, on HP-UX
2040
@cindex thread identifier (system), on HP-UX
2041
@c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2042
@c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2043
@c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2044
Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2045
both @value{GDBN}'s thread number and the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2046
form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}.  @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2047
whose form varies depending on the particular system.  For example, on
2048
HP-UX, you see
2049
 
2050
@example
2051
[New thread 2 (system thread 26594)]
2052
@end example
2053
 
2054
@noindent
2055
when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread.
2056
 
2057
@table @code
2058
@kindex info threads
2059
@item info threads
2060
Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2061
program.  @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2062
 
2063
@enumerate
2064
@item the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2065
 
2066
@item the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2067
 
2068
@item the current stack frame summary for that thread
2069
@end enumerate
2070
 
2071
@noindent
2072
An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2073
indicates the current thread.
2074
 
2075
For example,
2076
@end table
2077
@c end table here to get a little more width for example
2078
 
2079
@example
2080
(@value{GDBP}) info threads
2081
    * 3 system thread 26607  worker (wptr=0x7b09c318 "@@") \@*
2082
                               at quicksort.c:137
2083
      2 system thread 26606  0x7b0030d8 in __ksleep () \@*
2084
                               from /usr/lib/libc.2
2085
      1 system thread 27905  0x7b003498 in _brk () \@*
2086
                               from /usr/lib/libc.2
2087
@end example
2088
 
2089
@table @code
2090
@kindex thread @var{threadno}
2091
@item thread @var{threadno}
2092
Make thread number @var{threadno} the current thread.  The command
2093
argument @var{threadno} is the internal @value{GDBN} thread number, as
2094
shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display.
2095
@value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the thread
2096
you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
2097
 
2098
@smallexample
2099
@c FIXME!! This example made up; find a @value{GDBN} w/threads and get real one
2100
(@value{GDBP}) thread 2
2101
[Switching to process 35 thread 23]
2102
0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2103
@end smallexample
2104
 
2105
@noindent
2106
As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
2107
@samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
2108
threads.
2109
 
2110
@kindex thread apply
2111
@item thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}]  @var{args}
2112
The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply a command to one or
2113
more threads.  Specify the numbers of the threads that you want affected
2114
with the command argument @var{threadno}.  @var{threadno} is the internal
2115
@value{GDBN} thread number, as shown in the first field of the @samp{info
2116
threads} display.  To apply a command to all threads, use
2117
@code{thread apply all} @var{args}.
2118
@end table
2119
 
2120
@cindex automatic thread selection
2121
@cindex switching threads automatically
2122
@cindex threads, automatic switching
2123
Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
2124
signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
2125
signal happened.  @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
2126
message of the form @samp{[Switching to @var{systag}]} to identify the
2127
thread.
2128
 
2129
@xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and starting multi-thread programs}, for
2130
more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
2131
programs with multiple threads.
2132
 
2133
@xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting watchpoints}, for information about
2134
watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
2135
 
2136
@node Processes
2137
@section Debugging programs with multiple processes
2138
 
2139
@cindex fork, debugging programs which call
2140
@cindex multiple processes
2141
@cindex processes, multiple
2142
On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
2143
programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
2144
function.  When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
2145
parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.  If you have
2146
set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
2147
will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
2148
will cause it to terminate.
2149
 
2150
However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
2151
which isn't too painful.  Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
2152
the child process executes after the fork.  It may be useful to sleep
2153
only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
2154
so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
2155
on the child.  While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
2156
get its process ID.  Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
2157
@value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
2158
the child process (@pxref{Attach}).  From that point on you can debug
2159
the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
2160
 
2161
On HP-UX (11.x and later only?), @value{GDBN} provides support for
2162
debugging programs that create additional processes using the
2163
@code{fork} or @code{vfork} function.
2164
 
2165
By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
2166
the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
2167
 
2168
If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
2169
use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
2170
 
2171
@table @code
2172
@kindex set follow-fork-mode
2173
@item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
2174
Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
2175
@code{vfork}.  A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
2176
process.  The @var{mode} can be:
2177
 
2178
@table @code
2179
@item parent
2180
The original process is debugged after a fork.  The child process runs
2181
unimpeded.  This is the default.
2182
 
2183
@item child
2184
The new process is debugged after a fork.  The parent process runs
2185
unimpeded.
2186
 
2187
@item ask
2188
The debugger will ask for one of the above choices.
2189
@end table
2190
 
2191
@item show follow-fork-mode
2192
Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
2193
@end table
2194
 
2195
If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
2196
@code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
2197
breakpoint in the new target.  If you have a breakpoint set on
2198
@code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
2199
the child process's @code{main}.
2200
 
2201
When a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you cannot debug the
2202
child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
2203
 
2204
If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
2205
call executes, the new target restarts.  To restart the parent process,
2206
use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name as its
2207
argument.
2208
 
2209
You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
2210
a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made.  @xref{Set
2211
Catchpoints, ,Setting catchpoints}.
2212
 
2213
@node Stopping
2214
@chapter Stopping and Continuing
2215
 
2216
The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
2217
program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
2218
trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
2219
 
2220
Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
2221
such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
2222
@value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}.  You may then examine and
2223
change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
2224
continue execution.  Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
2225
ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
2226
explicitly request this information at any time.
2227
 
2228
@table @code
2229
@kindex info program
2230
@item info program
2231
Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
2232
running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
2233
@end table
2234
 
2235
@menu
2236
* Breakpoints::                 Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
2237
* Continuing and Stepping::     Resuming execution
2238
* Signals::                     Signals
2239
* Thread Stops::                Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
2240
@end menu
2241
 
2242
@node Breakpoints
2243
@section Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
2244
 
2245
@cindex breakpoints
2246
A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
2247
the program is reached.  For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
2248
control in finer detail whether your program stops.  You can set
2249
breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
2250
Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
2251
should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
2252
program.
2253
 
2254
In HP-UX, SunOS 4.x, SVR4, and Alpha OSF/1 configurations, you can set
2255
breakpoints in shared libraries before the executable is run.  There is
2256
a minor limitation on HP-UX systems: you must wait until the executable
2257
is run in order to set breakpoints in shared library routines that are
2258
not called directly by the program (for example, routines that are
2259
arguments in a @code{pthread_create} call).
2260
 
2261
@cindex watchpoints
2262
@cindex memory tracing
2263
@cindex breakpoint on memory address
2264
@cindex breakpoint on variable modification
2265
A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
2266
when the value of an expression changes.  You must use a different
2267
command to set watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting
2268
watchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a watchpoint like
2269
any other breakpoint: you enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints
2270
and watchpoints using the same commands.
2271
 
2272
You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
2273
whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint.  @xref{Auto Display,,
2274
Automatic display}.
2275
 
2276
@cindex catchpoints
2277
@cindex breakpoint on events
2278
A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
2279
when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C@t{++}
2280
exception or the loading of a library.  As with watchpoints, you use a
2281
different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
2282
catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
2283
other breakpoint.  (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
2284
@code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
2285
 
2286
@cindex breakpoint numbers
2287
@cindex numbers for breakpoints
2288
@value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
2289
catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
2290
starting with one.  In many of the commands for controlling various
2291
features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
2292
breakpoint you want to change.  Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
2293
@dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
2294
enable it again.
2295
 
2296
@cindex breakpoint ranges
2297
@cindex ranges of breakpoints
2298
Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a range of breakpoints on which to
2299
operate.  A breakpoint range is either a single breakpoint number, like
2300
@samp{5}, or two such numbers, in increasing order, separated by a
2301
hyphen, like @samp{5-7}.  When a breakpoint range is given to a command,
2302
all breakpoint in that range are operated on.
2303
 
2304
@menu
2305
* Set Breaks::                  Setting breakpoints
2306
* Set Watchpoints::             Setting watchpoints
2307
* Set Catchpoints::             Setting catchpoints
2308
* Delete Breaks::               Deleting breakpoints
2309
* Disabling::                   Disabling breakpoints
2310
* Conditions::                  Break conditions
2311
* Break Commands::              Breakpoint command lists
2312
* Breakpoint Menus::            Breakpoint menus
2313
* Error in Breakpoints::        ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
2314
@end menu
2315
 
2316
@node Set Breaks
2317
@subsection Setting breakpoints
2318
 
2319
@c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
2320
@c       consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
2321
@c
2322
@c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
2323
 
2324
@kindex break
2325
@kindex b @r{(@code{break})}
2326
@vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable}
2327
@cindex latest breakpoint
2328
Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
2329
@code{b}).  The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
2330
number of the breakpoint you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
2331
Vars,, Convenience variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
2332
convenience variables.
2333
 
2334
You have several ways to say where the breakpoint should go.
2335
 
2336
@table @code
2337
@item break @var{function}
2338
Set a breakpoint at entry to function @var{function}.
2339
When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
2340
C@t{++}, @var{function} may refer to more than one possible place to break.
2341
@xref{Breakpoint Menus,,Breakpoint menus}, for a discussion of that situation.
2342
 
2343
@item break +@var{offset}
2344
@itemx break -@var{offset}
2345
Set a breakpoint some number of lines forward or back from the position
2346
at which execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}.
2347
(@xref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.)
2348
 
2349
@item break @var{linenum}
2350
Set a breakpoint at line @var{linenum} in the current source file.
2351
The current source file is the last file whose source text was printed.
2352
The breakpoint will stop your program just before it executes any of the
2353
code on that line.
2354
 
2355
@item break @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
2356
Set a breakpoint at line @var{linenum} in source file @var{filename}.
2357
 
2358
@item break @var{filename}:@var{function}
2359
Set a breakpoint at entry to function @var{function} found in file
2360
@var{filename}.  Specifying a file name as well as a function name is
2361
superfluous except when multiple files contain similarly named
2362
functions.
2363
 
2364
@item break *@var{address}
2365
Set a breakpoint at address @var{address}.  You can use this to set
2366
breakpoints in parts of your program which do not have debugging
2367
information or source files.
2368
 
2369
@item break
2370
When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
2371
the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
2372
(@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}).  In any selected frame but the
2373
innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
2374
returns to that frame.  This is similar to the effect of a
2375
@code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
2376
that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint.  If you use
2377
@code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
2378
the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
2379
inside loops.
2380
 
2381
@value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
2382
least one instruction has been executed.  If it did not do this, you
2383
would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
2384
breakpoint.  This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
2385
existed when your program stopped.
2386
 
2387
@item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
2388
Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
2389
@var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
2390
value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
2391
@samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
2392
above (or no argument) specifying where to break.  @xref{Conditions,
2393
,Break conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
2394
 
2395
@kindex tbreak
2396
@item tbreak @var{args}
2397
Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop.  @var{args} are the
2398
same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
2399
way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
2400
program stops there.  @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling breakpoints}.
2401
 
2402
@kindex hbreak
2403
@item hbreak @var{args}
2404
Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint.  @var{args} are the same as for the
2405
@code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
2406
breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
2407
have this support.  The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
2408
debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
2409
changing the instruction.  This can be used with the new trap-generation
2410
provided by SPARClite DSU and some x86-based targets.  These targets
2411
will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
2412
address that is assigned to the debug registers.  However the hardware
2413
breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints.  For
2414
example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
2415
@value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used.  Delete
2416
or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
2417
(@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling}).  @xref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}.
2418
 
2419
@kindex thbreak
2420
@item thbreak @var{args}
2421
Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop.  @var{args}
2422
are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
2423
the same way.  However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
2424
the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
2425
first time your program stops there.  Also, like the @code{hbreak}
2426
command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
2427
may not have this support.  @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling breakpoints}.
2428
See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}.
2429
 
2430
@kindex rbreak
2431
@cindex regular expression
2432
@item rbreak @var{regex}
2433
Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
2434
@var{regex}.  This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
2435
matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set.  Once these
2436
breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
2437
the @code{break} command.  You can delete them, disable them, or make
2438
them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
2439
 
2440
The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
2441
like @file{grep}.  Note that this is different from the syntax used by
2442
shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
2443
an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s.  There is an implicit
2444
@code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
2445
match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
2446
 
2447
When debugging C@t{++} programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
2448
breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
2449
classes.
2450
 
2451
@kindex info breakpoints
2452
@cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
2453
@item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2454
@itemx info break @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2455
@itemx info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2456
Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
2457
not deleted, with the following columns for each breakpoint:
2458
 
2459
@table @emph
2460
@item Breakpoint Numbers
2461
@item Type
2462
Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
2463
@item Disposition
2464
Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
2465
@item Enabled or Disabled
2466
Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}.  @samp{n} marks breakpoints
2467
that are not enabled.
2468
@item Address
2469
Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address.
2470
@item What
2471
Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
2472
line number.
2473
@end table
2474
 
2475
@noindent
2476
If a breakpoint is conditional, @code{info break} shows the condition on
2477
the line following the affected breakpoint; breakpoint commands, if any,
2478
are listed after that.
2479
 
2480
@noindent
2481
@code{info break} with a breakpoint
2482
number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint.  The
2483
convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
2484
the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
2485
listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining memory}).
2486
 
2487
@noindent
2488
@code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
2489
has been hit.  This is especially useful in conjunction with the
2490
@code{ignore} command.  You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
2491
hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
2492
was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number.  This
2493
will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
2494
@end table
2495
 
2496
@value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
2497
your program.  There is nothing silly or meaningless about this.  When
2498
the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
2499
(@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}).
2500
 
2501
@cindex negative breakpoint numbers
2502
@cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
2503
@value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for special
2504
purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C programs).
2505
These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers, starting with
2506
@code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
2507
 
2508
You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
2509
@samp{maint info breakpoints}.
2510
 
2511
@table @code
2512
@kindex maint info breakpoints
2513
@item maint info breakpoints
2514
Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
2515
breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
2516
internal purposes.  Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
2517
breakpoint numbers.  The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
2518
is shown:
2519
 
2520
@table @code
2521
@item breakpoint
2522
Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
2523
 
2524
@item watchpoint
2525
Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
2526
 
2527
@item longjmp
2528
Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
2529
@code{longjmp} calls.
2530
 
2531
@item longjmp resume
2532
Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
2533
 
2534
@item until
2535
Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
2536
 
2537
@item finish
2538
Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
2539
 
2540
@item shlib events
2541
Shared library events.
2542
 
2543
@end table
2544
 
2545
@end table
2546
 
2547
 
2548
@node Set Watchpoints
2549
@subsection Setting watchpoints
2550
 
2551
@cindex setting watchpoints
2552
@cindex software watchpoints
2553
@cindex hardware watchpoints
2554
You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
2555
expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
2556
this may happen.
2557
 
2558
Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
2559
hardware.  @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
2560
program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
2561
times slower than normal execution.  (But this may still be worth it, to
2562
catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
2563
culprit.)
2564
 
2565
On some systems, such as HP-UX, Linux and some other x86-based targets,
2566
@value{GDBN} includes support for
2567
hardware watchpoints, which do not slow down the running of your
2568
program.
2569
 
2570
@table @code
2571
@kindex watch
2572
@item watch @var{expr}
2573
Set a watchpoint for an expression.  @value{GDBN} will break when @var{expr}
2574
is written into by the program and its value changes.
2575
 
2576
@kindex rwatch
2577
@item rwatch @var{expr}
2578
Set a watchpoint that will break when watch @var{expr} is read by the program.
2579
 
2580
@kindex awatch
2581
@item awatch @var{expr}
2582
Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read or written into
2583
by the program.
2584
 
2585
@kindex info watchpoints
2586
@item info watchpoints
2587
This command prints a list of watchpoints, breakpoints, and catchpoints;
2588
it is the same as @code{info break}.
2589
@end table
2590
 
2591
@value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible.  Hardware
2592
watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
2593
value at the exact instruction where the change occurs.  If @value{GDBN}
2594
cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
2595
executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
2596
statement, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
2597
 
2598
When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
2599
 
2600
@example
2601
Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
2602
@end example
2603
 
2604
@noindent
2605
if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
2606
 
2607
Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
2608
hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
2609
value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
2610
every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
2611
that currently.  If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
2612
hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
2613
will print a message like this:
2614
 
2615
@smallexample
2616
Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
2617
@end smallexample
2618
 
2619
Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
2620
data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
2621
watchpoint on the target machine can handle.  For example, some systems
2622
can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
2623
cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
2624
double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
2625
wide).  As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
2626
into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
2627
 
2628
If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
2629
to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
2630
Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
2631
time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
2632
able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
2633
warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
2634
 
2635
@smallexample
2636
Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
2637
@end smallexample
2638
 
2639
@noindent
2640
If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
2641
 
2642
The SPARClite DSU will generate traps when a program accesses some data
2643
or instruction address that is assigned to the debug registers.  For the
2644
data addresses, DSU facilitates the @code{watch} command.  However the
2645
hardware breakpoint registers can only take two data watchpoints, and
2646
both watchpoints must be the same kind.  For example, you can set two
2647
watchpoints with @code{watch} commands, two with @code{rwatch} commands,
2648
@strong{or} two with @code{awatch} commands, but you cannot set one
2649
watchpoint with one command and the other with a different command.
2650
@value{GDBN} will reject the command if you try to mix watchpoints.
2651
Delete or disable unused watchpoint commands before setting new ones.
2652
 
2653
If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
2654
any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
2655
kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
2656
 
2657
@value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
2658
(automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
2659
they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
2660
which these variables were defined.  In particular, when the program
2661
being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
2662
and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set.  If you
2663
rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again.  One
2664
way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
2665
@code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
2666
 
2667
@quotation
2668
@cindex watchpoints and threads
2669
@cindex threads and watchpoints
2670
@emph{Warning:} In multi-thread programs, watchpoints have only limited
2671
usefulness.  With the current watchpoint implementation, @value{GDBN}
2672
can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a single thread}.  If
2673
you are confident that the expression can only change due to the current
2674
thread's activity (and if you are also confident that no other thread
2675
can become current), then you can use watchpoints as usual.  However,
2676
@value{GDBN} may not notice when a non-current thread's activity changes
2677
the expression.
2678
 
2679
@c FIXME: this is almost identical to the previous paragraph.
2680
@emph{HP-UX Warning:} In multi-thread programs, software watchpoints
2681
have only limited usefulness.  If @value{GDBN} creates a software
2682
watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
2683
single thread}.  If you are confident that the expression can only
2684
change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
2685
confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
2686
software watchpoints as usual.  However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
2687
when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression.  (Hardware
2688
watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
2689
@end quotation
2690
 
2691
@node Set Catchpoints
2692
@subsection Setting catchpoints
2693
@cindex catchpoints, setting
2694
@cindex exception handlers
2695
@cindex event handling
2696
 
2697
You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
2698
kinds of program events, such as C@t{++} exceptions or the loading of a
2699
shared library.  Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
2700
 
2701
@table @code
2702
@kindex catch
2703
@item catch @var{event}
2704
Stop when @var{event} occurs.  @var{event} can be any of the following:
2705
@table @code
2706
@item throw
2707
@kindex catch throw
2708
The throwing of a C@t{++} exception.
2709
 
2710
@item catch
2711
@kindex catch catch
2712
The catching of a C@t{++} exception.
2713
 
2714
@item exec
2715
@kindex catch exec
2716
A call to @code{exec}.  This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2717
 
2718
@item fork
2719
@kindex catch fork
2720
A call to @code{fork}.  This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2721
 
2722
@item vfork
2723
@kindex catch vfork
2724
A call to @code{vfork}.  This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2725
 
2726
@item load
2727
@itemx load @var{libname}
2728
@kindex catch load
2729
The dynamic loading of any shared library, or the loading of the library
2730
@var{libname}.  This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2731
 
2732
@item unload
2733
@itemx unload @var{libname}
2734
@kindex catch unload
2735
The unloading of any dynamically loaded shared library, or the unloading
2736
of the library @var{libname}.  This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2737
@end table
2738
 
2739
@item tcatch @var{event}
2740
Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop.  The catchpoint is
2741
automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
2742
 
2743
@end table
2744
 
2745
Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
2746
 
2747
There are currently some limitations to C@t{++} exception handling
2748
(@code{catch throw} and @code{catch catch}) in @value{GDBN}:
2749
 
2750
@itemize @bullet
2751
@item
2752
If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
2753
control to you when the function has finished executing.  If the call
2754
raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
2755
returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
2756
simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
2757
that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits.  This is the case even if
2758
you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
2759
disabled within interactive calls.
2760
 
2761
@item
2762
You cannot raise an exception interactively.
2763
 
2764
@item
2765
You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
2766
@end itemize
2767
 
2768
@cindex raise exceptions
2769
Sometimes @code{catch} is not the best way to debug exception handling:
2770
if you need to know exactly where an exception is raised, it is better to
2771
stop @emph{before} the exception handler is called, since that way you
2772
can see the stack before any unwinding takes place.  If you set a
2773
breakpoint in an exception handler instead, it may not be easy to find
2774
out where the exception was raised.
2775
 
2776
To stop just before an exception handler is called, you need some
2777
knowledge of the implementation.  In the case of @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, exceptions are
2778
raised by calling a library function named @code{__raise_exception}
2779
which has the following ANSI C interface:
2780
 
2781
@example
2782
    /* @var{addr} is where the exception identifier is stored.
2783
       @var{id} is the exception identifier.  */
2784
    void __raise_exception (void **addr, void *id);
2785
@end example
2786
 
2787
@noindent
2788
To make the debugger catch all exceptions before any stack
2789
unwinding takes place, set a breakpoint on @code{__raise_exception}
2790
(@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; watchpoints; and exceptions}).
2791
 
2792
With a conditional breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions})
2793
that depends on the value of @var{id}, you can stop your program when
2794
a specific exception is raised.  You can use multiple conditional
2795
breakpoints to stop your program when any of a number of exceptions are
2796
raised.
2797
 
2798
 
2799
@node Delete Breaks
2800
@subsection Deleting breakpoints
2801
 
2802
@cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
2803
@cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
2804
It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
2805
catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
2806
to stop there.  This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint.  A
2807
breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
2808
 
2809
With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
2810
where they are in your program.  With the @code{delete} command you can
2811
delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
2812
their breakpoint numbers.
2813
 
2814
It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it.  @value{GDBN}
2815
automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
2816
when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
2817
 
2818
@table @code
2819
@kindex clear
2820
@item clear
2821
Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
2822
selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}).  When
2823
the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
2824
breakpoint where your program just stopped.
2825
 
2826
@item clear @var{function}
2827
@itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
2828
Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the function @var{function}.
2829
 
2830
@item clear @var{linenum}
2831
@itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
2832
Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified line.
2833
 
2834
@cindex delete breakpoints
2835
@kindex delete
2836
@kindex d @r{(@code{delete})}
2837
@item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
2838
Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
2839
ranges specified as arguments.  If no argument is specified, delete all
2840
breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
2841
confirm off}).  You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
2842
@end table
2843
 
2844
@node Disabling
2845
@subsection Disabling breakpoints
2846
 
2847
@kindex disable breakpoints
2848
@kindex enable breakpoints
2849
Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
2850
prefer to @dfn{disable} it.  This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
2851
it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
2852
that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
2853
 
2854
You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
2855
the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying one
2856
or more breakpoint numbers as arguments.  Use @code{info break} or
2857
@code{info watch} to print a list of breakpoints, watchpoints, and
2858
catchpoints if you do not know which numbers to use.
2859
 
2860
A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of four different
2861
states of enablement:
2862
 
2863
@itemize @bullet
2864
@item
2865
Enabled.  The breakpoint stops your program.  A breakpoint set
2866
with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
2867
@item
2868
Disabled.  The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
2869
@item
2870
Enabled once.  The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
2871
disabled.
2872
@item
2873
Enabled for deletion.  The breakpoint stops your program, but
2874
immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently.  A breakpoint
2875
set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
2876
@end itemize
2877
 
2878
You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
2879
watchpoints, and catchpoints:
2880
 
2881
@table @code
2882
@kindex disable breakpoints
2883
@kindex disable
2884
@kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})}
2885
@item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
2886
Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
2887
listed.  A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten.  All
2888
options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
2889
case the breakpoint is enabled again later.  You may abbreviate
2890
@code{disable} as @code{dis}.
2891
 
2892
@kindex enable breakpoints
2893
@kindex enable
2894
@item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
2895
Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints).  They
2896
become effective once again in stopping your program.
2897
 
2898
@item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{range}@dots{}
2899
Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily.  @value{GDBN} disables any
2900
of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
2901
 
2902
@item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{range}@dots{}
2903
Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die.  @value{GDBN}
2904
deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
2905
@end table
2906
 
2907
@c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
2908
@c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
2909
Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
2910
,Setting breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
2911
subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
2912
the commands above.  (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
2913
breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
2914
breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
2915
stepping}.)
2916
 
2917
@node Conditions
2918
@subsection Break conditions
2919
@cindex conditional breakpoints
2920
@cindex breakpoint conditions
2921
 
2922
@c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr?  Context where wanted?
2923
@c      in particular for a watchpoint?
2924
The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
2925
specified place.  You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
2926
breakpoint.  A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
2927
programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).  A breakpoint with
2928
a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
2929
and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
2930
 
2931
This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
2932
situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
2933
when the condition is false.  In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
2934
by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
2935
@samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
2936
 
2937
Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
2938
since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
2939
it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
2940
and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
2941
one.
2942
 
2943
Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
2944
your program.  This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
2945
that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
2946
format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
2947
unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address.  (In
2948
that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
2949
program without checking the condition of this one.)  Note that
2950
breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
2951
conditions for the
2952
purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
2953
(@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint command lists}).
2954
 
2955
Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
2956
@samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command.  @xref{Set
2957
Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}.  They can also be changed at any time
2958
with the @code{condition} command.
2959
 
2960
You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
2961
The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
2962
@code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
2963
catchpoint.
2964
 
2965
@table @code
2966
@kindex condition
2967
@item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
2968
Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
2969
watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}.  After you set a condition,
2970
breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
2971
@var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C).  When you use
2972
@code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
2973
syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
2974
referents in the context of your breakpoint.  If @var{expression} uses
2975
symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
2976
prints an error message:
2977
 
2978
@example
2979
No symbol "foo" in current context.
2980
@end example
2981
 
2982
@noindent
2983
@value{GDBN} does
2984
not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
2985
command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
2986
@code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however.  @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
2987
 
2988
@item condition @var{bnum}
2989
Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}.  It becomes
2990
an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
2991
@end table
2992
 
2993
@cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
2994
A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
2995
breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times.  This is so
2996
useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
2997
count} of the breakpoint.  Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
2998
is an integer.  Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
2999
therefore has no effect.  But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
3000
ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
3001
the ignore count by one and continues.  As a result, if the ignore count
3002
value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
3003
your program reaches it.
3004
 
3005
@table @code
3006
@kindex ignore
3007
@item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
3008
Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
3009
The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
3010
execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
3011
takes no action.
3012
 
3013
To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
3014
a count of zero.
3015
 
3016
When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
3017
breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
3018
@code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}.  @xref{Continuing and
3019
Stepping,,Continuing and stepping}.
3020
 
3021
If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
3022
condition is not checked.  Once the ignore count reaches zero,
3023
@value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
3024
 
3025
You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
3026
as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
3027
is decremented each time.  @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
3028
variables}.
3029
@end table
3030
 
3031
Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
3032
 
3033
 
3034
@node Break Commands
3035
@subsection Breakpoint command lists
3036
 
3037
@cindex breakpoint commands
3038
You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
3039
commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint.  For
3040
example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
3041
enable other breakpoints.
3042
 
3043
@table @code
3044
@kindex commands
3045
@kindex end
3046
@item commands @r{[}@var{bnum}@r{]}
3047
@itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
3048
@itemx end
3049
Specify a list of commands for breakpoint number @var{bnum}.  The commands
3050
themselves appear on the following lines.  Type a line containing just
3051
@code{end} to terminate the commands.
3052
 
3053
To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
3054
follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
3055
 
3056
With no @var{bnum} argument, @code{commands} refers to the last
3057
breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most
3058
recently encountered).
3059
@end table
3060
 
3061
Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
3062
disabled within a @var{command-list}.
3063
 
3064
You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again.  Simply
3065
use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
3066
that resumes execution.
3067
 
3068
Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
3069
execution, are ignored.  This is because any time you resume execution
3070
(even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
3071
another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
3072
ambiguities about which list to execute.
3073
 
3074
@kindex silent
3075
If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
3076
usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed.  This may
3077
be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
3078
then continue.  If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
3079
see no sign that the breakpoint was reached.  @code{silent} is
3080
meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
3081
 
3082
The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
3083
print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
3084
breakpoints.  @xref{Output, ,Commands for controlled output}.
3085
 
3086
For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
3087
value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
3088
 
3089
@example
3090
break foo if x>0
3091
commands
3092
silent
3093
printf "x is %d\n",x
3094
cont
3095
end
3096
@end example
3097
 
3098
One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
3099
you can test for another.  Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
3100
of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
3101
erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
3102
to any variables that need them.  End with the @code{continue} command
3103
so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
3104
command so that no output is produced.  Here is an example:
3105
 
3106
@example
3107
break 403
3108
commands
3109
silent
3110
set x = y + 4
3111
cont
3112
end
3113
@end example
3114
 
3115
@node Breakpoint Menus
3116
@subsection Breakpoint menus
3117
@cindex overloading
3118
@cindex symbol overloading
3119
 
3120
Some programming languages (notably C@t{++}) permit a single function name
3121
to be defined several times, for application in different contexts.
3122
This is called @dfn{overloading}.  When a function name is overloaded,
3123
@samp{break @var{function}} is not enough to tell @value{GDBN} where you want
3124
a breakpoint.  If you realize this is a problem, you can use
3125
something like @samp{break @var{function}(@var{types})} to specify which
3126
particular version of the function you want.  Otherwise, @value{GDBN} offers
3127
you a menu of numbered choices for different possible breakpoints, and
3128
waits for your selection with the prompt @samp{>}.  The first two
3129
options are always @samp{[0] cancel} and @samp{[1] all}.  Typing @kbd{1}
3130
sets a breakpoint at each definition of @var{function}, and typing
3131
@kbd{0} aborts the @code{break} command without setting any new
3132
breakpoints.
3133
 
3134
For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
3135
breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
3136
We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
3137
 
3138
@c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
3139
@smallexample
3140
@group
3141
(@value{GDBP}) b String::after
3142
[0] cancel
3143
[1] all
3144
[2] file:String.cc; line number:867
3145
[3] file:String.cc; line number:860
3146
[4] file:String.cc; line number:875
3147
[5] file:String.cc; line number:853
3148
[6] file:String.cc; line number:846
3149
[7] file:String.cc; line number:735
3150
> 2 4 6
3151
Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
3152
Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
3153
Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
3154
Multiple breakpoints were set.
3155
Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
3156
 breakpoints.
3157
(@value{GDBP})
3158
@end group
3159
@end smallexample
3160
 
3161
@c  @ifclear BARETARGET
3162
@node Error in Breakpoints
3163
@subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
3164
@c
3165
@c  FIXME!! 14/6/95  Is there a real example of this?  Let's use it.
3166
@c
3167
Under some operating systems, breakpoints cannot be used in a program if
3168
any other process is running that program.  In this situation,
3169
attempting to run or continue a program with a breakpoint causes
3170
@value{GDBN} to print an error message:
3171
 
3172
@example
3173
Cannot insert breakpoints.
3174
The same program may be running in another process.
3175
@end example
3176
 
3177
When this happens, you have three ways to proceed:
3178
 
3179
@enumerate
3180
@item
3181
Remove or disable the breakpoints, then continue.
3182
 
3183
@item
3184
Suspend @value{GDBN}, and copy the file containing your program to a new
3185
name.  Resume @value{GDBN} and use the @code{exec-file} command to specify
3186
that @value{GDBN} should run your program under that name.
3187
Then start your program again.
3188
 
3189
@item
3190
Relink your program so that the text segment is nonsharable, using the
3191
linker option @samp{-N}.  The operating system limitation may not apply
3192
to nonsharable executables.
3193
@end enumerate
3194
@c  @end ifclear
3195
 
3196
A similar message can be printed if you request too many active
3197
hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints:
3198
 
3199
@c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
3200
@c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
3201
@smallexample
3202
Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
3203
You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
3204
@end smallexample
3205
 
3206
@noindent
3207
This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
3208
only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
3209
watchpoints it needs to insert.
3210
 
3211
When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
3212
hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
3213
 
3214
 
3215
@node Continuing and Stepping
3216
@section Continuing and stepping
3217
 
3218
@cindex stepping
3219
@cindex continuing
3220
@cindex resuming execution
3221
@dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
3222
completes normally.  In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
3223
one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
3224
line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
3225
particular command you use).  Either when continuing or when stepping,
3226
your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal.  (If
3227
it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
3228
@samp{signal 0} to resume execution.  @xref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
3229
 
3230
@table @code
3231
@kindex continue
3232
@kindex c @r{(@code{continue})}
3233
@kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)}
3234
@item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3235
@itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3236
@itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3237
Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
3238
any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed.  The optional argument
3239
@var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
3240
ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
3241
@code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}).
3242
 
3243
The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
3244
stopped due to a breakpoint.  At other times, the argument to
3245
@code{continue} is ignored.
3246
 
3247
The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
3248
debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
3249
purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
3250
@code{continue}.
3251
@end table
3252
 
3253
To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
3254
(@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a function}) to go back to the
3255
calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
3256
different address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
3257
 
3258
A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
3259
(@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; watchpoints; and catchpoints}) at the
3260
beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
3261
is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
3262
and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
3263
interesting, until you see the problem happen.
3264
 
3265
@table @code
3266
@kindex step
3267
@kindex s @r{(@code{step})}
3268
@item step
3269
Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
3270
line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}.  This command is
3271
abbreviated @code{s}.
3272
 
3273
@quotation
3274
@c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
3275
@c numbers in the debugging information".  (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
3276
@c not line numbers).  But it seems complex to try to make that
3277
@c distinction here.
3278
@emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
3279
within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
3280
execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
3281
debugging information.  Likewise, it will not step into a function which
3282
is compiled without debugging information.  To step through functions
3283
without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
3284
below.
3285
@end quotation
3286
 
3287
The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a source
3288
line.  This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
3289
@code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc.  @code{step} continues
3290
to stop if a function that has debugging information is called within
3291
the line.  In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions
3292
called within the line.
3293
 
3294
Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
3295
number information for the function.  Otherwise it acts like the
3296
@code{next} command.  This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
3297
on MIPS machines.  Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
3298
was any debugging information about the routine.
3299
 
3300
@item step @var{count}
3301
Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times.  If a
3302
breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
3303
@var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
3304
 
3305
@kindex next
3306
@kindex n @r{(@code{next})}
3307
@item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
3308
Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
3309
This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
3310
the line of code are executed without stopping.  Execution stops when
3311
control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
3312
that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command.  This command
3313
is abbreviated @code{n}.
3314
 
3315
An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
3316
 
3317
 
3318
@c  FIX ME!!  Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
3319
@c  the following paragraph?   ---  Vctoria
3320
@c
3321
@c  @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
3322
@c  @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
3323
@c  function are executed without stopping.
3324
 
3325
The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
3326
source line.  This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
3327
@code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc.
3328
 
3329
@kindex set step-mode
3330
@item set step-mode
3331
@cindex functions without line info, and stepping
3332
@cindex stepping into functions with no line info
3333
@itemx set step-mode on
3334
The @code{set step-mode on} command causes the @code{step} command to
3335
stop at the first instruction of a function which contains no debug line
3336
information rather than stepping over it.
3337
 
3338
This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the
3339
machine instructions of a function which has no symbolic info and do not
3340
want @value{GDBN} to automatically skip over this function.
3341
 
3342
@item set step-mode off
3343
Causes the @code{step} command to step over any functions which contains no
3344
debug information.  This is the default.
3345
 
3346
@kindex finish
3347
@item finish
3348
Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
3349
returns.  Print the returned value (if any).
3350
 
3351
Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
3352
,Returning from a function}).
3353
 
3354
@kindex until
3355
@kindex u @r{(@code{until})}
3356
@item until
3357
@itemx u
3358
Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
3359
current stack frame, is reached.  This command is used to avoid single
3360
stepping through a loop more than once.  It is like the @code{next}
3361
command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
3362
automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
3363
than the address of the jump.
3364
 
3365
This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
3366
though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
3367
exits the loop.  In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
3368
simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
3369
through the next iteration.
3370
 
3371
@code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
3372
stack frame.
3373
 
3374
@code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
3375
of machine code does not match the order of the source lines.  For
3376
example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
3377
(@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
3378
@code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
3379
 
3380
@example
3381
(@value{GDBP}) f
3382
#0  main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
3383
206                 expand_input();
3384
(@value{GDBP}) until
3385
195             for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
3386
@end example
3387
 
3388
This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
3389
generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
3390
start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
3391
written before the body of the loop.  The @code{until} command appeared
3392
to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
3393
expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
3394
statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
3395
 
3396
@code{until} with no argument works by means of single
3397
instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
3398
argument.
3399
 
3400
@item until @var{location}
3401
@itemx u @var{location}
3402
Continue running your program until either the specified location is
3403
reached, or the current stack frame returns.  @var{location} is any of
3404
the forms of argument acceptable to @code{break} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
3405
,Setting breakpoints}).  This form of the command uses breakpoints,
3406
and hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument.
3407
 
3408
@kindex stepi
3409
@kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})}
3410
@item stepi
3411
@itemx stepi @var{arg}
3412
@itemx si
3413
Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
3414
 
3415
It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
3416
instructions.  This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
3417
instruction to be executed, each time your program stops.  @xref{Auto
3418
Display,, Automatic display}.
3419
 
3420
An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
3421
 
3422
@need 750
3423
@kindex nexti
3424
@kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})}
3425
@item nexti
3426
@itemx nexti @var{arg}
3427
@itemx ni
3428
Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
3429
proceed until the function returns.
3430
 
3431
An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
3432
@end table
3433
 
3434
@node Signals
3435
@section Signals
3436
@cindex signals
3437
 
3438
A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program.  The
3439
operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
3440
kind a name and a number.  For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
3441
signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{C-c});
3442
@code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
3443
memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
3444
the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
3445
requested an alarm).
3446
 
3447
@cindex fatal signals
3448
Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
3449
functioning of your program.  Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
3450
errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
3451
program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
3452
@code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
3453
fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
3454
 
3455
@value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
3456
program.  You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
3457
signal.
3458
 
3459
@cindex handling signals
3460
Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to let the non-erroneous signals like
3461
@code{SIGALRM} be silently passed to your program
3462
(so as not to interfere with their role in the program's functioning)
3463
but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
3464
You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
3465
 
3466
@table @code
3467
@kindex info signals
3468
@item info signals
3469
@itemx info handle
3470
Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
3471
handle each one.  You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
3472
the defined types of signals.
3473
 
3474
@code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
3475
 
3476
@kindex handle
3477
@item handle @var{signal} @var{keywords}@dots{}
3478
Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}.  @var{signal}
3479
can be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the
3480
@samp{SIG} at the beginning); a list of signal numbers of the form
3481
@samp{@var{low}-@var{high}}; or the word @samp{all}, meaning all the
3482
known signals.  The @var{keywords} say what change to make.
3483
@end table
3484
 
3485
@c @group
3486
The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
3487
Their full names are:
3488
 
3489
@table @code
3490
@item nostop
3491
@value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens.  It may
3492
still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
3493
 
3494
@item stop
3495
@value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens.  This implies
3496
the @code{print} keyword as well.
3497
 
3498
@item print
3499
@value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
3500
 
3501
@item noprint
3502
@value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all.  This
3503
implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
3504
 
3505
@item pass
3506
@itemx noignore
3507
@value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
3508
can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
3509
and not handled.  @code{pass} and @code{noignore} are synonyms.
3510
 
3511
@item nopass
3512
@itemx ignore
3513
@value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
3514
@code{nopass} and @code{ignore} are synonyms.
3515
@end table
3516
@c @end group
3517
 
3518
When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
3519
program until you
3520
continue.  Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
3521
effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}.  In other words,
3522
after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
3523
command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
3524
program sees that signal when you continue.
3525
 
3526
The default is set to @code{nostop}, @code{noprint}, @code{pass} for
3527
non-erroneous signals such as @code{SIGALRM}, @code{SIGWINCH} and
3528
@code{SIGCHLD}, and to @code{stop}, @code{print}, @code{pass} for the
3529
erroneous signals.
3530
 
3531
You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
3532
seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
3533
or to give it any signal at any time.  For example, if your program stopped
3534
due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
3535
values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
3536
execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
3537
a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal.  To prevent this,
3538
you can continue with @samp{signal 0}.  @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
3539
program a signal}.
3540
 
3541
@node Thread Stops
3542
@section Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
3543
 
3544
When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
3545
programs with multiple threads}), you can choose whether to set
3546
breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
3547
 
3548
@table @code
3549
@cindex breakpoints and threads
3550
@cindex thread breakpoints
3551
@kindex break @dots{} thread @var{threadno}
3552
@item break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno}
3553
@itemx break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno} if @dots{}
3554
@var{linespec} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
3555
writing them, but the effect is always to specify some source line.
3556
 
3557
Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{threadno}} with a breakpoint command
3558
to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
3559
particular thread reaches this breakpoint.  @var{threadno} is one of the
3560
numeric thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
3561
column of the @samp{info threads} display.
3562
 
3563
If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{threadno}} when you set a
3564
breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
3565
program.
3566
 
3567
You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
3568
well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{threadno}} before the
3569
breakpoint condition, like this:
3570
 
3571
@smallexample
3572
(@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
3573
@end smallexample
3574
 
3575
@end table
3576
 
3577
@cindex stopped threads
3578
@cindex threads, stopped
3579
Whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
3580
@emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread.  This
3581
allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
3582
switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
3583
underfoot.
3584
 
3585
@cindex continuing threads
3586
@cindex threads, continuing
3587
Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
3588
executing.  @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
3589
like @code{step} or @code{next}.
3590
 
3591
In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
3592
Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
3593
system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
3594
execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
3595
single step.  Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
3596
statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
3597
stops.
3598
 
3599
You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
3600
continuing or even single-stepping.  This happens whenever some other
3601
thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
3602
first thread completes whatever you requested.
3603
 
3604
On some OSes, you can lock the OS scheduler and thus allow only a single
3605
thread to run.
3606
 
3607
@table @code
3608
@item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
3609
Set the scheduler locking mode.  If it is @code{off}, then there is no
3610
locking and any thread may run at any time.  If @code{on}, then only the
3611
current thread may run when the inferior is resumed.  The @code{step}
3612
mode optimizes for single-stepping.  It stops other threads from
3613
``seizing the prompt'' by preempting the current thread while you are
3614
stepping.  Other threads will only rarely (or never) get a chance to run
3615
when you step.  They are more likely to run when you @samp{next} over a
3616
function call, and they are completely free to run when you use commands
3617
like @samp{continue}, @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}.  However, unless another
3618
thread hits a breakpoint during its timeslice, they will never steal the
3619
@value{GDBN} prompt away from the thread that you are debugging.
3620
 
3621
@item show scheduler-locking
3622
Display the current scheduler locking mode.
3623
@end table
3624
 
3625
 
3626
@node Stack
3627
@chapter Examining the Stack
3628
 
3629
When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
3630
stopped and how it got there.
3631
 
3632
@cindex call stack
3633
Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
3634
is generated.
3635
That information includes the location of the call in your program,
3636
the arguments of the call,
3637
and the local variables of the function being called.
3638
The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
3639
The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
3640
stack}.
3641
 
3642
When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
3643
stack allow you to see all of this information.
3644
 
3645
@cindex selected frame
3646
One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
3647
@value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame.  In
3648
particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
3649
your program, the value is found in the selected frame.  There are
3650
special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
3651
interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
3652
 
3653
When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
3654
currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
3655
@code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a frame}).
3656
 
3657
@menu
3658
* Frames::                      Stack frames
3659
* Backtrace::                   Backtraces
3660
* Selection::                   Selecting a frame
3661
* Frame Info::                  Information on a frame
3662
 
3663
@end menu
3664
 
3665
@node Frames
3666
@section Stack frames
3667
 
3668
@cindex frame, definition
3669
@cindex stack frame
3670
The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
3671
frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
3672
with one call to one function.  The frame contains the arguments given
3673
to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
3674
which the function is executing.
3675
 
3676
@cindex initial frame
3677
@cindex outermost frame
3678
@cindex innermost frame
3679
When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
3680
function @code{main}.  This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
3681
@dfn{outermost} frame.  Each time a function is called, a new frame is
3682
made.  Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
3683
is eliminated.  If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
3684
the same function.  The frame for the function in which execution is
3685
actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame.  This is the most
3686
recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
3687
 
3688
@cindex frame pointer
3689
Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses.  A
3690
stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
3691
kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
3692
address serves as the address of the frame.  Usually this address is kept
3693
in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register} while execution is
3694
going on in that frame.
3695
 
3696
@cindex frame number
3697
@value{GDBN} assigns numbers to all existing stack frames, starting with
3698
zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that called it,
3699
and so on upward.  These numbers do not really exist in your program;
3700
they are assigned by @value{GDBN} to give you a way of designating stack
3701
frames in @value{GDBN} commands.
3702
 
3703
@c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow
3704
@c underflow problems.
3705
@cindex frameless execution
3706
Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
3707
without stack frames.  (For example, the @value{GCC} option
3708
@example
3709
@samp{-fomit-frame-pointer}
3710
@end example
3711
generates functions without a frame.)
3712
This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
3713
the frame setup time.  @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
3714
with these function invocations.  If the innermost function invocation
3715
has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
3716
it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
3717
correct tracing of the function call chain.  However, @value{GDBN} has
3718
no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
3719
 
3720
@table @code
3721
@kindex frame@r{, command}
3722
@cindex current stack frame
3723
@item frame @var{args}
3724
The @code{frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame to another,
3725
and to print the stack frame you select.  @var{args} may be either the
3726
address of the frame or the stack frame number.  Without an argument,
3727
@code{frame} prints the current stack frame.
3728
 
3729
@kindex select-frame
3730
@cindex selecting frame silently
3731
@item select-frame
3732
The @code{select-frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame
3733
to another without printing the frame.  This is the silent version of
3734
@code{frame}.
3735
@end table
3736
 
3737
@node Backtrace
3738
@section Backtraces
3739
 
3740
@cindex backtraces
3741
@cindex tracebacks
3742
@cindex stack traces
3743
A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is.  It shows one
3744
line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
3745
frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
3746
stack.
3747
 
3748
@table @code
3749
@kindex backtrace
3750
@kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})}
3751
@item backtrace
3752
@itemx bt
3753
Print a backtrace of the entire stack: one line per frame for all
3754
frames in the stack.
3755
 
3756
You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system interrupt
3757
character, normally @kbd{C-c}.
3758
 
3759
@item backtrace @var{n}
3760
@itemx bt @var{n}
3761
Similar, but print only the innermost @var{n} frames.
3762
 
3763
@item backtrace -@var{n}
3764
@itemx bt -@var{n}
3765
Similar, but print only the outermost @var{n} frames.
3766
@end table
3767
 
3768
@kindex where
3769
@kindex info stack
3770
@kindex info s @r{(@code{info stack})}
3771
The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
3772
are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
3773
 
3774
Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
3775
The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
3776
print address off}.  The backtrace also shows the source file name and
3777
line number, as well as the arguments to the function.  The program
3778
counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
3779
line number.
3780
 
3781
Here is an example of a backtrace.  It was made with the command
3782
@samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
3783
 
3784
@smallexample
3785
@group
3786
#0  m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
3787
    at builtin.c:993
3788
#1  0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600) at macro.c:242
3789
#2  0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
3790
    at macro.c:71
3791
(More stack frames follow...)
3792
@end group
3793
@end smallexample
3794
 
3795
@noindent
3796
The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
3797
value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
3798
code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
3799
 
3800
@node Selection
3801
@section Selecting a frame
3802
 
3803
Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
3804
whichever stack frame is selected at the moment.  Here are the commands for
3805
selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
3806
of the stack frame just selected.
3807
 
3808
@table @code
3809
@kindex frame@r{, selecting}
3810
@kindex f @r{(@code{frame})}
3811
@item frame @var{n}
3812
@itemx f @var{n}
3813
Select frame number @var{n}.  Recall that frame zero is the innermost
3814
(currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
3815
innermost one, and so on.  The highest-numbered frame is the one for
3816
@code{main}.
3817
 
3818
@item frame @var{addr}
3819
@itemx f @var{addr}
3820
Select the frame at address @var{addr}.  This is useful mainly if the
3821
chaining of stack frames has been damaged by a bug, making it
3822
impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign numbers properly to all frames.  In
3823
addition, this can be useful when your program has multiple stacks and
3824
switches between them.
3825
 
3826
On the SPARC architecture, @code{frame} needs two addresses to
3827
select an arbitrary frame: a frame pointer and a stack pointer.
3828
 
3829
On the MIPS and Alpha architecture, it needs two addresses: a stack
3830
pointer and a program counter.
3831
 
3832
On the 29k architecture, it needs three addresses: a register stack
3833
pointer, a program counter, and a memory stack pointer.
3834
@c note to future updaters: this is conditioned on a flag
3835
@c SETUP_ARBITRARY_FRAME in the tm-*.h files.  The above is up to date
3836
@c as of 27 Jan 1994.
3837
 
3838
@kindex up
3839
@item up @var{n}
3840
Move @var{n} frames up the stack.  For positive numbers @var{n}, this
3841
advances toward the outermost frame, to higher frame numbers, to frames
3842
that have existed longer.  @var{n} defaults to one.
3843
 
3844
@kindex down
3845
@kindex do @r{(@code{down})}
3846
@item down @var{n}
3847
Move @var{n} frames down the stack.  For positive numbers @var{n}, this
3848
advances toward the innermost frame, to lower frame numbers, to frames
3849
that were created more recently.  @var{n} defaults to one.  You may
3850
abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
3851
@end table
3852
 
3853
All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
3854
frame.  The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
3855
arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
3856
frame.  The second line shows the text of that source line.
3857
 
3858
@need 1000
3859
For example:
3860
 
3861
@smallexample
3862
@group
3863
(@value{GDBP}) up
3864
#1  0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
3865
    at env.c:10
3866
10              read_input_file (argv[i]);
3867
@end group
3868
@end smallexample
3869
 
3870
After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
3871
prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
3872
@xref{List, ,Printing source lines}.
3873
 
3874
@table @code
3875
@kindex down-silently
3876
@kindex up-silently
3877
@item up-silently @var{n}
3878
@itemx down-silently @var{n}
3879
These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
3880
respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
3881
causing display of the new frame.  They are intended primarily for use
3882
in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
3883
distracting.
3884
@end table
3885
 
3886
@node Frame Info
3887
@section Information about a frame
3888
 
3889
There are several other commands to print information about the selected
3890
stack frame.
3891
 
3892
@table @code
3893
@item frame
3894
@itemx f
3895
When used without any argument, this command does not change which
3896
frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
3897
selected stack frame.  It can be abbreviated @code{f}.  With an
3898
argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
3899
@xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
3900
 
3901
@kindex info frame
3902
@kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})}
3903
@item info frame
3904
@itemx info f
3905
This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
3906
including:
3907
 
3908
@itemize @bullet
3909
@item
3910
the address of the frame
3911
@item
3912
the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
3913
@item
3914
the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
3915
@item
3916
the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
3917
@item
3918
the address of the frame's arguments
3919
@item
3920
the address of the frame's local variables
3921
@item
3922
the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
3923
@item
3924
which registers were saved in the frame
3925
@end itemize
3926
 
3927
@noindent The verbose description is useful when
3928
something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
3929
the usual conventions.
3930
 
3931
@item info frame @var{addr}
3932
@itemx info f @var{addr}
3933
Print a verbose description of the frame at address @var{addr}, without
3934
selecting that frame.  The selected frame remains unchanged by this
3935
command.  This requires the same kind of address (more than one for some
3936
architectures) that you specify in the @code{frame} command.
3937
@xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
3938
 
3939
@kindex info args
3940
@item info args
3941
Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
3942
 
3943
@item info locals
3944
@kindex info locals
3945
Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
3946
line.  These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
3947
accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
3948
 
3949
@kindex info catch
3950
@cindex catch exceptions, list active handlers
3951
@cindex exception handlers, how to list
3952
@item info catch
3953
Print a list of all the exception handlers that are active in the
3954
current stack frame at the current point of execution.  To see other
3955
exception handlers, visit the associated frame (using the @code{up},
3956
@code{down}, or @code{frame} commands); then type @code{info catch}.
3957
@xref{Set Catchpoints, , Setting catchpoints}.
3958
 
3959
@end table
3960
 
3961
 
3962
@node Source
3963
@chapter Examining Source Files
3964
 
3965
@value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
3966
information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
3967
used to build it.  When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
3968
the line where it stopped.  Likewise, when you select a stack frame
3969
(@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
3970
execution in that frame has stopped.  You can print other portions of
3971
source files by explicit command.
3972
 
3973
If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
3974
prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
3975
@value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
3976
 
3977
@menu
3978
* List::                        Printing source lines
3979
* Search::                      Searching source files
3980
* Source Path::                 Specifying source directories
3981
* Machine Code::                Source and machine code
3982
@end menu
3983
 
3984
@node List
3985
@section Printing source lines
3986
 
3987
@kindex list
3988
@kindex l @r{(@code{list})}
3989
To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
3990
(abbreviated @code{l}).  By default, ten lines are printed.
3991
There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to print.
3992
 
3993
Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
3994
 
3995
@table @code
3996
@item list @var{linenum}
3997
Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
3998
current source file.
3999
 
4000
@item list @var{function}
4001
Print lines centered around the beginning of function
4002
@var{function}.
4003
 
4004
@item list
4005
Print more lines.  If the last lines printed were printed with a
4006
@code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
4007
printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
4008
as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
4009
Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
4010
 
4011
@item list -
4012
Print lines just before the lines last printed.
4013
@end table
4014
 
4015
By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
4016
the @code{list} command.  You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
4017
 
4018
@table @code
4019
@kindex set listsize
4020
@item set listsize @var{count}
4021
Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
4022
the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
4023
 
4024
@kindex show listsize
4025
@item show listsize
4026
Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
4027
@end table
4028
 
4029
Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
4030
so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}.  This is more useful
4031
than listing the same lines again.  An exception is made for an
4032
argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
4033
each repetition moves up in the source file.
4034
 
4035
@cindex linespec
4036
In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
4037
@dfn{linespecs}.  Linespecs specify source lines; there are several ways
4038
of writing them, but the effect is always to specify some source line.
4039
Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
4040
 
4041
@table @code
4042
@item list @var{linespec}
4043
Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{linespec}.
4044
 
4045
@item list @var{first},@var{last}
4046
Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}.  Both arguments are
4047
linespecs.
4048
 
4049
@item list ,@var{last}
4050
Print lines ending with @var{last}.
4051
 
4052
@item list @var{first},
4053
Print lines starting with @var{first}.
4054
 
4055
@item list +
4056
Print lines just after the lines last printed.
4057
 
4058
@item list -
4059
Print lines just before the lines last printed.
4060
 
4061
@item list
4062
As described in the preceding table.
4063
@end table
4064
 
4065
Here are the ways of specifying a single source line---all the
4066
kinds of linespec.
4067
 
4068
@table @code
4069
@item @var{number}
4070
Specifies line @var{number} of the current source file.
4071
When a @code{list} command has two linespecs, this refers to
4072
the same source file as the first linespec.
4073
 
4074
@item +@var{offset}
4075
Specifies the line @var{offset} lines after the last line printed.
4076
When used as the second linespec in a @code{list} command that has
4077
two, this specifies the line @var{offset} lines down from the
4078
first linespec.
4079
 
4080
@item -@var{offset}
4081
Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before the last line printed.
4082
 
4083
@item @var{filename}:@var{number}
4084
Specifies line @var{number} in the source file @var{filename}.
4085
 
4086
@item @var{function}
4087
Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
4088
For example: in C, this is the line with the open brace.
4089
 
4090
@item @var{filename}:@var{function}
4091
Specifies the line of the open-brace that begins the body of the
4092
function @var{function} in the file @var{filename}.  You only need the
4093
file name with a function name to avoid ambiguity when there are
4094
identically named functions in different source files.
4095
 
4096
@item *@var{address}
4097
Specifies the line containing the program address @var{address}.
4098
@var{address} may be any expression.
4099
@end table
4100
 
4101
@node Search
4102
@section Searching source files
4103
@cindex searching
4104
@kindex reverse-search
4105
 
4106
There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
4107
regular expression.
4108
 
4109
@table @code
4110
@kindex search
4111
@kindex forward-search
4112
@item forward-search @var{regexp}
4113
@itemx search @var{regexp}
4114
The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
4115
starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
4116
@var{regexp}.  It lists the line that is found.  You can use the
4117
synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
4118
@code{fo}.
4119
 
4120
@item reverse-search @var{regexp}
4121
The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
4122
with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
4123
for @var{regexp}.  It lists the line that is found.  You can abbreviate
4124
this command as @code{rev}.
4125
@end table
4126
 
4127
@node Source Path
4128
@section Specifying source directories
4129
 
4130
@cindex source path
4131
@cindex directories for source files
4132
Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
4133
files from which they were compiled, just the names.  Even when they do,
4134
the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
4135
session.  @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
4136
this is called the @dfn{source path}.  Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
4137
it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
4138
in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name.  Note that
4139
the executable search path is @emph{not} used for this purpose.  Neither is
4140
the current working directory, unless it happens to be in the source
4141
path.
4142
 
4143
If @value{GDBN} cannot find a source file in the source path, and the
4144
object program records a directory, @value{GDBN} tries that directory
4145
too.  If the source path is empty, and there is no record of the
4146
compilation directory, @value{GDBN} looks in the current directory as a
4147
last resort.
4148
 
4149
Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
4150
any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
4151
each line is in the file.
4152
 
4153
@kindex directory
4154
@kindex dir
4155
When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
4156
and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
4157
To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
4158
 
4159
@table @code
4160
@item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
4161
@item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
4162
Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path.  Several
4163
directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
4164
(@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
4165
part of absolute file names) or
4166
whitespace.  You may specify a directory that is already in the source
4167
path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
4168
 
4169
@kindex cdir
4170
@kindex cwd
4171
@vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable}
4172
@vindex $cwdr@r{, convenience variable}
4173
@cindex compilation directory
4174
@cindex current directory
4175
@cindex working directory
4176
@cindex directory, current
4177
@cindex directory, compilation
4178
You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
4179
directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
4180
working directory.  @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
4181
tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
4182
session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
4183
directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
4184
 
4185
@item directory
4186
Reset the source path to empty again.  This requires confirmation.
4187
 
4188
@c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
4189
@c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that.  (thanks to RMS)
4190
 
4191
@item show directories
4192
@kindex show directories
4193
Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
4194
@end table
4195
 
4196
If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
4197
interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
4198
versions of source.  You can correct the situation as follows:
4199
 
4200
@enumerate
4201
@item
4202
Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to empty.
4203
 
4204
@item
4205
Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
4206
directories you want in the source path.  You can add all the
4207
directories in one command.
4208
@end enumerate
4209
 
4210
@node Machine Code
4211
@section Source and machine code
4212
 
4213
You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
4214
addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
4215
a range of addresses as machine instructions.  When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
4216
mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
4217
line specified.  Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
4218
well as hex.
4219
 
4220
@table @code
4221
@kindex info line
4222
@item info line @var{linespec}
4223
Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
4224
source line @var{linespec}.  You can specify source lines in any of
4225
the ways understood by the @code{list} command (@pxref{List, ,Printing
4226
source lines}).
4227
@end table
4228
 
4229
For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
4230
the object code for the first line of function
4231
@code{m4_changequote}:
4232
 
4233
@c FIXME: I think this example should also show the addresses in
4234
@c symbolic form, as they usually would be displayed.
4235
@smallexample
4236
(@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote
4237
Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c and ends at 0x6350.
4238
@end smallexample
4239
 
4240
@noindent
4241
We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
4242
@var{linespec}) what source line covers a particular address:
4243
@smallexample
4244
(@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
4245
Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 and ends at 0x6404.
4246
@end smallexample
4247
 
4248
@cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
4249
@kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line
4250
After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
4251
is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
4252
sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
4253
,Examining memory}).  Also, this address is saved as the value of the
4254
convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
4255
variables}).
4256
 
4257
@table @code
4258
@kindex disassemble
4259
@cindex assembly instructions
4260
@cindex instructions, assembly
4261
@cindex machine instructions
4262
@cindex listing machine instructions
4263
@item disassemble
4264
This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
4265
instructions.  The default memory range is the function surrounding the
4266
program counter of the selected frame.  A single argument to this
4267
command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
4268
surrounding this value.  Two arguments specify a range of addresses
4269
(first inclusive, second exclusive) to dump.
4270
@end table
4271
 
4272
The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
4273
HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
4274
 
4275
@smallexample
4276
(@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4 0x32e4
4277
Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
4278
0x32c4 <main+204>:      addil 0,dp
4279
0x32c8 <main+208>:      ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
4280
0x32cc <main+212>:      ldil 0x3000,r31
4281
0x32d0 <main+216>:      ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
4282
0x32d4 <main+220>:      ldo 0(r31),rp
4283
0x32d8 <main+224>:      addil -0x800,dp
4284
0x32dc <main+228>:      ldo 0x588(r1),r26
4285
0x32e0 <main+232>:      ldil 0x3000,r31
4286
End of assembler dump.
4287
@end smallexample
4288
 
4289
Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
4290
mnemonics or other syntax.
4291
 
4292
@table @code
4293
@kindex set disassembly-flavor
4294
@cindex assembly instructions
4295
@cindex instructions, assembly
4296
@cindex machine instructions
4297
@cindex listing machine instructions
4298
@cindex Intel disassembly flavor
4299
@cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
4300
@item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
4301
Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
4302
program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
4303
 
4304
Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family.  You
4305
can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
4306
The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
4307
assemblers for x86-based targets.
4308
@end table
4309
 
4310
 
4311
@node Data
4312
@chapter Examining Data
4313
 
4314
@cindex printing data
4315
@cindex examining data
4316
@kindex print
4317
@kindex inspect
4318
@c "inspect" is not quite a synonym if you are using Epoch, which we do not
4319
@c document because it is nonstandard...  Under Epoch it displays in a
4320
@c different window or something like that.
4321
The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
4322
command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}.  It
4323
evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
4324
program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
4325
Different Languages}).
4326
 
4327
@table @code
4328
@item print @var{expr}
4329
@itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr}
4330
@var{expr} is an expression (in the source language).  By default the
4331
value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
4332
you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
4333
@var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
4334
formats}.
4335
 
4336
@item print
4337
@itemx print /@var{f}
4338
If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
4339
@dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value history}).  This allows you to
4340
conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
4341
@end table
4342
 
4343
A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
4344
It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
4345
specified format.  @xref{Memory, ,Examining memory}.
4346
 
4347
If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
4348
fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
4349
command rather than @code{print}.  @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
4350
Table}.
4351
 
4352
@menu
4353
* Expressions::                 Expressions
4354
* Variables::                   Program variables
4355
* Arrays::                      Artificial arrays
4356
* Output Formats::              Output formats
4357
* Memory::                      Examining memory
4358
* Auto Display::                Automatic display
4359
* Print Settings::              Print settings
4360
* Value History::               Value history
4361
* Convenience Vars::            Convenience variables
4362
* Registers::                   Registers
4363
* Floating Point Hardware::     Floating point hardware
4364
* Memory Region Attributes::    Memory region attributes
4365
@end menu
4366
 
4367
@node Expressions
4368
@section Expressions
4369
 
4370
@cindex expressions
4371
@code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
4372
compute its value.  Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
4373
by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
4374
@value{GDBN}.  This includes conditional expressions, function calls, casts
4375
and string constants.  It unfortunately does not include symbols defined
4376
by preprocessor @code{#define} commands.
4377
 
4378
@value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
4379
the user.  The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}.  For example,
4380
you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to build up an array in
4381
memory that is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
4382
 
4383
Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
4384
this manual are in C.  @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
4385
Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
4386
languages.
4387
 
4388
In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
4389
expressions regardless of your programming language.
4390
 
4391
Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
4392
useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
4393
at that address in memory.
4394
@c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
4395
 
4396
@value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
4397
to programming languages:
4398
 
4399
@table @code
4400
@item @@
4401
@samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
4402
@xref{Arrays, ,Artificial arrays}, for more information.
4403
 
4404
@item ::
4405
@samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
4406
function where it is defined.  @xref{Variables, ,Program variables}.
4407
 
4408
@cindex @{@var{type}@}
4409
@cindex type casting memory
4410
@cindex memory, viewing as typed object
4411
@cindex casts, to view memory
4412
@item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
4413
Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
4414
memory.  @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is an integer or
4415
pointer (but parentheses are required around binary operators, just as in
4416
a cast).  This construct is allowed regardless of what kind of data is
4417
normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
4418
@end table
4419
 
4420
@node Variables
4421
@section Program variables
4422
 
4423
The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
4424
in your program.
4425
 
4426
Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
4427
(@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}); they must be either:
4428
 
4429
@itemize @bullet
4430
@item
4431
global (or file-static)
4432
@end itemize
4433
 
4434
@noindent or
4435
 
4436
@itemize @bullet
4437
@item
4438
visible according to the scope rules of the
4439
programming language from the point of execution in that frame
4440
@end itemize
4441
 
4442
@noindent This means that in the function
4443
 
4444
@example
4445
foo (a)
4446
     int a;
4447
@{
4448
  bar (a);
4449
  @{
4450
    int b = test ();
4451
    bar (b);
4452
  @}
4453
@}
4454
@end example
4455
 
4456
@noindent
4457
you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
4458
executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
4459
examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
4460
the block where @code{b} is declared.
4461
 
4462
@cindex variable name conflict
4463
There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
4464
scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
4465
in this file.  But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
4466
function with the same name (in different source files).  If that
4467
happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects.  If you wish,
4468
you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file,
4469
using the colon-colon notation:
4470
 
4471
@cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
4472
@iftex
4473
@c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
4474
@cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions
4475
@end iftex
4476
@example
4477
@var{file}::@var{variable}
4478
@var{function}::@var{variable}
4479
@end example
4480
 
4481
@noindent
4482
Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
4483
static @var{variable}.  In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
4484
make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
4485
to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
4486
 
4487
@example
4488
(@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
4489
@end example
4490
 
4491
@cindex C@t{++} scope resolution
4492
This use of @samp{::} is very rarely in conflict with the very similar
4493
use of the same notation in C@t{++}.  @value{GDBN} also supports use of the C@t{++}
4494
scope resolution operator in @value{GDBN} expressions.
4495
@c FIXME: Um, so what happens in one of those rare cases where it's in
4496
@c conflict??  --mew
4497
 
4498
@cindex wrong values
4499
@cindex variable values, wrong
4500
@quotation
4501
@emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
4502
wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
4503
scope, and just before exit.
4504
@end quotation
4505
You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
4506
This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
4507
set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
4508
stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
4509
values until the stack frame is completely built.  On exit, it usually
4510
also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
4511
after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
4512
variable definitions may be gone.
4513
 
4514
This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
4515
To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
4516
when compiling.
4517
 
4518
@cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
4519
Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
4520
unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
4521
opposed to memory addresses).  Depending on the support for such cases
4522
offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
4523
might not be able to display values for such local variables.  If that
4524
happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
4525
 
4526
@example
4527
No symbol "foo" in current context.
4528
@end example
4529
 
4530
To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
4531
different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
4532
formats.  For example, @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler usually
4533
supports the @samp{-gstabs} option.  @samp{-gstabs} produces debug info
4534
in a format that is superior to formats such as COFF.  You may be able
4535
to use DWARF2 (@samp{-gdwarf-2}), which is also an effective form for
4536
debug info.  See @ref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your
4537
Program or @sc{gnu} CC, gcc.info, Using @sc{gnu} CC}, for more
4538
information.
4539
 
4540
 
4541
@node Arrays
4542
@section Artificial arrays
4543
 
4544
@cindex artificial array
4545
@kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array}
4546
It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
4547
same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
4548
dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
4549
program.
4550
 
4551
You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
4552
@dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}.  The left
4553
operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
4554
and be an individual object.  The right operand should be the desired length
4555
of the array.  The result is an array value whose elements are all of
4556
the type of the left argument.  The first element is actually the left
4557
argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
4558
following those that hold the first element, and so on.  Here is an
4559
example.  If a program says
4560
 
4561
@example
4562
int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
4563
@end example
4564
 
4565
@noindent
4566
you can print the contents of @code{array} with
4567
 
4568
@example
4569
p *array@@len
4570
@end example
4571
 
4572
The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory.  Array values made
4573
with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
4574
subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
4575
Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
4576
(@pxref{Value History, ,Value history}), after printing one out.
4577
 
4578
Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
4579
This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
4580
The value need not be in memory:
4581
@example
4582
(@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
4583
$1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
4584
@end example
4585
 
4586
As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
4587
@samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
4588
the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
4589
@example
4590
(@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
4591
$2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
4592
@end example
4593
 
4594
Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
4595
moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
4596
actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
4597
of pointers in an array.  One useful work-around in this situation is
4598
to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
4599
variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
4600
interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}.  For
4601
instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
4602
structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
4603
in each structure.  Here is an example of what you might type:
4604
 
4605
@example
4606
set $i = 0
4607
p dtab[$i++]->fv
4608
@key{RET}
4609
@key{RET}
4610
@dots{}
4611
@end example
4612
 
4613
@node Output Formats
4614
@section Output formats
4615
 
4616
@cindex formatted output
4617
@cindex output formats
4618
By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type.  Sometimes
4619
this is not what you want.  For example, you might want to print a number
4620
in hex, or a pointer in decimal.  Or you might want to view data in memory
4621
at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction.  To do
4622
these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
4623
 
4624
The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
4625
already computed.  This is done by starting the arguments of the
4626
@code{print} command with a slash and a format letter.  The format
4627
letters supported are:
4628
 
4629
@table @code
4630
@item x
4631
Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
4632
hexadecimal.
4633
 
4634
@item d
4635
Print as integer in signed decimal.
4636
 
4637
@item u
4638
Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
4639
 
4640
@item o
4641
Print as integer in octal.
4642
 
4643
@item t
4644
Print as integer in binary.  The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
4645
@footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
4646
used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
4647
see @ref{Memory,,Examining memory}.}
4648
 
4649
@item a
4650
@cindex unknown address, locating
4651
@cindex locate address
4652
Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
4653
the nearest preceding symbol.  You can use this format used to discover
4654
where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
4655
 
4656
@example
4657
(@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
4658
$3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
4659
@end example
4660
 
4661
@noindent
4662
The command @code{info symbol 0x54320} yields similar results.
4663
@xref{Symbols, info symbol}.
4664
 
4665
@item c
4666
Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant.
4667
 
4668
@item f
4669
Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
4670
using typical floating point syntax.
4671
@end table
4672
 
4673
For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
4674
 
4675
@example
4676
p/x $pc
4677
@end example
4678
 
4679
@noindent
4680
Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
4681
names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
4682
 
4683
To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
4684
you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
4685
expression.  For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
4686
 
4687
@node Memory
4688
@section Examining memory
4689
 
4690
You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
4691
any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
4692
 
4693
@cindex examining memory
4694
@table @code
4695
@kindex x @r{(examine memory)}
4696
@item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
4697
@itemx x @var{addr}
4698
@itemx x
4699
Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
4700
@end table
4701
 
4702
@var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
4703
much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
4704
expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
4705
If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
4706
Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
4707
 
4708
@table @r
4709
@item @var{n}, the repeat count
4710
The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1.  It specifies
4711
how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display.
4712
@c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
4713
@c 4.1.2.
4714
 
4715
@item @var{f}, the display format
4716
The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print},
4717
@samp{s} (null-terminated string), or @samp{i} (machine instruction).
4718
The default is @samp{x} (hexadecimal) initially.
4719
The default changes each time you use either @code{x} or @code{print}.
4720
 
4721
@item @var{u}, the unit size
4722
The unit size is any of
4723
 
4724
@table @code
4725
@item b
4726
Bytes.
4727
@item h
4728
Halfwords (two bytes).
4729
@item w
4730
Words (four bytes).  This is the initial default.
4731
@item g
4732
Giant words (eight bytes).
4733
@end table
4734
 
4735
Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
4736
default unit the next time you use @code{x}.  (For the @samp{s} and
4737
@samp{i} formats, the unit size is ignored and is normally not written.)
4738
 
4739
@item @var{addr}, starting display address
4740
@var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
4741
memory.  The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
4742
it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
4743
@xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions.  The default for
4744
@var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
4745
other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
4746
the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
4747
starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
4748
a value from memory).
4749
@end table
4750
 
4751
For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
4752
(@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
4753
starting at address @code{0x54320}.  @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
4754
words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
4755
@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
4756
 
4757
Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
4758
letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
4759
unit size or format comes first; either order works.  The output
4760
specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
4761
(However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
4762
 
4763
Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
4764
and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
4765
@samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
4766
including any operands.  The command @code{disassemble} gives an
4767
alternative way of inspecting machine instructions; see @ref{Machine
4768
Code,,Source and machine code}.
4769
 
4770
All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
4771
easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
4772
you use @code{x}.  For example, after you have inspected three machine
4773
instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
4774
with just @samp{x/7}.  If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
4775
the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
4776
for successive uses of @code{x}.
4777
 
4778
@cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
4779
The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
4780
in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
4781
would get in the way.  Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
4782
subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
4783
@code{$_} and @code{$__}.  After an @code{x} command, the last address
4784
examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
4785
@code{$_}.  The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
4786
the convenience variable @code{$__}.
4787
 
4788
If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
4789
are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
4790
address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
4791
 
4792
@node Auto Display
4793
@section Automatic display
4794
@cindex automatic display
4795
@cindex display of expressions
4796
 
4797
If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
4798
(to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
4799
display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
4800
Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
4801
to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
4802
The automatic display looks like this:
4803
 
4804
@example
4805
2: foo = 38
4806
3: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
4807
@end example
4808
 
4809
@noindent
4810
This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values.  As with
4811
displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
4812
specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
4813
whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending on how elaborate your
4814
format specification is---it uses @code{x} if you specify a unit size,
4815
or one of the two formats (@samp{i} and @samp{s}) that are only
4816
supported by @code{x}; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
4817
 
4818
@table @code
4819
@kindex display
4820
@item display @var{expr}
4821
Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
4822
each time your program stops.  @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
4823
 
4824
@code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
4825
 
4826
@item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
4827
For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
4828
count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
4829
arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
4830
@xref{Output Formats,,Output formats}.
4831
 
4832
@item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
4833
For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
4834
number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
4835
be examined each time your program stops.  Examining means in effect
4836
doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}.  @xref{Memory, ,Examining memory}.
4837
@end table
4838
 
4839
For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
4840
instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
4841
is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
4842
 
4843
@table @code
4844
@kindex delete display
4845
@kindex undisplay
4846
@item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
4847
@itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
4848
Remove item numbers @var{dnums} from the list of expressions to display.
4849
 
4850
@code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
4851
(Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
4852
 
4853
@kindex disable display
4854
@item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
4855
Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}.  A disabled display
4856
item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten.  It may be
4857
enabled again later.
4858
 
4859
@kindex enable display
4860
@item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
4861
Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}.  It becomes effective once
4862
again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
4863
 
4864
@item display
4865
Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
4866
done when your program stops.
4867
 
4868
@kindex info display
4869
@item info display
4870
Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
4871
automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
4872
values.  This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
4873
It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
4874
because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
4875
@end table
4876
 
4877
If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
4878
sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up.  Such an
4879
expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
4880
variables is not defined.  For example, if you give the command
4881
@code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
4882
@code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
4883
continues to stop inside that function.  When it stops elsewhere---where
4884
there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
4885
automatically.  The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
4886
is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
4887
 
4888
@node Print Settings
4889
@section Print settings
4890
 
4891
@cindex format options
4892
@cindex print settings
4893
@value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
4894
and symbols are printed.
4895
 
4896
@noindent
4897
These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
4898
 
4899
@table @code
4900
@kindex set print address
4901
@item set print address
4902
@itemx set print address on
4903
@value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
4904
traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
4905
even when it also displays the contents of those addresses.  The default
4906
is @code{on}.  For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
4907
@code{set print address on}:
4908
 
4909
@smallexample
4910
@group
4911
(@value{GDBP}) f
4912
#0  set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
4913
    at input.c:530
4914
530         if (lquote != def_lquote)
4915
@end group
4916
@end smallexample
4917
 
4918
@item set print address off
4919
Do not print addresses when displaying their contents.  For example,
4920
this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
4921
 
4922
@smallexample
4923
@group
4924
(@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
4925
(@value{GDBP}) f
4926
#0  set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
4927
530         if (lquote != def_lquote)
4928
@end group
4929
@end smallexample
4930
 
4931
You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
4932
dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface.  For example, with
4933
@code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
4934
all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
4935
 
4936
@kindex show print address
4937
@item show print address
4938
Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
4939
@end table
4940
 
4941
When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
4942
closest earlier symbol plus an offset.  If that symbol does not uniquely
4943
identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
4944
source file), you may need to clarify.  One way to do this is with
4945
@code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}.  Alternately,
4946
you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
4947
it prints a symbolic address:
4948
 
4949
@table @code
4950
@kindex set print symbol-filename
4951
@item set print symbol-filename on
4952
Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
4953
symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
4954
 
4955
@item set print symbol-filename off
4956
Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol.  This is the
4957
default.
4958
 
4959
@kindex show print symbol-filename
4960
@item show print symbol-filename
4961
Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
4962
line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
4963
@end table
4964
 
4965
Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
4966
numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
4967
number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
4968
 
4969
Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
4970
printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
4971
 
4972
@table @code
4973
@kindex set print max-symbolic-offset
4974
@item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
4975
Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
4976
offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
4977
@var{max-offset}.  The default is 0, which tells @value{GDBN}
4978
to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes it.
4979
 
4980
@kindex show print max-symbolic-offset
4981
@item show print max-symbolic-offset
4982
Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
4983
symbolic address.
4984
@end table
4985
 
4986
@cindex wild pointer, interpreting
4987
@cindex pointer, finding referent
4988
If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
4989
@samp{set print symbol-filename on}.  Then you can determine the name
4990
and source file location of the variable where it points, using
4991
@samp{p/a @var{pointer}}.  This interprets the address in symbolic form.
4992
For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
4993
at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
4994
 
4995
@example
4996
(@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
4997
(@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
4998
$4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
4999
@end example
5000
 
5001
@quotation
5002
@emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
5003
does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
5004
the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
5005
@end quotation
5006
 
5007
Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
5008
 
5009
@table @code
5010
@kindex set print array
5011
@item set print array
5012
@itemx set print array on
5013
Pretty print arrays.  This format is more convenient to read,
5014
but uses more space.  The default is off.
5015
 
5016
@item set print array off
5017
Return to compressed format for arrays.
5018
 
5019
@kindex show print array
5020
@item show print array
5021
Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
5022
arrays.
5023
 
5024
@kindex set print elements
5025
@item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
5026
Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
5027
If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
5028
printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
5029
This limit also applies to the display of strings.
5030
When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
5031
Setting  @var{number-of-elements} to zero means that the printing is unlimited.
5032
 
5033
@kindex show print elements
5034
@item show print elements
5035
Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
5036
If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
5037
 
5038
@kindex set print null-stop
5039
@item set print null-stop
5040
Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
5041
@sc{null} is encountered.  This is useful when large arrays actually
5042
contain only short strings.
5043
The default is off.
5044
 
5045
@kindex set print pretty
5046
@item set print pretty on
5047
Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
5048
per line, like this:
5049
 
5050
@smallexample
5051
@group
5052
$1 = @{
5053
  next = 0x0,
5054
  flags = @{
5055
    sweet = 1,
5056
    sour = 1
5057
  @},
5058
  meat = 0x54 "Pork"
5059
@}
5060
@end group
5061
@end smallexample
5062
 
5063
@item set print pretty off
5064
Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
5065
 
5066
@smallexample
5067
@group
5068
$1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
5069
meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
5070
@end group
5071
@end smallexample
5072
 
5073
@noindent
5074
This is the default format.
5075
 
5076
@kindex show print pretty
5077
@item show print pretty
5078
Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
5079
 
5080
@kindex set print sevenbit-strings
5081
@item set print sevenbit-strings on
5082
Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
5083
@value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
5084
character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}.  This setting is
5085
best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
5086
high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
5087
 
5088
@item set print sevenbit-strings off
5089
Print full eight-bit characters.  This allows the use of more
5090
international character sets, and is the default.
5091
 
5092
@kindex show print sevenbit-strings
5093
@item show print sevenbit-strings
5094
Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
5095
 
5096
@kindex set print union
5097
@item set print union on
5098
Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures.  This
5099
is the default setting.
5100
 
5101
@item set print union off
5102
Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in structures.
5103
 
5104
@kindex show print union
5105
@item show print union
5106
Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
5107
structures.
5108
 
5109
For example, given the declarations
5110
 
5111
@smallexample
5112
typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
5113
typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
5114
typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
5115
              Bug_forms;
5116
 
5117
struct thing @{
5118
  Species it;
5119
  union @{
5120
    Tree_forms tree;
5121
    Bug_forms bug;
5122
  @} form;
5123
@};
5124
 
5125
struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
5126
@end smallexample
5127
 
5128
@noindent
5129
with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
5130
 
5131
@smallexample
5132
$1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
5133
@end smallexample
5134
 
5135
@noindent
5136
and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
5137
 
5138
@smallexample
5139
$1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
5140
@end smallexample
5141
@end table
5142
 
5143
@need 1000
5144
@noindent
5145
These settings are of interest when debugging C@t{++} programs:
5146
 
5147
@table @code
5148
@cindex demangling
5149
@kindex set print demangle
5150
@item set print demangle
5151
@itemx set print demangle on
5152
Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than in the encoded
5153
(``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
5154
linkage.  The default is on.
5155
 
5156
@kindex show print demangle
5157
@item show print demangle
5158
Show whether C@t{++} names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
5159
 
5160
@kindex set print asm-demangle
5161
@item set print asm-demangle
5162
@itemx set print asm-demangle on
5163
Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
5164
in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
5165
The default is off.
5166
 
5167
@kindex show print asm-demangle
5168
@item show print asm-demangle
5169
Show whether C@t{++} names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
5170
or demangled form.
5171
 
5172
@kindex set demangle-style
5173
@cindex C@t{++} symbol decoding style
5174
@cindex symbol decoding style, C@t{++}
5175
@item set demangle-style @var{style}
5176
Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to
5177
represent C@t{++} names.  The choices for @var{style} are currently:
5178
 
5179
@table @code
5180
@item auto
5181
Allow @value{GDBN} to choose a decoding style by inspecting your program.
5182
 
5183
@item gnu
5184
Decode based on the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler (@code{g++}) encoding algorithm.
5185
This is the default.
5186
 
5187
@item hp
5188
Decode based on the HP ANSI C@t{++} (@code{aCC}) encoding algorithm.
5189
 
5190
@item lucid
5191
Decode based on the Lucid C@t{++} compiler (@code{lcc}) encoding algorithm.
5192
 
5193
@item arm
5194
Decode using the algorithm in the @cite{C@t{++} Annotated Reference Manual}.
5195
@strong{Warning:} this setting alone is not sufficient to allow
5196
debugging @code{cfront}-generated executables.  @value{GDBN} would
5197
require further enhancement to permit that.
5198
 
5199
@end table
5200
If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible formats.
5201
 
5202
@kindex show demangle-style
5203
@item show demangle-style
5204
Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C@t{++} symbols.
5205
 
5206
@kindex set print object
5207
@item set print object
5208
@itemx set print object on
5209
When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
5210
(derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
5211
the virtual function table.
5212
 
5213
@item set print object off
5214
Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
5215
virtual function table.  This is the default setting.
5216
 
5217
@kindex show print object
5218
@item show print object
5219
Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
5220
 
5221
@kindex set print static-members
5222
@item set print static-members
5223
@itemx set print static-members on
5224
Print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object.  The default is on.
5225
 
5226
@item set print static-members off
5227
Do not print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object.
5228
 
5229
@kindex show print static-members
5230
@item show print static-members
5231
Show whether C@t{++} static members are printed, or not.
5232
 
5233
@c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
5234
@kindex set print vtbl
5235
@item set print vtbl
5236
@itemx set print vtbl on
5237
Pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables.  The default is off.
5238
(The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
5239
ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
5240
 
5241
@item set print vtbl off
5242
Do not pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables.
5243
 
5244
@kindex show print vtbl
5245
@item show print vtbl
5246
Show whether C@t{++} virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
5247
@end table
5248
 
5249
@node Value History
5250
@section Value history
5251
 
5252
@cindex value history
5253
Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
5254
@dfn{value history}.  This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
5255
Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
5256
(for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
5257
When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
5258
since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
5259
symbol table.
5260
 
5261
@cindex @code{$}
5262
@cindex @code{$$}
5263
@cindex history number
5264
The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
5265
refer to them.  These are successive integers starting with one.
5266
@code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
5267
printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
5268
history number.
5269
 
5270
To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
5271
history number.  The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
5272
remind you of this.  Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
5273
the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
5274
@code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
5275
is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
5276
@code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
5277
 
5278
For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
5279
want to see the contents of the structure.  It suffices to type
5280
 
5281
@example
5282
p *$
5283
@end example
5284
 
5285
If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
5286
to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
5287
 
5288
@example
5289
p *$.next
5290
@end example
5291
 
5292
@noindent
5293
You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
5294
command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
5295
 
5296
Note that the history records values, not expressions.  If the value of
5297
@code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
5298
 
5299
@example
5300
print x
5301
set x=5
5302
@end example
5303
 
5304
@noindent
5305
then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
5306
remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
5307
 
5308
@table @code
5309
@kindex show values
5310
@item show values
5311
Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
5312
This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
5313
values} does not change the history.
5314
 
5315
@item show values @var{n}
5316
Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
5317
 
5318
@item show values +
5319
Print ten history values just after the values last printed.  If no more
5320
values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
5321
@end table
5322
 
5323
Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
5324
same effect as @samp{show values +}.
5325
 
5326
@node Convenience Vars
5327
@section Convenience variables
5328
 
5329
@cindex convenience variables
5330
@value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
5331
@value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later.  These variables
5332
exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
5333
setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
5334
of your program.  That is why you can use them freely.
5335
 
5336
Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}.  Any name preceded by
5337
@samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
5338
the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
5339
(Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
5340
by @samp{$}.  @xref{Value History, ,Value history}.)
5341
 
5342
You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
5343
expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
5344
For example:
5345
 
5346
@example
5347
set $foo = *object_ptr
5348
@end example
5349
 
5350
@noindent
5351
would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
5352
@code{object_ptr}.
5353
 
5354
Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
5355
value is @code{void} until you assign a new value.  You can alter the
5356
value with another assignment at any time.
5357
 
5358
Convenience variables have no fixed types.  You can assign a convenience
5359
variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
5360
that variable already has a value of a different type.  The convenience
5361
variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
5362
 
5363
@table @code
5364
@kindex show convenience
5365
@item show convenience
5366
Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values.
5367
Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
5368
@end table
5369
 
5370
One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
5371
incremented or a pointer to be advanced.  For example, to print
5372
a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
5373
 
5374
@example
5375
set $i = 0
5376
print bar[$i++]->contents
5377
@end example
5378
 
5379
@noindent
5380
Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
5381
 
5382
Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
5383
values likely to be useful.
5384
 
5385
@table @code
5386
@vindex $_@r{, convenience variable}
5387
@item $_
5388
The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
5389
the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining memory}).  Other
5390
commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
5391
set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
5392
and @code{info breakpoint}.  The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
5393
except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
5394
to the type of @code{$__}.
5395
 
5396
@vindex $__@r{, convenience variable}
5397
@item $__
5398
The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
5399
to the value found in the last address examined.  Its type is chosen
5400
to match the format in which the data was printed.
5401
 
5402
@item $_exitcode
5403
@vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
5404
The variable @code{$_exitcode} is automatically set to the exit code when
5405
the program being debugged terminates.
5406
@end table
5407
 
5408
On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
5409
begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
5410
name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
5411
 
5412
@node Registers
5413
@section Registers
5414
 
5415
@cindex registers
5416
You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
5417
with names starting with @samp{$}.  The names of registers are different
5418
for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
5419
your machine.
5420
 
5421
@table @code
5422
@kindex info registers
5423
@item info registers
5424
Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
5425
registers (in the selected stack frame).
5426
 
5427
@kindex info all-registers
5428
@cindex floating point registers
5429
@item info all-registers
5430
Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
5431
registers.
5432
 
5433
@item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
5434
Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
5435
As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
5436
the selected stack frame.  @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
5437
the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
5438
@end table
5439
 
5440
@value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
5441
expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
5442
architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers.  The register names
5443
@code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
5444
the stack pointer.  @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
5445
pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
5446
register that contains the processor status.  For example,
5447
you could print the program counter in hex with
5448
 
5449
@example
5450
p/x $pc
5451
@end example
5452
 
5453
@noindent
5454
or print the instruction to be executed next with
5455
 
5456
@example
5457
x/i $pc
5458
@end example
5459
 
5460
@noindent
5461
or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
5462
one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
5463
memory (most machines, nowadays).  This assumes that the innermost
5464
stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
5465
stack frames are selected.  To pop entire frames off the stack,
5466
regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
5467
see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a function}.} with
5468
 
5469
@example
5470
set $sp += 4
5471
@end example
5472
 
5473
Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
5474
your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
5475
so long as there is no conflict.  The @code{info registers} command
5476
shows the canonical names.  For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
5477
registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
5478
can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
5479
is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
5480
 
5481
@value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
5482
integer when the register is examined in this way.  Some machines have
5483
special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
5484
registers are considered to have floating point values.  There is no way
5485
to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
5486
(although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
5487
@samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
5488
 
5489
Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats.  This
5490
means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
5491
the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
5492
sees.  For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
5493
coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
5494
programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format.  In such
5495
cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
5496
that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
5497
prints the data in both formats.
5498
 
5499
Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
5500
(@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}).  This means that you get the
5501
value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
5502
were exited and their saved registers restored.  In order to see the
5503
true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
5504
frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
5505
 
5506
However, @value{GDBN} must deduce where registers are saved, from the machine
5507
code generated by your compiler.  If some registers are not saved, or if
5508
@value{GDBN} is unable to locate the saved registers, the selected stack
5509
frame makes no difference.
5510
 
5511
@node Floating Point Hardware
5512
@section Floating point hardware
5513
@cindex floating point
5514
 
5515
Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
5516
you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
5517
 
5518
@table @code
5519
@kindex info float
5520
@item info float
5521
Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
5522
point unit.  The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
5523
floating point chip.  Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
5524
the ARM and x86 machines.
5525
@end table
5526
 
5527
@node Memory Region Attributes
5528
@section Memory Region Attributes
5529
@cindex memory region attributes
5530
 
5531
@dfn{Memory region attributes} allow you to describe special handling
5532
required by regions of your target's memory.  @value{GDBN} uses attributes
5533
to determine whether to allow certain types of memory accesses; whether to
5534
use specific width accesses; and whether to cache target memory.
5535
 
5536
Defined memory regions can be individually enabled and disabled.  When a
5537
memory region is disabled, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when
5538
accessing memory in that region.  Similarly, if no memory regions have
5539
been defined, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when accessing
5540
all memory.
5541
 
5542
When a memory region is defined, it is given a number to identify it;
5543
to enable, disable, or remove a memory region, you specify that number.
5544
 
5545
@table @code
5546
@kindex mem
5547
@item mem @var{address1} @var{address1} @var{attributes}@dots{}
5548
Define memory region bounded by @var{address1} and @var{address2}
5549
with attributes @var{attributes}@dots{}.
5550
 
5551
@kindex delete mem
5552
@item delete mem @var{nums}@dots{}
5553
Remove memory region numbers @var{nums}.
5554
 
5555
@kindex disable mem
5556
@item disable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
5557
Disable memory region numbers @var{nums}.
5558
A disabled memory region is not forgotten.
5559
It may be enabled again later.
5560
 
5561
@kindex enable mem
5562
@item enable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
5563
Enable memory region numbers @var{nums}.
5564
 
5565
@kindex info mem
5566
@item info mem
5567
Print a table of all defined memory regions, with the following columns
5568
for each region.
5569
 
5570
@table @emph
5571
@item Memory Region Number
5572
@item Enabled or Disabled.
5573
Enabled memory regions are marked with @samp{y}.
5574
Disabled memory regions are marked with @samp{n}.
5575
 
5576
@item Lo Address
5577
The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the memory region.
5578
 
5579
@item Hi Address
5580
The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the memory region.
5581
 
5582
@item Attributes
5583
The list of attributes set for this memory region.
5584
@end table
5585
@end table
5586
 
5587
 
5588
@subsection Attributes
5589
 
5590
@subsubsection Memory Access Mode
5591
The access mode attributes set whether @value{GDBN} may make read or
5592
write accesses to a memory region.
5593
 
5594
While these attributes prevent @value{GDBN} from performing invalid
5595
memory accesses, they do nothing to prevent the target system, I/O DMA,
5596
etc. from accessing memory.
5597
 
5598
@table @code
5599
@item ro
5600
Memory is read only.
5601
@item wo
5602
Memory is write only.
5603
@item rw
5604
Memory is read/write (default).
5605
@end table
5606
 
5607
@subsubsection Memory Access Size
5608
The acccess size attributes tells @value{GDBN} to use specific sized
5609
accesses in the memory region.  Often memory mapped device registers
5610
require specific sized accesses.  If no access size attribute is
5611
specified, @value{GDBN} may use accesses of any size.
5612
 
5613
@table @code
5614
@item 8
5615
Use 8 bit memory accesses.
5616
@item 16
5617
Use 16 bit memory accesses.
5618
@item 32
5619
Use 32 bit memory accesses.
5620
@item 64
5621
Use 64 bit memory accesses.
5622
@end table
5623
 
5624
@c @subsubsection Hardware/Software Breakpoints
5625
@c The hardware/software breakpoint attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
5626
@c will use hardware or software breakpoints for the internal breakpoints
5627
@c used by the step, next, finish, until, etc. commands.
5628
@c
5629
@c @table @code
5630
@c @item hwbreak
5631
@c Always use hardware breakpoints
5632
@c @item swbreak (default)
5633
@c @end table
5634
 
5635
@subsubsection Data Cache
5636
The data cache attributes set whether @value{GDBN} will cache target
5637
memory.  While this generally improves performance by reducing debug
5638
protocol overhead, it can lead to incorrect results because @value{GDBN}
5639
does not know about volatile variables or memory mapped device
5640
registers.
5641
 
5642
@table @code
5643
@item cache
5644
Enable @value{GDBN} to cache target memory.
5645
@item nocache (default)
5646
Disable @value{GDBN} from caching target memory.
5647
@end table
5648
 
5649
@c @subsubsection Memory Write Verification
5650
@c The memory write verification attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
5651
@c will re-reads data after each write to verify the write was successful.
5652
@c
5653
@c @table @code
5654
@c @item verify
5655
@c @item noverify (default)
5656
@c @end table
5657
 
5658
@node Tracepoints
5659
@chapter Tracepoints
5660
@c This chapter is based on the documentation written by Michael
5661
@c Snyder, David Taylor, Jim Blandy, and Elena Zannoni.
5662
 
5663
@cindex tracepoints
5664
In some applications, it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt
5665
the program's execution long enough for the developer to learn
5666
anything helpful about its behavior.  If the program's correctness
5667
depends on its real-time behavior, delays introduced by a debugger
5668
might cause the program to change its behavior drastically, or perhaps
5669
fail, even when the code itself is correct.  It is useful to be able
5670
to observe the program's behavior without interrupting it.
5671
 
5672
Using @value{GDBN}'s @code{trace} and @code{collect} commands, you can
5673
specify locations in the program, called @dfn{tracepoints}, and
5674
arbitrary expressions to evaluate when those tracepoints are reached.
5675
Later, using the @code{tfind} command, you can examine the values
5676
those expressions had when the program hit the tracepoints.  The
5677
expressions may also denote objects in memory---structures or arrays,
5678
for example---whose values @value{GDBN} should record; while visiting
5679
a particular tracepoint, you may inspect those objects as if they were
5680
in memory at that moment.  However, because @value{GDBN} records these
5681
values without interacting with you, it can do so quickly and
5682
unobtrusively, hopefully not disturbing the program's behavior.
5683
 
5684
The tracepoint facility is currently available only for remote
5685
targets.  @xref{Targets}.
5686
 
5687
This chapter describes the tracepoint commands and features.
5688
 
5689
@menu
5690
* Set Tracepoints::
5691
* Analyze Collected Data::
5692
* Tracepoint Variables::
5693
@end menu
5694
 
5695
@node Set Tracepoints
5696
@section Commands to Set Tracepoints
5697
 
5698
Before running such a @dfn{trace experiment}, an arbitrary number of
5699
tracepoints can be set.  Like a breakpoint (@pxref{Set Breaks}), a
5700
tracepoint has a number assigned to it by @value{GDBN}.  Like with
5701
breakpoints, tracepoint numbers are successive integers starting from
5702
one.  Many of the commands associated with tracepoints take the
5703
tracepoint number as their argument, to identify which tracepoint to
5704
work on.
5705
 
5706
For each tracepoint, you can specify, in advance, some arbitrary set
5707
of data that you want the target to collect in the trace buffer when
5708
it hits that tracepoint.  The collected data can include registers,
5709
local variables, or global data.  Later, you can use @value{GDBN}
5710
commands to examine the values these data had at the time the
5711
tracepoint was hit.
5712
 
5713
This section describes commands to set tracepoints and associated
5714
conditions and actions.
5715
 
5716
@menu
5717
* Create and Delete Tracepoints::
5718
* Enable and Disable Tracepoints::
5719
* Tracepoint Passcounts::
5720
* Tracepoint Actions::
5721
* Listing Tracepoints::
5722
* Starting and Stopping Trace Experiment::
5723
@end menu
5724
 
5725
@node Create and Delete Tracepoints
5726
@subsection Create and Delete Tracepoints
5727
 
5728
@table @code
5729
@cindex set tracepoint
5730
@kindex trace
5731
@item trace
5732
The @code{trace} command is very similar to the @code{break} command.
5733
Its argument can be a source line, a function name, or an address in
5734
the target program.  @xref{Set Breaks}.  The @code{trace} command
5735
defines a tracepoint, which is a point in the target program where the
5736
debugger will briefly stop, collect some data, and then allow the
5737
program to continue.  Setting a tracepoint or changing its commands
5738
doesn't take effect until the next @code{tstart} command; thus, you
5739
cannot change the tracepoint attributes once a trace experiment is
5740
running.
5741
 
5742
Here are some examples of using the @code{trace} command:
5743
 
5744
@smallexample
5745
(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo.c:121}    // a source file and line number
5746
 
5747
(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace +2}           // 2 lines forward
5748
 
5749
(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace my_function}  // first source line of function
5750
 
5751
(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *my_function} // EXACT start address of function
5752
 
5753
(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *0x2117c4}    // an address
5754
@end smallexample
5755
 
5756
@noindent
5757
You can abbreviate @code{trace} as @code{tr}.
5758
 
5759
@vindex $tpnum
5760
@cindex last tracepoint number
5761
@cindex recent tracepoint number
5762
@cindex tracepoint number
5763
The convenience variable @code{$tpnum} records the tracepoint number
5764
of the most recently set tracepoint.
5765
 
5766
@kindex delete tracepoint
5767
@cindex tracepoint deletion
5768
@item delete tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
5769
Permanently delete one or more tracepoints.  With no argument, the
5770
default is to delete all tracepoints.
5771
 
5772
Examples:
5773
 
5774
@smallexample
5775
(@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace 1 2 3} // remove three tracepoints
5776
 
5777
(@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace}       // remove all tracepoints
5778
@end smallexample
5779
 
5780
@noindent
5781
You can abbreviate this command as @code{del tr}.
5782
@end table
5783
 
5784
@node Enable and Disable Tracepoints
5785
@subsection Enable and Disable Tracepoints
5786
 
5787
@table @code
5788
@kindex disable tracepoint
5789
@item disable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
5790
Disable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints if no argument
5791
@var{num} is given.  A disabled tracepoint will have no effect during
5792
the next trace experiment, but it is not forgotten.  You can re-enable
5793
a disabled tracepoint using the @code{enable tracepoint} command.
5794
 
5795
@kindex enable tracepoint
5796
@item enable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
5797
Enable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints.  The enabled
5798
tracepoints will become effective the next time a trace experiment is
5799
run.
5800
@end table
5801
 
5802
@node Tracepoint Passcounts
5803
@subsection Tracepoint Passcounts
5804
 
5805
@table @code
5806
@kindex passcount
5807
@cindex tracepoint pass count
5808
@item passcount @r{[}@var{n} @r{[}@var{num}@r{]]}
5809
Set the @dfn{passcount} of a tracepoint.  The passcount is a way to
5810
automatically stop a trace experiment.  If a tracepoint's passcount is
5811
@var{n}, then the trace experiment will be automatically stopped on
5812
the @var{n}'th time that tracepoint is hit.  If the tracepoint number
5813
@var{num} is not specified, the @code{passcount} command sets the
5814
passcount of the most recently defined tracepoint.  If no passcount is
5815
given, the trace experiment will run until stopped explicitly by the
5816
user.
5817
 
5818
Examples:
5819
 
5820
@smallexample
5821
(@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 5 2} // Stop on the 5th execution of tracepoint 2
5822
 
5823
(@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 12}  // Stop on the 12th execution of the
5824
                                // most recently defined tracepoint.
5825
(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
5826
(@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 3}
5827
(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace bar}
5828
(@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 2}
5829
(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace baz}
5830
(@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 1}        // Stop tracing when foo has been
5831
                                 // executed 3 times OR when bar has
5832
                                 // been executed 2 times
5833
                                 // OR when baz has been executed 1 time.
5834
@end smallexample
5835
@end table
5836
 
5837
@node Tracepoint Actions
5838
@subsection Tracepoint Action Lists
5839
 
5840
@table @code
5841
@kindex actions
5842
@cindex tracepoint actions
5843
@item actions @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
5844
This command will prompt for a list of actions to be taken when the
5845
tracepoint is hit.  If the tracepoint number @var{num} is not
5846
specified, this command sets the actions for the one that was most
5847
recently defined (so that you can define a tracepoint and then say
5848
@code{actions} without bothering about its number).  You specify the
5849
actions themselves on the following lines, one action at a time, and
5850
terminate the actions list with a line containing just @code{end}.  So
5851
far, the only defined actions are @code{collect} and
5852
@code{while-stepping}.
5853
 
5854
@cindex remove actions from a tracepoint
5855
To remove all actions from a tracepoint, type @samp{actions @var{num}}
5856
and follow it immediately with @samp{end}.
5857
 
5858
@smallexample
5859
(@value{GDBP}) @b{collect @var{data}} // collect some data
5860
 
5861
(@value{GDBP}) @b{while-stepping 5}   // single-step 5 times and collect data
5862
 
5863
(@value{GDBP}) @b{end}                // signals the end of actions.
5864
@end smallexample
5865
 
5866
In the following example, the action list begins with @code{collect}
5867
commands indicating the things to be collected when the tracepoint is
5868
hit.  Then, in order to single-step and collect additional data
5869
following the tracepoint, a @code{while-stepping} command is used,
5870
followed by the list of things to be collected while stepping.  The
5871
@code{while-stepping} command is terminated by its own separate
5872
@code{end} command.  Lastly, the action list is terminated by an
5873
@code{end} command.
5874
 
5875
@smallexample
5876
(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
5877
(@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
5878
Enter actions for tracepoint 1, one per line:
5879
> collect bar,baz
5880
> collect $regs
5881
> while-stepping 12
5882
  > collect $fp, $sp
5883
  > end
5884
end
5885
@end smallexample
5886
 
5887
@kindex collect @r{(tracepoints)}
5888
@item collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
5889
Collect values of the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit.
5890
This command accepts a comma-separated list of any valid expressions.
5891
In addition to global, static, or local variables, the following
5892
special arguments are supported:
5893
 
5894
@table @code
5895
@item $regs
5896
collect all registers
5897
 
5898
@item $args
5899
collect all function arguments
5900
 
5901
@item $locals
5902
collect all local variables.
5903
@end table
5904
 
5905
You can give several consecutive @code{collect} commands, each one
5906
with a single argument, or one @code{collect} command with several
5907
arguments separated by commas: the effect is the same.
5908
 
5909
The command @code{info scope} (@pxref{Symbols, info scope}) is
5910
particularly useful for figuring out what data to collect.
5911
 
5912
@kindex while-stepping @r{(tracepoints)}
5913
@item while-stepping @var{n}
5914
Perform @var{n} single-step traces after the tracepoint, collecting
5915
new data at each step.  The @code{while-stepping} command is
5916
followed by the list of what to collect while stepping (followed by
5917
its own @code{end} command):
5918
 
5919
@smallexample
5920
> while-stepping 12
5921
  > collect $regs, myglobal
5922
  > end
5923
>
5924
@end smallexample
5925
 
5926
@noindent
5927
You may abbreviate @code{while-stepping} as @code{ws} or
5928
@code{stepping}.
5929
@end table
5930
 
5931
@node Listing Tracepoints
5932
@subsection Listing Tracepoints
5933
 
5934
@table @code
5935
@kindex info tracepoints
5936
@cindex information about tracepoints
5937
@item info tracepoints @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
5938
Display information the tracepoint @var{num}.  If you don't specify a
5939
tracepoint number displays information about all the tracepoints
5940
defined so far.  For each tracepoint, the following information is
5941
shown:
5942
 
5943
@itemize @bullet
5944
@item
5945
its number
5946
@item
5947
whether it is enabled or disabled
5948
@item
5949
its address
5950
@item
5951
its passcount as given by the @code{passcount @var{n}} command
5952
@item
5953
its step count as given by the @code{while-stepping @var{n}} command
5954
@item
5955
where in the source files is the tracepoint set
5956
@item
5957
its action list as given by the @code{actions} command
5958
@end itemize
5959
 
5960
@smallexample
5961
(@value{GDBP}) @b{info trace}
5962
Num Enb Address    PassC StepC What
5963
1   y   0x002117c4 0     0     <gdb_asm>
5964
2   y   0x0020dc64 0     0     in gdb_test at gdb_test.c:375
5965
3   y   0x0020b1f4 0     0     in collect_data at ../foo.c:1741
5966
(@value{GDBP})
5967
@end smallexample
5968
 
5969
@noindent
5970
This command can be abbreviated @code{info tp}.
5971
@end table
5972
 
5973
@node Starting and Stopping Trace Experiment
5974
@subsection Starting and Stopping Trace Experiment
5975
 
5976
@table @code
5977
@kindex tstart
5978
@cindex start a new trace experiment
5979
@cindex collected data discarded
5980
@item tstart
5981
This command takes no arguments.  It starts the trace experiment, and
5982
begins collecting data.  This has the side effect of discarding all
5983
the data collected in the trace buffer during the previous trace
5984
experiment.
5985
 
5986
@kindex tstop
5987
@cindex stop a running trace experiment
5988
@item tstop
5989
This command takes no arguments.  It ends the trace experiment, and
5990
stops collecting data.
5991
 
5992
@strong{Note:} a trace experiment and data collection may stop
5993
automatically if any tracepoint's passcount is reached
5994
(@pxref{Tracepoint Passcounts}), or if the trace buffer becomes full.
5995
 
5996
@kindex tstatus
5997
@cindex status of trace data collection
5998
@cindex trace experiment, status of
5999
@item tstatus
6000
This command displays the status of the current trace data
6001
collection.
6002
@end table
6003
 
6004
Here is an example of the commands we described so far:
6005
 
6006
@smallexample
6007
(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace gdb_c_test}
6008
(@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
6009
Enter actions for tracepoint #1, one per line.
6010
> collect $regs,$locals,$args
6011
> while-stepping 11
6012
  > collect $regs
6013
  > end
6014
> end
6015
(@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
6016
        [time passes @dots{}]
6017
(@value{GDBP}) @b{tstop}
6018
@end smallexample
6019
 
6020
 
6021
@node Analyze Collected Data
6022
@section Using the collected data
6023
 
6024
After the tracepoint experiment ends, you use @value{GDBN} commands
6025
for examining the trace data.  The basic idea is that each tracepoint
6026
collects a trace @dfn{snapshot} every time it is hit and another
6027
snapshot every time it single-steps.  All these snapshots are
6028
consecutively numbered from zero and go into a buffer, and you can
6029
examine them later.  The way you examine them is to @dfn{focus} on a
6030
specific trace snapshot.  When the remote stub is focused on a trace
6031
snapshot, it will respond to all @value{GDBN} requests for memory and
6032
registers by reading from the buffer which belongs to that snapshot,
6033
rather than from @emph{real} memory or registers of the program being
6034
debugged.  This means that @strong{all} @value{GDBN} commands
6035
(@code{print}, @code{info registers}, @code{backtrace}, etc.) will
6036
behave as if we were currently debugging the program state as it was
6037
when the tracepoint occurred.  Any requests for data that are not in
6038
the buffer will fail.
6039
 
6040
@menu
6041
* tfind::                       How to select a trace snapshot
6042
* tdump::                       How to display all data for a snapshot
6043
* save-tracepoints::            How to save tracepoints for a future run
6044
@end menu
6045
 
6046
@node tfind
6047
@subsection @code{tfind @var{n}}
6048
 
6049
@kindex tfind
6050
@cindex select trace snapshot
6051
@cindex find trace snapshot
6052
The basic command for selecting a trace snapshot from the buffer is
6053
@code{tfind @var{n}}, which finds trace snapshot number @var{n},
6054
counting from zero.  If no argument @var{n} is given, the next
6055
snapshot is selected.
6056
 
6057
Here are the various forms of using the @code{tfind} command.
6058
 
6059
@table @code
6060
@item tfind start
6061
Find the first snapshot in the buffer.  This is a synonym for
6062
@code{tfind 0} (since 0 is the number of the first snapshot).
6063
 
6064
@item tfind none
6065
Stop debugging trace snapshots, resume @emph{live} debugging.
6066
 
6067
@item tfind end
6068
Same as @samp{tfind none}.
6069
 
6070
@item tfind
6071
No argument means find the next trace snapshot.
6072
 
6073
@item tfind -
6074
Find the previous trace snapshot before the current one.  This permits
6075
retracing earlier steps.
6076
 
6077
@item tfind tracepoint @var{num}
6078
Find the next snapshot associated with tracepoint @var{num}.  Search
6079
proceeds forward from the last examined trace snapshot.  If no
6080
argument @var{num} is given, it means find the next snapshot collected
6081
for the same tracepoint as the current snapshot.
6082
 
6083
@item tfind pc @var{addr}
6084
Find the next snapshot associated with the value @var{addr} of the
6085
program counter.  Search proceeds forward from the last examined trace
6086
snapshot.  If no argument @var{addr} is given, it means find the next
6087
snapshot with the same value of PC as the current snapshot.
6088
 
6089
@item tfind outside @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
6090
Find the next snapshot whose PC is outside the given range of
6091
addresses.
6092
 
6093
@item tfind range @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
6094
Find the next snapshot whose PC is between @var{addr1} and
6095
@var{addr2}.  @c FIXME: Is the range inclusive or exclusive?
6096
 
6097
@item tfind line @r{[}@var{file}:@r{]}@var{n}
6098
Find the next snapshot associated with the source line @var{n}.  If
6099
the optional argument @var{file} is given, refer to line @var{n} in
6100
that source file.  Search proceeds forward from the last examined
6101
trace snapshot.  If no argument @var{n} is given, it means find the
6102
next line other than the one currently being examined; thus saying
6103
@code{tfind line} repeatedly can appear to have the same effect as
6104
stepping from line to line in a @emph{live} debugging session.
6105
@end table
6106
 
6107
The default arguments for the @code{tfind} commands are specifically
6108
designed to make it easy to scan through the trace buffer.  For
6109
instance, @code{tfind} with no argument selects the next trace
6110
snapshot, and @code{tfind -} with no argument selects the previous
6111
trace snapshot.  So, by giving one @code{tfind} command, and then
6112
simply hitting @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine all the trace
6113
snapshots in order.  Or, by saying @code{tfind -} and then hitting
6114
@key{RET} repeatedly you can examine the snapshots in reverse order.
6115
The @code{tfind line} command with no argument selects the snapshot
6116
for the next source line executed.  The @code{tfind pc} command with
6117
no argument selects the next snapshot with the same program counter
6118
(PC) as the current frame.  The @code{tfind tracepoint} command with
6119
no argument selects the next trace snapshot collected by the same
6120
tracepoint as the current one.
6121
 
6122
In addition to letting you scan through the trace buffer manually,
6123
these commands make it easy to construct @value{GDBN} scripts that
6124
scan through the trace buffer and print out whatever collected data
6125
you are interested in.  Thus, if we want to examine the PC, FP, and SP
6126
registers from each trace frame in the buffer, we can say this:
6127
 
6128
@smallexample
6129
(@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
6130
(@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
6131
> printf "Frame %d, PC = %08X, SP = %08X, FP = %08X\n", \
6132
          $trace_frame, $pc, $sp, $fp
6133
> tfind
6134
> end
6135
 
6136
Frame 0, PC = 0020DC64, SP = 0030BF3C, FP = 0030BF44
6137
Frame 1, PC = 0020DC6C, SP = 0030BF38, FP = 0030BF44
6138
Frame 2, PC = 0020DC70, SP = 0030BF34, FP = 0030BF44
6139
Frame 3, PC = 0020DC74, SP = 0030BF30, FP = 0030BF44
6140
Frame 4, PC = 0020DC78, SP = 0030BF2C, FP = 0030BF44
6141
Frame 5, PC = 0020DC7C, SP = 0030BF28, FP = 0030BF44
6142
Frame 6, PC = 0020DC80, SP = 0030BF24, FP = 0030BF44
6143
Frame 7, PC = 0020DC84, SP = 0030BF20, FP = 0030BF44
6144
Frame 8, PC = 0020DC88, SP = 0030BF1C, FP = 0030BF44
6145
Frame 9, PC = 0020DC8E, SP = 0030BF18, FP = 0030BF44
6146
Frame 10, PC = 00203F6C, SP = 0030BE3C, FP = 0030BF14
6147
@end smallexample
6148
 
6149
Or, if we want to examine the variable @code{X} at each source line in
6150
the buffer:
6151
 
6152
@smallexample
6153
(@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
6154
(@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
6155
> printf "Frame %d, X == %d\n", $trace_frame, X
6156
> tfind line
6157
> end
6158
 
6159
Frame 0, X = 1
6160
Frame 7, X = 2
6161
Frame 13, X = 255
6162
@end smallexample
6163
 
6164
@node tdump
6165
@subsection @code{tdump}
6166
@kindex tdump
6167
@cindex dump all data collected at tracepoint
6168
@cindex tracepoint data, display
6169
 
6170
This command takes no arguments.  It prints all the data collected at
6171
the current trace snapshot.
6172
 
6173
@smallexample
6174
(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace 444}
6175
(@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
6176
Enter actions for tracepoint #2, one per line:
6177
> collect $regs, $locals, $args, gdb_long_test
6178
> end
6179
 
6180
(@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
6181
 
6182
(@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind line 444}
6183
#0  gdb_test (p1=0x11, p2=0x22, p3=0x33, p4=0x44, p5=0x55, p6=0x66)
6184
at gdb_test.c:444
6185
444        printp( "%s: arguments = 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X\n", )
6186
 
6187
(@value{GDBP}) @b{tdump}
6188
Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 1:
6189
d0             0xc4aa0085       -995491707
6190
d1             0x18     24
6191
d2             0x80     128
6192
d3             0x33     51
6193
d4             0x71aea3d        119204413
6194
d5             0x22     34
6195
d6             0xe0     224
6196
d7             0x380035 3670069
6197
a0             0x19e24a 1696330
6198
a1             0x3000668        50333288
6199
a2             0x100    256
6200
a3             0x322000 3284992
6201
a4             0x3000698        50333336
6202
a5             0x1ad3cc 1758156
6203
fp             0x30bf3c 0x30bf3c
6204
sp             0x30bf34 0x30bf34
6205
ps             0x0      0
6206
pc             0x20b2c8 0x20b2c8
6207
fpcontrol      0x0      0
6208
fpstatus       0x0      0
6209
fpiaddr        0x0      0
6210
p = 0x20e5b4 "gdb-test"
6211
p1 = (void *) 0x11
6212
p2 = (void *) 0x22
6213
p3 = (void *) 0x33
6214
p4 = (void *) 0x44
6215
p5 = (void *) 0x55
6216
p6 = (void *) 0x66
6217
gdb_long_test = 17 '\021'
6218
 
6219
(@value{GDBP})
6220
@end smallexample
6221
 
6222
@node save-tracepoints
6223
@subsection @code{save-tracepoints @var{filename}}
6224
@kindex save-tracepoints
6225
@cindex save tracepoints for future sessions
6226
 
6227
This command saves all current tracepoint definitions together with
6228
their actions and passcounts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
6229
suitable for use in a later debugging session.  To read the saved
6230
tracepoint definitions, use the @code{source} command (@pxref{Command
6231
Files}).
6232
 
6233
@node Tracepoint Variables
6234
@section Convenience Variables for Tracepoints
6235
@cindex tracepoint variables
6236
@cindex convenience variables for tracepoints
6237
 
6238
@table @code
6239
@vindex $trace_frame
6240
@item (int) $trace_frame
6241
The current trace snapshot (a.k.a.@: @dfn{frame}) number, or -1 if no
6242
snapshot is selected.
6243
 
6244
@vindex $tracepoint
6245
@item (int) $tracepoint
6246
The tracepoint for the current trace snapshot.
6247
 
6248
@vindex $trace_line
6249
@item (int) $trace_line
6250
The line number for the current trace snapshot.
6251
 
6252
@vindex $trace_file
6253
@item (char []) $trace_file
6254
The source file for the current trace snapshot.
6255
 
6256
@vindex $trace_func
6257
@item (char []) $trace_func
6258
The name of the function containing @code{$tracepoint}.
6259
@end table
6260
 
6261
Note: @code{$trace_file} is not suitable for use in @code{printf},
6262
use @code{output} instead.
6263
 
6264
Here's a simple example of using these convenience variables for
6265
stepping through all the trace snapshots and printing some of their
6266
data.
6267
 
6268
@smallexample
6269
(@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
6270
 
6271
(@value{GDBP}) @b{while $trace_frame != -1}
6272
> output $trace_file
6273
> printf ", line %d (tracepoint #%d)\n", $trace_line, $tracepoint
6274
> tfind
6275
> end
6276
@end smallexample
6277
 
6278
@node Languages
6279
@chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
6280
@cindex languages
6281
 
6282
Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
6283
rarely expressed in the same manner.  For instance, in ANSI C,
6284
dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
6285
Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}.  Values can also be
6286
represented (and displayed) differently.  Hex numbers in C appear as
6287
@samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
6288
 
6289
@cindex working language
6290
Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
6291
allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
6292
native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
6293
consistent with the syntax of your program's native language.  The
6294
language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
6295
language}.
6296
 
6297
@menu
6298
* Setting::                     Switching between source languages
6299
* Show::                        Displaying the language
6300
* Checks::                      Type and range checks
6301
* Support::                     Supported languages
6302
@end menu
6303
 
6304
@node Setting
6305
@section Switching between source languages
6306
 
6307
There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
6308
set it automatically, or select it manually yourself.  You can use the
6309
@code{set language} command for either purpose.  On startup, @value{GDBN}
6310
defaults to setting the language automatically.  The working language is
6311
used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
6312
are printed, etc.
6313
 
6314
In addition to the working language, every source file that
6315
@value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language.  For some object
6316
file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
6317
source file is in.  However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
6318
language from the name of the file.  The language of a source file
6319
controls whether C@t{++} names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
6320
show each frame appropriately for its own language.  There is no way to
6321
set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
6322
set the language associated with a filename extension.  @xref{Show, ,
6323
Displaying the language}.
6324
 
6325
This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
6326
as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
6327
another language.  In that case, make the
6328
program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
6329
@value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
6330
program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
6331
 
6332
@menu
6333
* Filenames::                   Filename extensions and languages.
6334
* Manually::                    Setting the working language manually
6335
* Automatically::               Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
6336
@end menu
6337
 
6338
@node Filenames
6339
@subsection List of filename extensions and languages
6340
 
6341
If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
6342
@value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
6343
 
6344
@table @file
6345
 
6346
@item .c
6347
C source file
6348
 
6349
@item .C
6350
@itemx .cc
6351
@itemx .cp
6352
@itemx .cpp
6353
@itemx .cxx
6354
@itemx .c++
6355
C@t{++} source file
6356
 
6357
@item .f
6358
@itemx .F
6359
Fortran source file
6360
 
6361
@item .ch
6362
@itemx .c186
6363
@itemx .c286
6364
CHILL source file
6365
 
6366
@item .mod
6367
Modula-2 source file
6368
 
6369
@item .s
6370
@itemx .S
6371
Assembler source file.  This actually behaves almost like C, but
6372
@value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
6373
@end table
6374
 
6375
In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
6376
extension.  @xref{Show, , Displaying the language}.
6377
 
6378
@node Manually
6379
@subsection Setting the working language
6380
 
6381
If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
6382
expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
6383
your program.
6384
 
6385
@kindex set language
6386
If you wish, you may set the language manually.  To do this, issue the
6387
command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
6388
a language, such as
6389
@code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
6390
For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
6391
 
6392
Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
6393
language automatically.  This can lead to confusion if you try
6394
to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
6395
source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
6396
languages---but means different things.  For instance, if the current
6397
source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
6398
command such as:
6399
 
6400
@example
6401
print a = b + c
6402
@end example
6403
 
6404
@noindent
6405
might not have the effect you intended.  In C, this means to add
6406
@code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}.  The result
6407
printed would be the value of @code{a}.  In Modula-2, this means to compare
6408
@code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
6409
 
6410
@node Automatically
6411
@subsection Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
6412
 
6413
To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
6414
@samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}.  @value{GDBN}
6415
then infers the working language.  That is, when your program stops in a
6416
frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
6417
working language to the language recorded for the function in that
6418
frame.  If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
6419
or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
6420
does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
6421
not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
6422
 
6423
This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
6424
entirely in one source language.  However, program modules and libraries
6425
written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
6426
a different source language.  Using @samp{set language auto} in this
6427
case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
6428
 
6429
@node Show
6430
@section Displaying the language
6431
 
6432
The following commands help you find out which language is the
6433
working language, and also what language source files were written in.
6434
 
6435
@kindex show language
6436
@kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
6437
@kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
6438
@table @code
6439
@item show language
6440
Display the current working language.  This is the
6441
language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
6442
build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
6443
 
6444
@item info frame
6445
Display the source language for this frame.  This language becomes the
6446
working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
6447
@xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a frame}, to identify the other
6448
information listed here.
6449
 
6450
@item info source
6451
Display the source language of this source file.
6452
@xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
6453
information listed here.
6454
@end table
6455
 
6456
In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
6457
not in the standard list.  You can then set the extension associated
6458
with a language explicitly:
6459
 
6460
@kindex set extension-language
6461
@kindex info extensions
6462
@table @code
6463
@item set extension-language @var{.ext} @var{language}
6464
Set source files with extension @var{.ext} to be assumed to be in
6465
the source language @var{language}.
6466
 
6467
@item info extensions
6468
List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
6469
@end table
6470
 
6471
@node Checks
6472
@section Type and range checking
6473
 
6474
@quotation
6475
@emph{Warning:} In this release, the @value{GDBN} commands for type and range
6476
checking are included, but they do not yet have any effect.  This
6477
section documents the intended facilities.
6478
@end quotation
6479
@c FIXME remove warning when type/range code added
6480
 
6481
Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
6482
errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks.  These include
6483
checking the type of arguments to functions and operators, and making
6484
sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time.  Checks such as
6485
these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
6486
by eliminating type mismatches, and providing active checks for range
6487
errors when your program is running.
6488
 
6489
@value{GDBN} can check for conditions like the above if you wish.
6490
Although @value{GDBN} does not check the statements in your program, it
6491
can check expressions entered directly into @value{GDBN} for evaluation via
6492
the @code{print} command, for example.  As with the working language,
6493
@value{GDBN} can also decide whether or not to check automatically based on
6494
your program's source language.  @xref{Support, ,Supported languages},
6495
for the default settings of supported languages.
6496
 
6497
@menu
6498
* Type Checking::               An overview of type checking
6499
* Range Checking::              An overview of range checking
6500
@end menu
6501
 
6502
@cindex type checking
6503
@cindex checks, type
6504
@node Type Checking
6505
@subsection An overview of type checking
6506
 
6507
Some languages, such as Modula-2, are strongly typed, meaning that the
6508
arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
6509
otherwise an error occurs.  These checks prevent type mismatch
6510
errors from ever causing any run-time problems.  For example,
6511
 
6512
@smallexample
6513
1 + 2 @result{} 3
6514
@exdent but
6515
@error{} 1 + 2.3
6516
@end smallexample
6517
 
6518
The second example fails because the @code{CARDINAL} 1 is not
6519
type-compatible with the @code{REAL} 2.3.
6520
 
6521
For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell the
6522
@value{GDBN} type checker to skip checking;
6523
to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
6524
or to only issue warnings when type mismatches occur,
6525
but evaluate the expression anyway.  When you choose the last of
6526
these, @value{GDBN} evaluates expressions like the second example above, but
6527
also issues a warning.
6528
 
6529
Even if you turn type checking off, there may be other reasons
6530
related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
6531
For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
6532
a @code{struct foo}.  These particular type errors have nothing to do
6533
with the language in use, and usually arise from expressions, such as
6534
the one described above, which make little sense to evaluate anyway.
6535
 
6536
Each language defines to what degree it is strict about type.  For
6537
instance, both Modula-2 and C require the arguments to arithmetical
6538
operators to be numbers.  In C, enumerated types and pointers can be
6539
represented as numbers, so that they are valid arguments to mathematical
6540
operators.  @xref{Support, ,Supported languages}, for further
6541
details on specific languages.
6542
 
6543
@value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the type checker:
6544
 
6545
@kindex set check@r{, type}
6546
@kindex set check type
6547
@kindex show check type
6548
@table @code
6549
@item set check type auto
6550
Set type checking on or off based on the current working language.
6551
@xref{Support, ,Supported languages}, for the default settings for
6552
each language.
6553
 
6554
@item set check type on
6555
@itemx set check type off
6556
Set type checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
6557
current working language.  Issue a warning if the setting does not
6558
match the language default.  If any type mismatches occur in
6559
evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
6560
message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
6561
 
6562
@item set check type warn
6563
Cause the type checker to issue warnings, but to always attempt to
6564
evaluate the expression.  Evaluating the expression may still
6565
be impossible for other reasons.  For example, @value{GDBN} cannot add
6566
numbers and structures.
6567
 
6568
@item show type
6569
Show the current setting of the type checker, and whether or not @value{GDBN}
6570
is setting it automatically.
6571
@end table
6572
 
6573
@cindex range checking
6574
@cindex checks, range
6575
@node Range Checking
6576
@subsection An overview of range checking
6577
 
6578
In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
6579
bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks.  Such range
6580
checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
6581
computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
6582
not exceed the bounds of the array.
6583
 
6584
For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
6585
@value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
6586
always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
6587
warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
6588
 
6589
A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
6590
array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
6591
of any type.  Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
6592
error.  In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
6593
result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
6594
the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
6595
 
6596
@example
6597
@var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
6598
@end example
6599
 
6600
This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
6601
specific to individual compilers or machines.  @xref{Support, ,
6602
Supported languages}, for further details on specific languages.
6603
 
6604
@value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
6605
 
6606
@kindex set check@r{, range}
6607
@kindex set check range
6608
@kindex show check range
6609
@table @code
6610
@item set check range auto
6611
Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
6612
@xref{Support, ,Supported languages}, for the default settings for
6613
each language.
6614
 
6615
@item set check range on
6616
@itemx set check range off
6617
Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
6618
current working language.  A warning is issued if the setting does not
6619
match the language default.  If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
6620
then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
6621
 
6622
@item set check range warn
6623
Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
6624
but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway.  Evaluating the
6625
expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
6626
memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
6627
systems).
6628
 
6629
@item show range
6630
Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
6631
being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
6632
@end table
6633
 
6634
@node Support
6635
@section Supported languages
6636
 
6637
@value{GDBN} supports C, C@t{++}, Fortran, Java, Chill, assembly, and Modula-2.
6638
@c This is false ...
6639
Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
6640
language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
6641
and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
6642
,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
6643
language.
6644
 
6645
The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
6646
supported by @value{GDBN}.  These sections are not meant to be language
6647
tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
6648
@value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
6649
formats should look like for different languages.  There are many good
6650
books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
6651
language reference or tutorial.
6652
 
6653
@menu
6654
* C::           C and C@t{++}
6655
* Modula-2::    Modula-2
6656
* Chill::        Chill
6657
@end menu
6658
 
6659
@node C
6660
@subsection C and C@t{++}
6661
 
6662
@cindex C and C@t{++}
6663
@cindex expressions in C or C@t{++}
6664
 
6665
Since C and C@t{++} are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
6666
to both languages.  Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
6667
together.
6668
 
6669
@cindex C@t{++}
6670
@cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler
6671
@cindex @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
6672
The C@t{++} debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C@t{++}
6673
compiler and @value{GDBN}.  Therefore, to debug your C@t{++} code
6674
effectively, you must compile your C@t{++} programs with a supported
6675
C@t{++} compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C@t{++}
6676
compiler (@code{aCC}).
6677
 
6678
For best results when using @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, use the stabs debugging
6679
format.  You can select that format explicitly with the @code{g++}
6680
command-line options @samp{-gstabs} or @samp{-gstabs+}.  See
6681
@ref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or @sc{gnu}
6682
CC, gcc.info, Using @sc{gnu} CC}, for more information.
6683
 
6684
@menu
6685
* C Operators::                 C and C@t{++} operators
6686
* C Constants::                 C and C@t{++} constants
6687
* C plus plus expressions::     C@t{++} expressions
6688
* C Defaults::                  Default settings for C and C@t{++}
6689
* C Checks::                    C and C@t{++} type and range checks
6690
* Debugging C::                 @value{GDBN} and C
6691
* Debugging C plus plus::       @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
6692
@end menu
6693
 
6694
@node C Operators
6695
@subsubsection C and C@t{++} operators
6696
 
6697
@cindex C and C@t{++} operators
6698
 
6699
Operators must be defined on values of specific types.  For instance,
6700
@code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures.  Operators are
6701
often defined on groups of types.
6702
 
6703
For the purposes of C and C@t{++}, the following definitions hold:
6704
 
6705
@itemize @bullet
6706
 
6707
@item
6708
@emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
6709
specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C@t{++}, @code{bool}.
6710
 
6711
@item
6712
@emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
6713
@code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
6714
 
6715
@item
6716
@emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
6717
 
6718
@item
6719
@emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
6720
 
6721
@end itemize
6722
 
6723
@noindent
6724
The following operators are supported.  They are listed here
6725
in order of increasing precedence:
6726
 
6727
@table @code
6728
@item ,
6729
The comma or sequencing operator.  Expressions in a comma-separated list
6730
are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
6731
expression being the last expression evaluated.
6732
 
6733
@item =
6734
Assignment.  The value of an assignment expression is the value
6735
assigned.  Defined on scalar types.
6736
 
6737
@item @var{op}=
6738
Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
6739
and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
6740
@w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence.
6741
@var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
6742
@code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
6743
 
6744
@item ?:
6745
The ternary operator.  @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
6746
of as:  if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}.  @var{a} should be of an
6747
integral type.
6748
 
6749
@item ||
6750
Logical @sc{or}.  Defined on integral types.
6751
 
6752
@item &&
6753
Logical @sc{and}.  Defined on integral types.
6754
 
6755
@item |
6756
Bitwise @sc{or}.  Defined on integral types.
6757
 
6758
@item ^
6759
Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}.  Defined on integral types.
6760
 
6761
@item &
6762
Bitwise @sc{and}.  Defined on integral types.
6763
 
6764
@item ==@r{, }!=
6765
Equality and inequality.  Defined on scalar types.  The value of these
6766
expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
6767
 
6768
@item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
6769
Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
6770
Defined on scalar types.  The value of these expressions is 0 for false
6771
and non-zero for true.
6772
 
6773
@item <<@r{, }>>
6774
left shift, and right shift.  Defined on integral types.
6775
 
6776
@item @@
6777
The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
6778
 
6779
@item +@r{, }-
6780
Addition and subtraction.  Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
6781
pointer types.
6782
 
6783
@item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
6784
Multiplication, division, and modulus.  Multiplication and division are
6785
defined on integral and floating-point types.  Modulus is defined on
6786
integral types.
6787
 
6788
@item ++@r{, }--
6789
Increment and decrement.  When appearing before a variable, the
6790
operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
6791
when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
6792
operation takes place.
6793
 
6794
@item *
6795
Pointer dereferencing.  Defined on pointer types.  Same precedence as
6796
@code{++}.
6797
 
6798
@item &
6799
Address operator.  Defined on variables.  Same precedence as @code{++}.
6800
 
6801
For debugging C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
6802
allowed in the C@t{++} language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
6803
(or, if you prefer, simply @samp{&&@var{ref}}) to examine the address
6804
where a C@t{++} reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
6805
stored.
6806
 
6807
@item -
6808
Negative.  Defined on integral and floating-point types.  Same
6809
precedence as @code{++}.
6810
 
6811
@item !
6812
Logical negation.  Defined on integral types.  Same precedence as
6813
@code{++}.
6814
 
6815
@item ~
6816
Bitwise complement operator.  Defined on integral types.  Same precedence as
6817
@code{++}.
6818
 
6819
 
6820
@item .@r{, }->
6821
Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member.  For convenience,
6822
@value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
6823
pointer based on the stored type information.
6824
Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
6825
 
6826
@item .*@r{, }->*
6827
Dereferences of pointers to members.
6828
 
6829
@item []
6830
Array indexing.  @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
6831
@code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}.  Same precedence as @code{->}.
6832
 
6833
@item ()
6834
Function parameter list.  Same precedence as @code{->}.
6835
 
6836
@item ::
6837
C@t{++} scope resolution operator.  Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
6838
and @code{class} types.
6839
 
6840
@item ::
6841
Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
6842
(@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).  Same precedence as @code{::},
6843
above.
6844
@end table
6845
 
6846
If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
6847
attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
6848
predefined meaning.
6849
 
6850
@menu
6851
* C Constants::
6852
@end menu
6853
 
6854
@node C Constants
6855
@subsubsection C and C@t{++} constants
6856
 
6857
@cindex C and C@t{++} constants
6858
 
6859
@value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C@t{++} in the
6860
following ways:
6861
 
6862
@itemize @bullet
6863
@item
6864
Integer constants are a sequence of digits.  Octal constants are
6865
specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e. zero), and hexadecimal constants by
6866
a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}.  Constants may also end with a letter
6867
@samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
6868
@code{long} value.
6869
 
6870
@item
6871
Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
6872
point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
6873
exponent.  An exponent is of the form:
6874
@samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
6875
sequence of digits.  The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
6876
A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
6877
@samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
6878
the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
6879
a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
6880
constant.
6881
 
6882
@item
6883
Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
6884
integral equivalents.
6885
 
6886
@item
6887
Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
6888
(@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
6889
(usually its @sc{ascii} value).  Within quotes, the single character may
6890
be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
6891
the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
6892
of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
6893
@samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
6894
@samp{\n} for newline.
6895
 
6896
@item
6897
String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by
6898
double quotes (@code{"}).  Any valid character constant (as described
6899
above) may appear.  Double quotes within the string must be preceded by
6900
a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five
6901
characters.
6902
 
6903
@item
6904
Pointer constants are an integral value.  You can also write pointers
6905
to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
6906
 
6907
@item
6908
Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
6909
and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
6910
integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
6911
and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
6912
@end itemize
6913
 
6914
@menu
6915
* C plus plus expressions::
6916
* C Defaults::
6917
* C Checks::
6918
 
6919
* Debugging C::
6920
@end menu
6921
 
6922
@node C plus plus expressions
6923
@subsubsection C@t{++} expressions
6924
 
6925
@cindex expressions in C@t{++}
6926
@value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C@t{++} expressions.
6927
 
6928
@cindex C@t{++} support, not in @sc{coff}
6929
@cindex @sc{coff} versus C@t{++}
6930
@cindex C@t{++} and object formats
6931
@cindex object formats and C@t{++}
6932
@cindex a.out and C@t{++}
6933
@cindex @sc{ecoff} and C@t{++}
6934
@cindex @sc{xcoff} and C@t{++}
6935
@cindex @sc{elf}/stabs and C@t{++}
6936
@cindex @sc{elf}/@sc{dwarf} and C@t{++}
6937
@c FIXME!! GDB may eventually be able to debug C++ using DWARF; check
6938
@c periodically whether this has happened...
6939
@quotation
6940
@emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C@t{++} code if you use the
6941
proper compiler.  Typically, C@t{++} debugging depends on the use of
6942
additional debugging information in the symbol table, and thus requires
6943
special support.  In particular, if your compiler generates a.out, MIPS
6944
@sc{ecoff}, RS/6000 @sc{xcoff}, or @sc{elf} with stabs extensions to the
6945
symbol table, these facilities are all available.  (With @sc{gnu} CC,
6946
you can use the @samp{-gstabs} option to request stabs debugging
6947
extensions explicitly.)  Where the object code format is standard
6948
@sc{coff} or @sc{dwarf} in @sc{elf}, on the other hand, most of the C@t{++}
6949
support in @value{GDBN} does @emph{not} work.
6950
@end quotation
6951
 
6952
@enumerate
6953
 
6954
@cindex member functions
6955
@item
6956
Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
6957
 
6958
@example
6959
count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
6960
@end example
6961
 
6962
@vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions}
6963
@cindex namespace in C@t{++}
6964
@item
6965
While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
6966
expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
6967
that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
6968
pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C@t{++}.
6969
 
6970
@cindex call overloaded functions
6971
@cindex overloaded functions, calling
6972
@cindex type conversions in C@t{++}
6973
@item
6974
You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
6975
call to the right definition, with some restrictions.  @value{GDBN} does not
6976
perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
6977
calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
6978
in the program.  It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
6979
default arguments.
6980
 
6981
It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
6982
promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
6983
class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
6984
functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
6985
number of function arguments.
6986
 
6987
Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
6988
@code{set overload-resolution off}.  @xref{Debugging C plus plus,
6989
,@value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}}.
6990
 
6991
You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
6992
explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
6993
@smallexample
6994
p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
6995
@end smallexample
6996
 
6997
The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
6998
see @ref{Completion, ,Command completion}.
6999
 
7000
@cindex reference declarations
7001
@item
7002
@value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C@t{++} references; you can use
7003
them in expressions just as you do in C@t{++} source---they are automatically
7004
dereferenced.
7005
 
7006
In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
7007
reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
7008
avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
7009
The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
7010
you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
7011
 
7012
@item
7013
@value{GDBN} supports the C@t{++} name resolution operator @code{::}---your
7014
expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do.  Since
7015
one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
7016
necessary, for example in an expression like
7017
@samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}.  @value{GDBN} also allows
7018
resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C@t{++}
7019
debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program variables}).
7020
@end enumerate
7021
 
7022
In addition, when used with HP's C@t{++} compiler, @value{GDBN} supports
7023
calling virtual functions correctly, printing out virtual bases of
7024
objects, calling functions in a base subobject, casting objects, and
7025
invoking user-defined operators.
7026
 
7027
@node C Defaults
7028
@subsubsection C and C@t{++} defaults
7029
 
7030
@cindex C and C@t{++} defaults
7031
 
7032
If you allow @value{GDBN} to set type and range checking automatically, they
7033
both default to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
7034
C or C@t{++}.  This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
7035
selects the working language.
7036
 
7037
If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
7038
recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
7039
@file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
7040
these files, it sets the working language to C or C@t{++}.
7041
@xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language},
7042
for further details.
7043
 
7044
@c Type checking is (a) primarily motivated by Modula-2, and (b)
7045
@c unimplemented.  If (b) changes, it might make sense to let this node
7046
@c appear even if Mod-2 does not, but meanwhile ignore it. roland 16jul93.
7047
 
7048
@node C Checks
7049
@subsubsection C and C@t{++} type and range checks
7050
 
7051
@cindex C and C@t{++} checks
7052
 
7053
By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C@t{++} expressions, type checking
7054
is not used.  However, if you turn type checking on, @value{GDBN}
7055
considers two variables type equivalent if:
7056
 
7057
@itemize @bullet
7058
@item
7059
The two variables are structured and have the same structure, union, or
7060
enumerated tag.
7061
 
7062
@item
7063
The two variables have the same type name, or types that have been
7064
declared equivalent through @code{typedef}.
7065
 
7066
@ignore
7067
@c leaving this out because neither J Gilmore nor R Pesch understand it.
7068
@c FIXME--beers?
7069
@item
7070
The two @code{struct}, @code{union}, or @code{enum} variables are
7071
declared in the same declaration.  (Note: this may not be true for all C
7072
compilers.)
7073
@end ignore
7074
@end itemize
7075
 
7076
Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations.  Array
7077
indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
7078
that is not itself an array.
7079
 
7080
@node Debugging C
7081
@subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
7082
 
7083
The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
7084
the @code{union} type.  When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
7085
inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed.  Otherwise, it
7086
appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
7087
 
7088
The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
7089
with pointers and a memory allocation function.  @xref{Expressions,
7090
,Expressions}.
7091
 
7092
@menu
7093
* Debugging C plus plus::
7094
@end menu
7095
 
7096
@node Debugging C plus plus
7097
@subsubsection @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
7098
 
7099
@cindex commands for C@t{++}
7100
 
7101
Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C@t{++}, and some are
7102
designed specifically for use with C@t{++}.  Here is a summary:
7103
 
7104
@table @code
7105
@cindex break in overloaded functions
7106
@item @r{breakpoint menus}
7107
When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
7108
@value{GDBN} breakpoint menus help you specify which function definition
7109
you want.  @xref{Breakpoint Menus,,Breakpoint menus}.
7110
 
7111
@cindex overloading in C@t{++}
7112
@item rbreak @var{regex}
7113
Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
7114
breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
7115
classes.
7116
@xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}.
7117
 
7118
@cindex C@t{++} exception handling
7119
@item catch throw
7120
@itemx catch catch
7121
Debug C@t{++} exception handling using these commands.  @xref{Set
7122
Catchpoints, , Setting catchpoints}.
7123
 
7124
@cindex inheritance
7125
@item ptype @var{typename}
7126
Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
7127
@var{typename}.
7128
@xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
7129
 
7130
@cindex C@t{++} symbol display
7131
@item set print demangle
7132
@itemx show print demangle
7133
@itemx set print asm-demangle
7134
@itemx show print asm-demangle
7135
Control whether C@t{++} symbols display in their source form, both when
7136
displaying code as C@t{++} source and when displaying disassemblies.
7137
@xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
7138
 
7139
@item set print object
7140
@itemx show print object
7141
Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
7142
@xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
7143
 
7144
@item set print vtbl
7145
@itemx show print vtbl
7146
Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
7147
@xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
7148
(The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
7149
ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
7150
 
7151
@kindex set overload-resolution
7152
@cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
7153
@item set overload-resolution on
7154
Enable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation.  The default
7155
is on.  For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
7156
and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
7157
using the standard C@t{++} conversion rules (see @ref{C plus plus expressions, ,C@t{++}
7158
expressions}, for details).  If it cannot find a match, it emits a
7159
message.
7160
 
7161
@item set overload-resolution off
7162
Disable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation.  For
7163
overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
7164
chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
7165
symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type.  For
7166
overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
7167
searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
7168
argument types.
7169
 
7170
@item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
7171
You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
7172
the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C@t{++}: type
7173
@code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}.  You can
7174
also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
7175
available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
7176
@xref{Completion,, Command completion}, for details on how to do this.
7177
@end table
7178
 
7179
@node Modula-2
7180
@subsection Modula-2
7181
 
7182
@cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
7183
 
7184
The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
7185
output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
7186
developed).  Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
7187
attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
7188
to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
7189
table.
7190
 
7191
@cindex expressions in Modula-2
7192
@menu
7193
* M2 Operators::                Built-in operators
7194
* Built-In Func/Proc::          Built-in functions and procedures
7195
* M2 Constants::                Modula-2 constants
7196
* M2 Defaults::                 Default settings for Modula-2
7197
* Deviations::                  Deviations from standard Modula-2
7198
* M2 Checks::                   Modula-2 type and range checks
7199
* M2 Scope::                    The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
7200
* GDB/M2::                      @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
7201
@end menu
7202
 
7203
@node M2 Operators
7204
@subsubsection Operators
7205
@cindex Modula-2 operators
7206
 
7207
Operators must be defined on values of specific types.  For instance,
7208
@code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures.  Operators are
7209
often defined on groups of types.  For the purposes of Modula-2, the
7210
following definitions hold:
7211
 
7212
@itemize @bullet
7213
 
7214
@item
7215
@emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
7216
their subranges.
7217
 
7218
@item
7219
@emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
7220
 
7221
@item
7222
@emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
7223
 
7224
@item
7225
@emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
7226
@var{type}}.
7227
 
7228
@item
7229
@emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
7230
 
7231
@item
7232
@emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
7233
 
7234
@item
7235
@emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
7236
@end itemize
7237
 
7238
@noindent
7239
The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
7240
increasing precedence:
7241
 
7242
@table @code
7243
@item ,
7244
Function argument or array index separator.
7245
 
7246
@item :=
7247
Assignment.  The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
7248
@var{value}.
7249
 
7250
@item <@r{, }>
7251
Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
7252
types.
7253
 
7254
@item <=@r{, }>=
7255
Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
7256
on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
7257
set types.  Same precedence as @code{<}.
7258
 
7259
@item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
7260
Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
7261
Same precedence as @code{<}.  In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
7262
available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
7263
comment character.
7264
 
7265
@item IN
7266
Set membership.  Defined on set types and the types of their members.
7267
Same precedence as @code{<}.
7268
 
7269
@item OR
7270
Boolean disjunction.  Defined on boolean types.
7271
 
7272
@item AND@r{, }&
7273
Boolean conjunction.  Defined on boolean types.
7274
 
7275
@item @@
7276
The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
7277
 
7278
@item +@r{, }-
7279
Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
7280
and difference on set types.
7281
 
7282
@item *
7283
Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
7284
on set types.
7285
 
7286
@item /
7287
Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
7288
types.  Same precedence as @code{*}.
7289
 
7290
@item DIV@r{, }MOD
7291
Integer division and remainder.  Defined on integral types.  Same
7292
precedence as @code{*}.
7293
 
7294
@item -
7295
Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
7296
 
7297
@item ^
7298
Pointer dereferencing.  Defined on pointer types.
7299
 
7300
@item NOT
7301
Boolean negation.  Defined on boolean types.  Same precedence as
7302
@code{^}.
7303
 
7304
@item .
7305
@code{RECORD} field selector.  Defined on @code{RECORD} data.  Same
7306
precedence as @code{^}.
7307
 
7308
@item []
7309
Array indexing.  Defined on @code{ARRAY} data.  Same precedence as @code{^}.
7310
 
7311
@item ()
7312
Procedure argument list.  Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects.  Same precedence
7313
as @code{^}.
7314
 
7315
@item ::@r{, }.
7316
@value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
7317
@end table
7318
 
7319
@quotation
7320
@emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
7321
treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
7322
@code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
7323
@code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
7324
@end quotation
7325
 
7326
 
7327
@node Built-In Func/Proc
7328
@subsubsection Built-in functions and procedures
7329
@cindex Modula-2 built-ins
7330
 
7331
Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
7332
In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
7333
 
7334
@table @var
7335
 
7336
@item a
7337
represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
7338
 
7339
@item c
7340
represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
7341
 
7342
@item i
7343
represents a variable or constant of integral type.
7344
 
7345
@item m
7346
represents an identifier that belongs to a set.  Generally used in the
7347
same function with the metavariable @var{s}.  The type of @var{s} should
7348
be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
7349
 
7350
@item n
7351
represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
7352
 
7353
@item r
7354
represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
7355
 
7356
@item t
7357
represents a type.
7358
 
7359
@item v
7360
represents a variable.
7361
 
7362
@item x
7363
represents a variable or constant of one of many types.  See the
7364
explanation of the function for details.
7365
@end table
7366
 
7367
All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
7368
 
7369
@table @code
7370
@item ABS(@var{n})
7371
Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
7372
 
7373
@item CAP(@var{c})
7374
If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
7375
equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
7376
 
7377
@item CHR(@var{i})
7378
Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
7379
 
7380
@item DEC(@var{v})
7381
Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one.  Returns the new value.
7382
 
7383
@item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
7384
Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}.  Returns the
7385
new value.
7386
 
7387
@item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
7388
Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}.  Returns the new
7389
set.
7390
 
7391
@item FLOAT(@var{i})
7392
Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
7393
 
7394
@item HIGH(@var{a})
7395
Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
7396
 
7397
@item INC(@var{v})
7398
Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one.  Returns the new value.
7399
 
7400
@item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
7401
Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}.  Returns the
7402
new value.
7403
 
7404
@item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
7405
Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
7406
there.  Returns the new set.
7407
 
7408
@item MAX(@var{t})
7409
Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
7410
 
7411
@item MIN(@var{t})
7412
Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
7413
 
7414
@item ODD(@var{i})
7415
Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
7416
 
7417
@item ORD(@var{x})
7418
Returns the ordinal value of its argument.  For example, the ordinal
7419
value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting the
7420
@sc{ascii} character set).  @var{x} must be of an ordered type, which include
7421
integral, character and enumerated types.
7422
 
7423
@item SIZE(@var{x})
7424
Returns the size of its argument.  @var{x} can be a variable or a type.
7425
 
7426
@item TRUNC(@var{r})
7427
Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
7428
 
7429
@item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
7430
Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
7431
@end table
7432
 
7433
@quotation
7434
@emph{Warning:}  Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
7435
@value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
7436
an error.
7437
@end quotation
7438
 
7439
@cindex Modula-2 constants
7440
@node M2 Constants
7441
@subsubsection Constants
7442
 
7443
@value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
7444
ways:
7445
 
7446
@itemize @bullet
7447
 
7448
@item
7449
Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits.  When used in an
7450
expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
7451
rest of the expression.  Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
7452
trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
7453
 
7454
@item
7455
Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
7456
decimal point and another sequence of digits.  An optional exponent can
7457
then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
7458
@samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent.  All of the
7459
digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
7460
digits.
7461
 
7462
@item
7463
Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
7464
like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).  They may
7465
also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
7466
followed by a @samp{C}.
7467
 
7468
@item
7469
String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
7470
pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
7471
Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed.  @xref{C
7472
Constants, ,C and C@t{++} constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
7473
sequences.
7474
 
7475
@item
7476
Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
7477
 
7478
@item
7479
Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
7480
@code{FALSE}.
7481
 
7482
@item
7483
Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
7484
 
7485
@item
7486
Set constants are not yet supported.
7487
@end itemize
7488
 
7489
@node M2 Defaults
7490
@subsubsection Modula-2 defaults
7491
@cindex Modula-2 defaults
7492
 
7493
If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
7494
both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
7495
Modula-2.  This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
7496
selected the working language.
7497
 
7498
If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
7499
code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
7500
working language to Modula-2.  @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} set
7501
the language automatically}, for further details.
7502
 
7503
@node Deviations
7504
@subsubsection Deviations from standard Modula-2
7505
@cindex Modula-2, deviations from
7506
 
7507
A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
7508
This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
7509
 
7510
@itemize @bullet
7511
@item
7512
Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
7513
integers.  This allows you to modify pointer variables during
7514
debugging.  (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
7515
pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
7516
through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
7517
returned a pointer.)
7518
 
7519
@item
7520
C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
7521
non-printable characters.  @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
7522
escape sequences embedded.  Single non-printable characters are
7523
printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
7524
 
7525
@item
7526
The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
7527
argument.
7528
 
7529
@item
7530
All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
7531
@end itemize
7532
 
7533
@node M2 Checks
7534
@subsubsection Modula-2 type and range checks
7535
@cindex Modula-2 checks
7536
 
7537
@quotation
7538
@emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
7539
range checking.
7540
@end quotation
7541
@c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
7542
 
7543
@value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
7544
 
7545
@itemize @bullet
7546
@item
7547
They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
7548
@var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
7549
 
7550
@item
7551
They have been declared on the same line.  (Note:  This is true of the
7552
@sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
7553
@end itemize
7554
 
7555
As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
7556
whose types are not equivalent is an error.
7557
 
7558
Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
7559
index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
7560
 
7561
@node M2 Scope
7562
@subsubsection The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
7563
@cindex scope
7564
@cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator
7565
@cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
7566
@ifinfo
7567
@vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
7568
@c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
7569
@end ifinfo
7570
@iftex
7571
@vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2}
7572
@end iftex
7573
 
7574
There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
7575
(@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}).  The two have
7576
similar syntax:
7577
 
7578
@example
7579
 
7580
@var{module} . @var{id}
7581
@var{scope} :: @var{id}
7582
@end example
7583
 
7584
@noindent
7585
where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
7586
@var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
7587
identifier within your program, except another module.
7588
 
7589
Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
7590
specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}.  If it is not
7591
found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
7592
enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
7593
 
7594
Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
7595
the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
7596
definition module specified by @var{module}.  With this operator, it is
7597
an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
7598
module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
7599
@var{module}.
7600
 
7601
@node GDB/M2
7602
@subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
7603
 
7604
Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
7605
Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
7606
specifically to C and C@t{++}: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
7607
@samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}.  The first four
7608
apply to C@t{++}, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
7609
analogue in Modula-2.
7610
 
7611
The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
7612
with any language, is not useful with Modula-2.  Its
7613
intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
7614
created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C@t{++}.  However, because an
7615
address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
7616
@samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
7617
 
7618
@cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
7619
In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
7620
interpreted as the beginning of a comment.  Use @code{<>} instead.
7621
 
7622
@node Chill
7623
@subsection Chill
7624
 
7625
The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Chill only support output
7626
from the @sc{gnu} Chill compiler.  Other Chill compilers are not currently
7627
supported, and attempting to debug executables produced by them is most
7628
likely to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
7629
table.
7630
 
7631
@c This used to say "... following Chill related topics ...", but since
7632
@c menus are not shown in the printed manual, it would look awkward.
7633
This section covers the Chill related topics and the features
7634
of @value{GDBN} which support these topics.
7635
 
7636
@menu
7637
* How modes are displayed::        How modes are displayed
7638
* Locations::                        Locations and their accesses
7639
* Values and their Operations:: Values and their Operations
7640
* Chill type and range checks::
7641
* Chill defaults::
7642
@end menu
7643
 
7644
@node How modes are displayed
7645
@subsubsection How modes are displayed
7646
 
7647
The Chill Datatype- (Mode) support of @value{GDBN} is directly related
7648
with the functionality of the @sc{gnu} Chill compiler, and therefore deviates
7649
slightly from the standard specification of the Chill language. The
7650
provided modes are:
7651
 
7652
@c FIXME: this @table's contents effectively disable @code by using @r
7653
@c on every @item.  So why does it need @code?
7654
@table @code
7655
@item @r{@emph{Discrete modes:}}
7656
@itemize @bullet
7657
@item
7658
@emph{Integer Modes} which are predefined by @code{BYTE, UBYTE, INT,
7659
UINT, LONG, ULONG},
7660
@item
7661
@emph{Boolean Mode} which is predefined by @code{BOOL},
7662
@item
7663
@emph{Character Mode} which is predefined by @code{CHAR},
7664
@item
7665
@emph{Set Mode} which is displayed by the keyword @code{SET}.
7666
@smallexample
7667
(@value{GDBP}) ptype x
7668
type = SET (karli = 10, susi = 20, fritzi = 100)
7669
@end smallexample
7670
If the type is an unnumbered set the set element values are omitted.
7671
@item
7672
@emph{Range Mode} which is displayed by
7673
@smallexample
7674
@code{type = <basemode>(<lower bound> : <upper bound>)}
7675
@end smallexample
7676
where @code{<lower bound>, <upper bound>} can be of any discrete literal
7677
expression (e.g. set element names).
7678
@end itemize
7679
 
7680
@item @r{@emph{Powerset Mode:}}
7681
A Powerset Mode is displayed by the keyword @code{POWERSET} followed by
7682
the member mode of the powerset.  The member mode can be any discrete mode.
7683
@smallexample
7684
(@value{GDBP}) ptype x
7685
type = POWERSET SET (egon, hugo, otto)
7686
@end smallexample
7687
 
7688
@item @r{@emph{Reference Modes:}}
7689
@itemize @bullet
7690
@item
7691
@emph{Bound Reference Mode} which is displayed by the keyword @code{REF}
7692
followed by the mode name to which the reference is bound.
7693
@item
7694
@emph{Free Reference Mode} which is displayed by the keyword @code{PTR}.
7695
@end itemize
7696
 
7697
@item @r{@emph{Procedure mode}}
7698
The procedure mode is displayed by @code{type = PROC(<parameter list>)
7699
<return mode> EXCEPTIONS (<exception list>)}. The @code{<parameter
7700
list>} is a list of the parameter modes.  @code{<return mode>} indicates
7701
the mode of the result of the procedure if any.  The exceptionlist lists
7702
all possible exceptions which can be raised by the procedure.
7703
 
7704
@ignore
7705
@item @r{@emph{Instance mode}}
7706
The instance mode is represented by a structure, which has a static
7707
type, and is therefore not really of interest.
7708
@end ignore
7709
 
7710
@item @r{@emph{Synchronization Modes:}}
7711
@itemize @bullet
7712
@item
7713
@emph{Event Mode} which is displayed by
7714
@smallexample
7715
@code{EVENT (<event length>)}
7716
@end smallexample
7717
where @code{(<event length>)} is optional.
7718
@item
7719
@emph{Buffer Mode} which is displayed by
7720
@smallexample
7721
@code{BUFFER (<buffer length>)<buffer element mode>}
7722
@end smallexample
7723
where @code{(<buffer length>)} is optional.
7724
@end itemize
7725
 
7726
@item @r{@emph{Timing Modes:}}
7727
@itemize @bullet
7728
@item
7729
@emph{Duration Mode} which is predefined by @code{DURATION}
7730
@item
7731
@emph{Absolute Time Mode} which is predefined by @code{TIME}
7732
@end itemize
7733
 
7734
@item @r{@emph{Real Modes:}}
7735
Real Modes are predefined with @code{REAL} and @code{LONG_REAL}.
7736
 
7737
@item @r{@emph{String Modes:}}
7738
@itemize @bullet
7739
@item
7740
@emph{Character String Mode} which is displayed by
7741
@smallexample
7742
@code{CHARS(<string length>)}
7743
@end smallexample
7744
followed by the keyword @code{VARYING} if the String Mode is a varying
7745
mode
7746
@item
7747
@emph{Bit String Mode} which is displayed by
7748
@smallexample
7749
@code{BOOLS(<string
7750
length>)}
7751
@end smallexample
7752
@end itemize
7753
 
7754
@item @r{@emph{Array Mode:}}
7755
The Array Mode is displayed by the keyword @code{ARRAY(<range>)}
7756
followed by the element mode (which may in turn be an array mode).
7757
@smallexample
7758
(@value{GDBP}) ptype x
7759
type = ARRAY (1:42)
7760
          ARRAY (1:20)
7761
             SET (karli = 10, susi = 20, fritzi = 100)
7762
@end smallexample
7763
 
7764
@item @r{@emph{Structure Mode}}
7765
The Structure mode is displayed by the keyword @code{STRUCT(<field
7766
list>)}.  The @code{<field list>} consists of names and modes of fields
7767
of the structure.  Variant structures have the keyword @code{CASE <field>
7768
OF <variant fields> ESAC} in their field list.  Since the current version
7769
of the GNU Chill compiler doesn't implement tag processing (no runtime
7770
checks of variant fields, and therefore no debugging info), the output
7771
always displays all variant fields.
7772
@smallexample
7773
(@value{GDBP}) ptype str
7774
type = STRUCT (
7775
    as x,
7776
    bs x,
7777
    CASE bs OF
7778
    (karli):
7779
        cs a
7780
    (ott):
7781
        ds x
7782
    ESAC
7783
)
7784
@end smallexample
7785
@end table
7786
 
7787
@node Locations
7788
@subsubsection Locations and their accesses
7789
 
7790
A location in Chill is an object which can contain values.
7791
 
7792
A value of a location is generally accessed by the (declared) name of
7793
the location.  The output conforms to the specification of values in
7794
Chill programs.  How values are specified
7795
is the topic of the next section, @ref{Values and their Operations}.
7796
 
7797
The pseudo-location @code{RESULT} (or @code{result}) can be used to
7798
display or change the result of a currently-active procedure:
7799
 
7800
@smallexample
7801
set result := EXPR
7802
@end smallexample
7803
 
7804
@noindent
7805
This does the same as the Chill action @code{RESULT EXPR} (which
7806
is not available in @value{GDBN}).
7807
 
7808
Values of reference mode locations are printed by @code{PTR(<hex
7809
value>)} in case of a free reference mode, and by @code{(REF <reference
7810
mode>) (<hex-value>)} in case of a bound reference.  @code{<hex value>}
7811
represents the address where the reference points to.  To access the
7812
value of the location referenced by the pointer, use the dereference
7813
operator @samp{->}.
7814
 
7815
Values of procedure mode locations are displayed by
7816
@smallexample
7817
@code{@{ PROC
7818
(<argument modes> ) <return mode> @} <address> <name of procedure
7819
location>}
7820
@end smallexample
7821
@code{<argument modes>} is a list of modes according to the parameter
7822
specification of the procedure and @code{<address>} shows the address of
7823
the entry point.
7824
 
7825
@ignore
7826
Locations of instance modes are displayed just like a structure with two
7827
fields specifying the @emph{process type} and the @emph{copy number} of
7828
the investigated instance location@footnote{This comes from the current
7829
implementation of instances.  They are implemented as a structure (no
7830
na).  The output should be something like @code{[<name of the process>;
7831
<instance number>]}.}.  The field names are @code{__proc_type} and
7832
@code{__proc_copy}.
7833
 
7834
Locations of synchronization modes are displayed like a structure with
7835
the field name @code{__event_data} in case of a event mode location, and
7836
like a structure with the field @code{__buffer_data} in case of a buffer
7837
mode location (refer to previous paragraph).
7838
 
7839
Structure Mode locations are printed by @code{[.<field name>: <value>,
7840
...]}.  The @code{<field name>} corresponds to the structure mode
7841
definition and the layout of @code{<value>} varies depending of the mode
7842
of the field.  If the investigated structure mode location is of variant
7843
structure mode, the variant parts of the structure are enclosed in curled
7844
braces (@samp{@{@}}).  Fields enclosed by @samp{@{,@}} are residing
7845
on the same memory location and represent the current values of the
7846
memory location in their specific modes.  Since no tag processing is done
7847
all variants are displayed. A variant field is printed by
7848
@code{(<variant name>) = .<field name>: <value>}.  (who implements the
7849
stuff ???)
7850
@smallexample
7851
(@value{GDBP}) print str1 $4 = [.as: 0, .bs: karli, .<TAG>: { (karli) =
7852
[.cs: []], (susi) = [.ds: susi]}]
7853
@end smallexample
7854
@end ignore
7855
 
7856
Substructures of string mode-, array mode- or structure mode-values
7857
(e.g. array slices, fields of structure locations) are accessed using
7858
certain operations which are described in the next section, @ref{Values
7859
and their Operations}.
7860
 
7861
A location value may be interpreted as having a different mode using the
7862
location conversion.  This mode conversion is written as @code{<mode
7863
name>(<location>)}.  The user has to consider that the sizes of the modes
7864
have to be equal otherwise an error occurs.  Furthermore, no range
7865
checking of the location against the destination mode is performed, and
7866
therefore the result can be quite confusing.
7867
 
7868
@smallexample
7869
(@value{GDBP}) print int (s(3 up 4)) XXX TO be filled in !! XXX
7870
@end smallexample
7871
 
7872
@node Values and their Operations
7873
@subsubsection Values and their Operations
7874
 
7875
Values are used to alter locations, to investigate complex structures in
7876
more detail or to filter relevant information out of a large amount of
7877
data.  There are several (mode dependent) operations defined which enable
7878
such investigations.  These operations are not only applicable to
7879
constant values but also to locations, which can become quite useful
7880
when debugging complex structures.  During parsing the command line
7881
(e.g. evaluating an expression) @value{GDBN} treats location names as
7882
the values behind these locations.
7883
 
7884
This section describes how values have to be specified and which
7885
operations are legal to be used with such values.
7886
 
7887
@table @code
7888
@item Literal Values
7889
Literal values are specified in the same manner as in @sc{gnu} Chill programs.
7890
For detailed specification refer to the @sc{gnu} Chill implementation Manual
7891
chapter 1.5.
7892
@c FIXME: if the Chill Manual is a Texinfo documents, the above should
7893
@c be converted to a @ref.
7894
 
7895
@ignore
7896
@itemize @bullet
7897
@item
7898
@emph{Integer Literals} are specified in the same manner as in Chill
7899
programs (refer to the Chill Standard z200/88 chpt 5.2.4.2)
7900
@item
7901
@emph{Boolean Literals} are defined by @code{TRUE} and @code{FALSE}.
7902
@item
7903
@emph{Character Literals} are defined by @code{'<character>'}. (e.g.
7904
@code{'M'})
7905
@item
7906
@emph{Set Literals} are defined by a name which was specified in a set
7907
mode.  The value delivered by a Set Literal is the set value.  This is
7908
comparable to an enumeration in C/C@t{++} language.
7909
@item
7910
@emph{Emptiness Literal} is predefined by @code{NULL}.  The value of the
7911
emptiness literal delivers either the empty reference value, the empty
7912
procedure value or the empty instance value.
7913
 
7914
@item
7915
@emph{Character String Literals} are defined by a sequence of characters
7916
enclosed in single- or double quotes.  If a single- or double quote has
7917
to be part of the string literal it has to be stuffed (specified twice).
7918
@item
7919
@emph{Bitstring Literals} are specified in the same manner as in Chill
7920
programs (refer z200/88 chpt 5.2.4.8).
7921
@item
7922
@emph{Floating point literals} are specified in the same manner as in
7923
(gnu-)Chill programs (refer @sc{gnu} Chill implementation Manual chapter 1.5).
7924
@end itemize
7925
@end ignore
7926
 
7927
@item Tuple Values
7928
A tuple is specified by @code{<mode name>[<tuple>]}, where @code{<mode
7929
name>} can be omitted if the mode of the tuple is unambiguous.  This
7930
unambiguity is derived from the context of a evaluated expression.
7931
@code{<tuple>} can be one of the following:
7932
 
7933
@itemize @bullet
7934
@item @emph{Powerset Tuple}
7935
@item @emph{Array Tuple}
7936
@item @emph{Structure Tuple}
7937
Powerset tuples, array tuples and structure tuples are specified in the
7938
same manner as in Chill programs refer to z200/88 chpt 5.2.5.
7939
@end itemize
7940
 
7941
@item String Element Value
7942
A string element value is specified by
7943
@smallexample
7944
@code{<string value>(<index>)}
7945
@end smallexample
7946
where @code{<index>} is a integer expression.  It delivers a character
7947
value which is equivalent to the character indexed by @code{<index>} in
7948
the string.
7949
 
7950
@item String Slice Value
7951
A string slice value is specified by @code{<string value>(<slice
7952
spec>)}, where @code{<slice spec>} can be either a range of integer
7953
expressions or specified by @code{<start expr> up <size>}.
7954
@code{<size>} denotes the number of elements which the slice contains.
7955
The delivered value is a string value, which is part of the specified
7956
string.
7957
 
7958
@item Array Element Values
7959
An array element value is specified by @code{<array value>(<expr>)} and
7960
delivers a array element value of the mode of the specified array.
7961
 
7962
@item Array Slice Values
7963
An array slice is specified by @code{<array value>(<slice spec>)}, where
7964
@code{<slice spec>} can be either a range specified by expressions or by
7965
@code{<start expr> up <size>}.  @code{<size>} denotes the number of
7966
arrayelements the slice contains.  The delivered value is an array value
7967
which is part of the specified array.
7968
 
7969
@item Structure Field Values
7970
A structure field value is derived by @code{<structure value>.<field
7971
name>}, where @code{<field name>} indicates the name of a field specified
7972
in the mode definition of the structure.  The mode of the delivered value
7973
corresponds to this mode definition in the structure definition.
7974
 
7975
@item Procedure Call Value
7976
The procedure call value is derived from the return value of the
7977
procedure@footnote{If a procedure call is used for instance in an
7978
expression, then this procedure is called with all its side
7979
effects.  This can lead to confusing results if used carelessly.}.
7980
 
7981
Values of duration mode locations are represented by @code{ULONG} literals.
7982
 
7983
Values of time mode locations appear as
7984
@smallexample
7985
@code{TIME(<secs>:<nsecs>)}
7986
@end smallexample
7987
 
7988
 
7989
@ignore
7990
This is not implemented yet:
7991
@item Built-in Value
7992
@noindent
7993
The following built in functions are provided:
7994
 
7995
@table @code
7996
@item @code{ADDR()}
7997
@item @code{NUM()}
7998
@item @code{PRED()}
7999
@item @code{SUCC()}
8000
@item @code{ABS()}
8001
@item @code{CARD()}
8002
@item @code{MAX()}
8003
@item @code{MIN()}
8004
@item @code{SIZE()}
8005
@item @code{UPPER()}
8006
@item @code{LOWER()}
8007
@item @code{LENGTH()}
8008
@item @code{SIN()}
8009
@item @code{COS()}
8010
@item @code{TAN()}
8011
@item @code{ARCSIN()}
8012
@item @code{ARCCOS()}
8013
@item @code{ARCTAN()}
8014
@item @code{EXP()}
8015
@item @code{LN()}
8016
@item @code{LOG()}
8017
@item @code{SQRT()}
8018
@end table
8019
 
8020
For a detailed description refer to the GNU Chill implementation manual
8021
chapter 1.6.
8022
@end ignore
8023
 
8024
@item Zero-adic Operator Value
8025
The zero-adic operator value is derived from the instance value for the
8026
current active process.
8027
 
8028
@item Expression Values
8029
The value delivered by an expression is the result of the evaluation of
8030
the specified expression.  If there are error conditions (mode
8031
incompatibility, etc.) the evaluation of expressions is aborted with a
8032
corresponding error message.  Expressions may be parenthesised which
8033
causes the evaluation of this expression before any other expression
8034
which uses the result of the parenthesised expression.  The following
8035
operators are supported by @value{GDBN}:
8036
 
8037
@table @code
8038
@item @code{OR, ORIF, XOR}
8039
@itemx @code{AND, ANDIF}
8040
@itemx @code{NOT}
8041
Logical operators defined over operands of boolean mode.
8042
 
8043
@item @code{=, /=}
8044
Equality and inequality operators defined over all modes.
8045
 
8046
@item @code{>, >=}
8047
@itemx @code{<, <=}
8048
Relational operators defined over predefined modes.
8049
 
8050
@item @code{+, -}
8051
@itemx @code{*, /, MOD, REM}
8052
Arithmetic operators defined over predefined modes.
8053
 
8054
@item @code{-}
8055
Change sign operator.
8056
 
8057
@item @code{//}
8058
String concatenation operator.
8059
 
8060
@item @code{()}
8061
String repetition operator.
8062
 
8063
@item @code{->}
8064
Referenced location operator which can be used either to take the
8065
address of a location (@code{->loc}), or to dereference a reference
8066
location (@code{loc->}).
8067
 
8068
@item @code{OR, XOR}
8069
@itemx @code{AND}
8070
@itemx @code{NOT}
8071
Powerset and bitstring operators.
8072
 
8073
@item @code{>, >=}
8074
@itemx @code{<, <=}
8075
Powerset inclusion operators.
8076
 
8077
@item @code{IN}
8078
Membership operator.
8079
@end table
8080
@end table
8081
 
8082
@node Chill type and range checks
8083
@subsubsection Chill type and range checks
8084
 
8085
@value{GDBN} considers two Chill variables mode equivalent if the sizes
8086
of the two modes are equal.  This rule applies recursively to more
8087
complex datatypes which means that complex modes are treated
8088
equivalent if all element modes (which also can be complex modes like
8089
structures, arrays, etc.) have the same size.
8090
 
8091
Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
8092
index bounds and all built in procedures.
8093
 
8094
Strong type checks are forced using the @value{GDBN} command @code{set
8095
check strong}.  This enforces strong type and range checks on all
8096
operations where Chill constructs are used (expressions, built in
8097
functions, etc.) in respect to the semantics as defined in the z.200
8098
language specification.
8099
 
8100
All checks can be disabled by the @value{GDBN} command @code{set check
8101
off}.
8102
 
8103
@ignore
8104
@c Deviations from the Chill Standard Z200/88
8105
see last paragraph ?
8106
@end ignore
8107
 
8108
@node Chill defaults
8109
@subsubsection Chill defaults
8110
 
8111
If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
8112
both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
8113
Chill.  This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
8114
selected the working language.
8115
 
8116
If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
8117
code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.ch} sets the
8118
working language to Chill.  @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} set
8119
the language automatically}, for further details.
8120
 
8121
@node Symbols
8122
@chapter Examining the Symbol Table
8123
 
8124
The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
8125
symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
8126
program.  This information is inherent in the text of your program and
8127
does not change as your program executes.  @value{GDBN} finds it in your
8128
program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
8129
(@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing files}), or by one of the
8130
file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
8131
 
8132
@cindex symbol names
8133
@cindex names of symbols
8134
@cindex quoting names
8135
Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
8136
characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters.  The
8137
most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
8138
source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program variables}).  File names
8139
are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
8140
ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
8141
@samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}.  To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
8142
@samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
8143
 
8144
@example
8145
p 'foo.c'::x
8146
@end example
8147
 
8148
@noindent
8149
looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
8150
 
8151
@table @code
8152
@kindex info address
8153
@cindex address of a symbol
8154
@item info address @var{symbol}
8155
Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored.  For a register
8156
variable, this says which register it is kept in.  For a non-register
8157
local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
8158
is always stored.
8159
 
8160
Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
8161
at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
8162
the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
8163
 
8164
@kindex info symbol
8165
@cindex symbol from address
8166
@item info symbol @var{addr}
8167
Print the name of a symbol which is stored at the address @var{addr}.
8168
If no symbol is stored exactly at @var{addr}, @value{GDBN} prints the
8169
nearest symbol and an offset from it:
8170
 
8171
@example
8172
(@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x54320
8173
_initialize_vx + 396 in section .text
8174
@end example
8175
 
8176
@noindent
8177
This is the opposite of the @code{info address} command.  You can use
8178
it to find out the name of a variable or a function given its address.
8179
 
8180
@kindex whatis
8181
@item whatis @var{expr}
8182
Print the data type of expression @var{expr}.  @var{expr} is not
8183
actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
8184
assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place.
8185
@xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
8186
 
8187
@item whatis
8188
Print the data type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
8189
 
8190
@kindex ptype
8191
@item ptype @var{typename}
8192
Print a description of data type @var{typename}.  @var{typename} may be
8193
the name of a type, or for C code it may have the form @samp{class
8194
@var{class-name}}, @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union
8195
@var{union-tag}} or @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
8196
 
8197
@item ptype @var{expr}
8198
@itemx ptype
8199
Print a description of the type of expression @var{expr}.  @code{ptype}
8200
differs from @code{whatis} by printing a detailed description, instead
8201
of just the name of the type.
8202
 
8203
For example, for this variable declaration:
8204
 
8205
@example
8206
struct complex @{double real; double imag;@} v;
8207
@end example
8208
 
8209
@noindent
8210
the two commands give this output:
8211
 
8212
@example
8213
@group
8214
(@value{GDBP}) whatis v
8215
type = struct complex
8216
(@value{GDBP}) ptype v
8217
type = struct complex @{
8218
    double real;
8219
    double imag;
8220
@}
8221
@end group
8222
@end example
8223
 
8224
@noindent
8225
As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
8226
the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
8227
 
8228
@kindex info types
8229
@item info types @var{regexp}
8230
@itemx info types
8231
Print a brief description of all types whose names match @var{regexp}
8232
(or all types in your program, if you supply no argument).  Each
8233
complete typename is matched as though it were a complete line; thus,
8234
@samp{i type value} gives information on all types in your program whose
8235
names include the string @code{value}, but @samp{i type ^value$} gives
8236
information only on types whose complete name is @code{value}.
8237
 
8238
This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
8239
@code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
8240
lists all source files where a type is defined.
8241
 
8242
@kindex info scope
8243
@cindex local variables
8244
@item info scope @var{addr}
8245
List all the variables local to a particular scope.  This command
8246
accepts a location---a function name, a source line, or an address
8247
preceded by a @samp{*}, and prints all the variables local to the
8248
scope defined by that location.  For example:
8249
 
8250
@smallexample
8251
(@value{GDBP}) @b{info scope command_line_handler}
8252
Scope for command_line_handler:
8253
Symbol rl is an argument at stack/frame offset 8, length 4.
8254
Symbol linebuffer is in static storage at address 0x150a18, length 4.
8255
Symbol linelength is in static storage at address 0x150a1c, length 4.
8256
Symbol p is a local variable in register $esi, length 4.
8257
Symbol p1 is a local variable in register $ebx, length 4.
8258
Symbol nline is a local variable in register $edx, length 4.
8259
Symbol repeat is a local variable at frame offset -8, length 4.
8260
@end smallexample
8261
 
8262
@noindent
8263
This command is especially useful for determining what data to collect
8264
during a @dfn{trace experiment}, see @ref{Tracepoint Actions,
8265
collect}.
8266
 
8267
@kindex info source
8268
@item info source
8269
Show the name of the current source file---that is, the source file for
8270
the function containing the current point of execution---and the language
8271
it was written in.
8272
 
8273
@kindex info sources
8274
@item info sources
8275
Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
8276
debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
8277
have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
8278
 
8279
@kindex info functions
8280
@item info functions
8281
Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
8282
 
8283
@item info functions @var{regexp}
8284
Print the names and data types of all defined functions
8285
whose names contain a match for regular expression @var{regexp}.
8286
Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose names
8287
include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
8288
start with @code{step}.
8289
 
8290
@kindex info variables
8291
@item info variables
8292
Print the names and data types of all variables that are declared
8293
outside of functions (i.e., excluding local variables).
8294
 
8295
@item info variables @var{regexp}
8296
Print the names and data types of all variables (except for local
8297
variables) whose names contain a match for regular expression
8298
@var{regexp}.
8299
 
8300
@ignore
8301
This was never implemented.
8302
@kindex info methods
8303
@item info methods
8304
@itemx info methods @var{regexp}
8305
The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
8306
methods within C@t{++} program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
8307
specific set of methods found in the various C@t{++} classes.  Many
8308
C@t{++} classes provide a large number of methods.  Thus, the output
8309
from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use.  The
8310
@code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
8311
which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
8312
@end ignore
8313
 
8314
@cindex reloading symbols
8315
Some systems allow individual object files that make up your program to
8316
be replaced without stopping and restarting your program.  For example,
8317
in VxWorks you can simply recompile a defective object file and keep on
8318
running.  If you are running on one of these systems, you can allow
8319
@value{GDBN} to reload the symbols for automatically relinked modules:
8320
 
8321
@table @code
8322
@kindex set symbol-reloading
8323
@item set symbol-reloading on
8324
Replace symbol definitions for the corresponding source file when an
8325
object file with a particular name is seen again.
8326
 
8327
@item set symbol-reloading off
8328
Do not replace symbol definitions when encountering object files of the
8329
same name more than once.  This is the default state; if you are not
8330
running on a system that permits automatic relinking of modules, you
8331
should leave @code{symbol-reloading} off, since otherwise @value{GDBN}
8332
may discard symbols when linking large programs, that may contain
8333
several modules (from different directories or libraries) with the same
8334
name.
8335
 
8336
@kindex show symbol-reloading
8337
@item show symbol-reloading
8338
Show the current @code{on} or @code{off} setting.
8339
@end table
8340
 
8341
@kindex set opaque-type-resolution
8342
@item set opaque-type-resolution on
8343
Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types.  An opaque type is a type
8344
declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
8345
@code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
8346
source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
8347
another source file.  The default is on.
8348
 
8349
A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
8350
the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
8351
 
8352
@item set opaque-type-resolution off
8353
Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types.  In this case, the type
8354
is printed as follows:
8355
@smallexample
8356
@{<no data fields>@}
8357
@end smallexample
8358
 
8359
@kindex show opaque-type-resolution
8360
@item show opaque-type-resolution
8361
Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
8362
 
8363
@kindex maint print symbols
8364
@cindex symbol dump
8365
@kindex maint print psymbols
8366
@cindex partial symbol dump
8367
@item maint print symbols @var{filename}
8368
@itemx maint print psymbols @var{filename}
8369
@itemx maint print msymbols @var{filename}
8370
Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename}.
8371
These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code.  Only
8372
symbols with debugging data are included.  If you use @samp{maint print
8373
symbols}, @value{GDBN} includes all the symbols for which it has already
8374
collected full details: that is, @var{filename} reflects symbols for
8375
only those files whose symbols @value{GDBN} has read.  You can use the
8376
command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are.  If you
8377
use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information about
8378
symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols defined in
8379
files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely.  Finally,
8380
@samp{maint print msymbols} dumps just the minimal symbol information
8381
required for each object file from which @value{GDBN} has read some symbols.
8382
@xref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}, for a discussion of how
8383
@value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
8384
@end table
8385
 
8386
@node Altering
8387
@chapter Altering Execution
8388
 
8389
Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
8390
find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
8391
correct results in the rest of the run.  You can find the answer by
8392
experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
8393
program.
8394
 
8395
For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
8396
locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
8397
address, or even return prematurely from a function.
8398
 
8399
@menu
8400
* Assignment::                  Assignment to variables
8401
* Jumping::                     Continuing at a different address
8402
* Signaling::                   Giving your program a signal
8403
* Returning::                   Returning from a function
8404
* Calling::                     Calling your program's functions
8405
* Patching::                    Patching your program
8406
@end menu
8407
 
8408
@node Assignment
8409
@section Assignment to variables
8410
 
8411
@cindex assignment
8412
@cindex setting variables
8413
To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
8414
@xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.  For example,
8415
 
8416
@example
8417
print x=4
8418
@end example
8419
 
8420
@noindent
8421
stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
8422
value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
8423
@xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
8424
information on operators in supported languages.
8425
 
8426
@kindex set variable
8427
@cindex variables, setting
8428
If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
8429
@code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command.  @code{set} is
8430
really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
8431
not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
8432
,Value history}).  The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
8433
 
8434
If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
8435
appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
8436
variable} command instead of just @code{set}.  This command is identical
8437
to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands.  For example, if your
8438
program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
8439
a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
8440
command @code{set width}:
8441
 
8442
@example
8443
(@value{GDBP}) whatis width
8444
type = double
8445
(@value{GDBP}) p width
8446
$4 = 13
8447
(@value{GDBP}) set width=47
8448
Invalid syntax in expression.
8449
@end example
8450
 
8451
@noindent
8452
The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}.  In
8453
order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
8454
 
8455
@example
8456
(@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
8457
@end example
8458
 
8459
Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
8460
with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
8461
@code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}.  For example, if
8462
your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
8463
to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
8464
the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
8465
 
8466
@example
8467
@group
8468
(@value{GDBP}) whatis g
8469
type = double
8470
(@value{GDBP}) p g
8471
$1 = 1
8472
(@value{GDBP}) set g=4
8473
(@value{GDBP}) p g
8474
$2 = 1
8475
(@value{GDBP}) r
8476
The program being debugged has been started already.
8477
Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
8478
Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
8479
"/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols:
8480
                                 Invalid bfd target.
8481
(@value{GDBP}) show g
8482
The current BFD target is "=4".
8483
@end group
8484
@end example
8485
 
8486
@noindent
8487
The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
8488
@code{gnutarget} to an invalid value.  In order to set the variable
8489
@code{g}, use
8490
 
8491
@example
8492
(@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
8493
@end example
8494
 
8495
@value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
8496
freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
8497
and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
8498
same length or shorter.
8499
@comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
8500
@comment        /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
8501
 
8502
To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
8503
construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
8504
(@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).  For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
8505
to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
8506
and representation in memory), and
8507
 
8508
@example
8509
set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
8510
@end example
8511
 
8512
@noindent
8513
stores the value 4 into that memory location.
8514
 
8515
@node Jumping
8516
@section Continuing at a different address
8517
 
8518
Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
8519
it stopped, with the @code{continue} command.  You can instead continue at
8520
an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
8521
 
8522
@table @code
8523
@kindex jump
8524
@item jump @var{linespec}
8525
Resume execution at line @var{linespec}.  Execution stops again
8526
immediately if there is a breakpoint there.  @xref{List, ,Printing
8527
source lines}, for a description of the different forms of
8528
@var{linespec}.  It is common practice to use the @code{tbreak} command
8529
in conjunction with @code{jump}.  @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
8530
breakpoints}.
8531
 
8532
The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
8533
the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
8534
register other than the program counter.  If line @var{linespec} is in
8535
a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
8536
be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
8537
of local variables.  For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
8538
confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
8539
executing.  However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
8540
well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
8541
 
8542
@item jump *@var{address}
8543
Resume execution at the instruction at address @var{address}.
8544
@end table
8545
 
8546
@c Doesn't work on HP-UX; have to set $pcoqh and $pcoqt.
8547
On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
8548
command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}.  The
8549
difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
8550
changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue.  For
8551
example,
8552
 
8553
@example
8554
set $pc = 0x485
8555
@end example
8556
 
8557
@noindent
8558
makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
8559
address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
8560
@xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and stepping}.
8561
 
8562
The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
8563
up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
8564
that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
8565
detail.
8566
 
8567
@c @group
8568
@node Signaling
8569
@section Giving your program a signal
8570
 
8571
@table @code
8572
@kindex signal
8573
@item signal @var{signal}
8574
Resume execution where your program stopped, but immediately give it the
8575
signal @var{signal}.  @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
8576
signal.  For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
8577
SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
8578
 
8579
Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
8580
giving a signal.  This is useful when your program stopped on account of
8581
a signal and would ordinary see the signal when resumed with the
8582
@code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
8583
signal.
8584
 
8585
@code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
8586
after executing the command.
8587
@end table
8588
@c @end group
8589
 
8590
Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
8591
@code{kill} utility from the shell.  Sending a signal with @code{kill}
8592
causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
8593
the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}).  The @code{signal} command
8594
passes the signal directly to your program.
8595
 
8596
 
8597
@node Returning
8598
@section Returning from a function
8599
 
8600
@table @code
8601
@cindex returning from a function
8602
@kindex return
8603
@item return
8604
@itemx return @var{expression}
8605
You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
8606
command.  If you give an
8607
@var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
8608
value.
8609
@end table
8610
 
8611
When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
8612
(and all frames within it).  You can think of this as making the
8613
discarded frame return prematurely.  If you wish to specify a value to
8614
be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
8615
 
8616
This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
8617
frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
8618
innermost remaining frame.  That frame becomes selected.  The
8619
specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
8620
of functions.
8621
 
8622
The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
8623
program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
8624
returned.  In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
8625
and Stepping, ,Continuing and stepping}) resumes execution until the
8626
selected stack frame returns naturally.
8627
 
8628
@node Calling
8629
@section Calling program functions
8630
 
8631
@cindex calling functions
8632
@kindex call
8633
@table @code
8634
@item call @var{expr}
8635
Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
8636
returned values.
8637
@end table
8638
 
8639
You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
8640
execute a function from your program, but without cluttering the output
8641
with @code{void} returned values.  If the result is not void, it
8642
is printed and saved in the value history.
8643
 
8644
For the A29K, a user-controlled variable @code{call_scratch_address},
8645
specifies the location of a scratch area to be used when @value{GDBN}
8646
calls a function in the target.  This is necessary because the usual
8647
method of putting the scratch area on the stack does not work in systems
8648
that have separate instruction and data spaces.
8649
 
8650
@node Patching
8651
@section Patching programs
8652
 
8653
@cindex patching binaries
8654
@cindex writing into executables
8655
@cindex writing into corefiles
8656
 
8657
By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
8658
executable code (or the corefile) read-only.  This prevents accidental
8659
alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
8660
patching your program's binary.
8661
 
8662
If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
8663
explicitly with the @code{set write} command.  For example, you might
8664
want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
8665
repairs.
8666
 
8667
@table @code
8668
@kindex set write
8669
@item set write on
8670
@itemx set write off
8671
If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
8672
core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @samp{set write
8673
off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
8674
 
8675
If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
8676
@code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
8677
write}, for your new setting to take effect.
8678
 
8679
@item show write
8680
@kindex show write
8681
Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
8682
as well as reading.
8683
@end table
8684
 
8685
@node GDB Files
8686
@chapter @value{GDBN} Files
8687
 
8688
@value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
8689
both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
8690
program.  To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
8691
@value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
8692
 
8693
@menu
8694
* Files::                       Commands to specify files
8695
* Symbol Errors::               Errors reading symbol files
8696
@end menu
8697
 
8698
@node Files
8699
@section Commands to specify files
8700
 
8701
@cindex symbol table
8702
@cindex core dump file
8703
 
8704
You may want to specify executable and core dump file names.  The usual
8705
way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
8706
@value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
8707
Out of @value{GDBN}}).
8708
 
8709
Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
8710
@value{GDBN} session.  Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to specify
8711
a file you want to use.  In these situations the @value{GDBN} commands
8712
to specify new files are useful.
8713
 
8714
@table @code
8715
@cindex executable file
8716
@kindex file
8717
@item file @var{filename}
8718
Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged.  It is read for its
8719
symbols and for the contents of pure memory.  It is also the program
8720
executed when you use the @code{run} command.  If you do not specify a
8721
directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
8722
@value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
8723
directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
8724
to run.  You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
8725
and your program, using the @code{path} command.
8726
 
8727
On systems with memory-mapped files, an auxiliary file named
8728
@file{@var{filename}.syms} may hold symbol table information for
8729
@var{filename}.  If so, @value{GDBN} maps in the symbol table from
8730
@file{@var{filename}.syms}, starting up more quickly.  See the
8731
descriptions of the file options @samp{-mapped} and @samp{-readnow}
8732
(available on the command line, and with the commands @code{file},
8733
@code{symbol-file}, or @code{add-symbol-file}, described below),
8734
for more information.
8735
 
8736
@item file
8737
@code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
8738
has on both executable file and the symbol table.
8739
 
8740
@kindex exec-file
8741
@item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
8742
Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
8743
in @var{filename}.  @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
8744
if necessary to locate your program.  Omitting @var{filename} means to
8745
discard information on the executable file.
8746
 
8747
@kindex symbol-file
8748
@item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
8749
Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}.  @code{PATH} is
8750
searched when necessary.  Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
8751
table and program to run from the same file.
8752
 
8753
@code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
8754
program's symbol table.
8755
 
8756
The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents
8757
of its convenience variables, the value history, and all breakpoints and
8758
auto-display expressions.  This is because they may contain pointers to
8759
the internal data recording symbols and data types, which are part of
8760
the old symbol table data being discarded inside @value{GDBN}.
8761
 
8762
@code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
8763
executing it once.
8764
 
8765
When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
8766
understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
8767
generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
8768
other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
8769
Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
8770
using @code{@value{GCC}} you can generate debugging information for
8771
optimized code.
8772
 
8773
For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
8774
using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
8775
symbol table in full right away.  Instead, it scans the symbol table
8776
quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present.  The
8777
details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
8778
 
8779
The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
8780
start up faster.  For the most part, it is invisible except for
8781
occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
8782
file are being read.  (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
8783
pauses into messages if desired.  @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
8784
warnings and messages}.)
8785
 
8786
We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet.  When the
8787
symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
8788
symbol table data in full right away.  Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
8789
still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
8790
in stabs format.
8791
 
8792
@kindex readnow
8793
@cindex reading symbols immediately
8794
@cindex symbols, reading immediately
8795
@kindex mapped
8796
@cindex memory-mapped symbol file
8797
@cindex saving symbol table
8798
@item symbol-file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @r{[} -mapped @r{]}
8799
@itemx file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @r{[} -mapped @r{]}
8800
You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
8801
tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
8802
load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
8803
entire symbol table available.
8804
 
8805
If memory-mapped files are available on your system through the
8806
@code{mmap} system call, you can use another option, @samp{-mapped}, to
8807
cause @value{GDBN} to write the symbols for your program into a reusable
8808
file.  Future @value{GDBN} debugging sessions map in symbol information
8809
from this auxiliary symbol file (if the program has not changed), rather
8810
than spending time reading the symbol table from the executable
8811
program.  Using the @samp{-mapped} option has the same effect as
8812
starting @value{GDBN} with the @samp{-mapped} command-line option.
8813
 
8814
You can use both options together, to make sure the auxiliary symbol
8815
file has all the symbol information for your program.
8816
 
8817
The auxiliary symbol file for a program called @var{myprog} is called
8818
@samp{@var{myprog}.syms}.  Once this file exists (so long as it is newer
8819
than the corresponding executable), @value{GDBN} always attempts to use
8820
it when you debug @var{myprog}; no special options or commands are
8821
needed.
8822
 
8823
The @file{.syms} file is specific to the host machine where you run
8824
@value{GDBN}.  It holds an exact image of the internal @value{GDBN}
8825
symbol table.  It cannot be shared across multiple host platforms.
8826
 
8827
@c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
8828
@c flux.  13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
8829
@c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
8830
@c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
8831
@c only current dir is used.  FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
8832
@c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
8833
@c files.
8834
 
8835
@kindex core
8836
@kindex core-file
8837
@item core-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
8838
Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
8839
of memory''.  Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
8840
address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
8841
executable file itself for other parts.
8842
 
8843
@code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
8844
to be used.
8845
 
8846
Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
8847
under @value{GDBN}.  So, if you have been running your program and you
8848
wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
8849
the program is running.  To do this, use the @code{kill} command
8850
(@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the child process}).
8851
 
8852
@kindex add-symbol-file
8853
@cindex dynamic linking
8854
@item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address}
8855
@itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @r{[} -mapped @r{]}
8856
@itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @r{-s}@var{section} @var{address}
8857
The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table
8858
information from the file @var{filename}.  You would use this command
8859
when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means)
8860
into the program that is running.  @var{address} should be the memory
8861
address at which the file has been loaded; @value{GDBN} cannot figure
8862
this out for itself.  You can additionally specify an arbitrary number
8863
of @samp{@r{-s}@var{section} @var{address}} pairs, to give an explicit
8864
section name and base address for that section.  You can specify any
8865
@var{address} as an expression.
8866
 
8867
The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
8868
originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command.  You can use the
8869
@code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data
8870
thus read keeps adding to the old.  To discard all old symbol data
8871
instead, use the @code{symbol-file} command without any arguments.
8872
 
8873
@code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
8874
 
8875
You can use the @samp{-mapped} and @samp{-readnow} options just as with
8876
the @code{symbol-file} command, to change how @value{GDBN} manages the symbol
8877
table information for @var{filename}.
8878
 
8879
@kindex add-shared-symbol-file
8880
@item add-shared-symbol-file
8881
The @code{add-shared-symbol-file} command can be used only under Harris' CXUX
8882
operating system for the Motorola 88k.  @value{GDBN} automatically looks for
8883
shared libraries, however if @value{GDBN} does not find yours, you can run
8884
@code{add-shared-symbol-file}.  It takes no arguments.
8885
 
8886
@kindex section
8887
@item section
8888
The @code{section} command changes the base address of section SECTION of
8889
the exec file to ADDR.  This can be used if the exec file does not contain
8890
section addresses, (such as in the a.out format), or when the addresses
8891
specified in the file itself are wrong.  Each section must be changed
8892
separately.  The @code{info files} command, described below, lists all
8893
the sections and their addresses.
8894
 
8895
@kindex info files
8896
@kindex info target
8897
@item info files
8898
@itemx info target
8899
@code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
8900
current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
8901
including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
8902
use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded.  The
8903
command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
8904
current ones.
8905
 
8906
@end table
8907
 
8908
All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
8909
as arguments.  @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
8910
name and remembers it that way.
8911
 
8912
@cindex shared libraries
8913
@value{GDBN} supports HP-UX, SunOS, SVr4, Irix 5, and IBM RS/6000 shared
8914
libraries.
8915
 
8916
@value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
8917
when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
8918
(Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
8919
references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
8920
debugging a core file).
8921
 
8922
On HP-UX, if the program loads a library explicitly, @value{GDBN}
8923
automatically loads the symbols at the time of the @code{shl_load} call.
8924
 
8925
@c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
8926
@c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
8927
@c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
8928
 
8929
@table @code
8930
@kindex info sharedlibrary
8931
@kindex info share
8932
@item info share
8933
@itemx info sharedlibrary
8934
Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded.
8935
 
8936
@kindex sharedlibrary
8937
@kindex share
8938
@item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
8939
@itemx share @var{regex}
8940
Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
8941
Unix regular expression.
8942
As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
8943
required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}.  If
8944
@var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
8945
loaded.
8946
@end table
8947
 
8948
On HP-UX systems, @value{GDBN} detects the loading of a shared library
8949
and automatically reads in symbols from the newly loaded library, up to
8950
a threshold that is initially set but that you can modify if you wish.
8951
 
8952
Beyond that threshold, symbols from shared libraries must be explicitly
8953
loaded.  To load these symbols, use the command @code{sharedlibrary
8954
@var{filename}}.  The base address of the shared library is determined
8955
automatically by @value{GDBN} and need not be specified.
8956
 
8957
To display or set the threshold, use the commands:
8958
 
8959
@table @code
8960
@kindex set auto-solib-add
8961
@item set auto-solib-add @var{threshold}
8962
Set the autoloading size threshold, in megabytes.  If @var{threshold} is
8963
nonzero, symbols from all shared object libraries will be loaded
8964
automatically when the inferior begins execution or when the dynamic
8965
linker informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded, until
8966
the symbol table of the program and libraries exceeds this threshold.
8967
Otherwise, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
8968
@code{sharedlibrary} command.  The default threshold is 100 megabytes.
8969
 
8970
@kindex show auto-solib-add
8971
@item show auto-solib-add
8972
Display the current autoloading size threshold, in megabytes.
8973
@end table
8974
 
8975
@node Symbol Errors
8976
@section Errors reading symbol files
8977
 
8978
While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
8979
such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
8980
output.  By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
8981
they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
8982
debugging compilers.  If you are interested in seeing information
8983
about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
8984
only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
8985
times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
8986
to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
8987
complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
8988
messages}).
8989
 
8990
The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
8991
 
8992
@table @code
8993
@item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
8994
 
8995
The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
8996
(such as at the start of a function or a block of statements).  This
8997
error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
8998
in its outer scope blocks.
8999
 
9000
@value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
9001
the same scope as the outer block.  In the error message, @var{symbol}
9002
may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
9003
function.
9004
 
9005
@item block at @var{address} out of order
9006
 
9007
The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
9008
order of increasing addresses.  This error indicates that it does not
9009
do so.
9010
 
9011
@value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
9012
locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading.  (You
9013
can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
9014
@code{set verbose on}.  @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
9015
messages}.)
9016
 
9017
@item bad block start address patched
9018
 
9019
The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
9020
smaller than the address of the preceding source line.  This is known
9021
to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
9022
 
9023
@value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
9024
starting on the previous source line.
9025
 
9026
@item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
9027
 
9028
@cindex foo
9029
Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
9030
larger than the size of the string table.
9031
 
9032
@value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
9033
name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
9034
with this name.
9035
 
9036
@item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
9037
 
9038
The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
9039
not yet know how to read.  @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
9040
uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
9041
 
9042
@value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
9043
This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
9044
are not accessible.  If you encounter such a problem and feel like
9045
debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
9046
on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
9047
and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
9048
 
9049
@item stub type has NULL name
9050
 
9051
@value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
9052
 
9053
@item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
9054
The symbol information for a C@t{++} member function is missing some
9055
information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
9056
it.
9057
 
9058
@item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
9059
 
9060
@value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
9061
 
9062
@end table
9063
 
9064
@node Targets
9065
@chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
9066
 
9067
@cindex debugging target
9068
@kindex target
9069
 
9070
A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
9071
 
9072
Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
9073
in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
9074
you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands.  When you need more
9075
flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
9076
host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
9077
realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
9078
command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
9079
(@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for managing targets}).
9080
 
9081
@menu
9082
* Active Targets::              Active targets
9083
* Target Commands::             Commands for managing targets
9084
* Byte Order::                  Choosing target byte order
9085
* Remote::                      Remote debugging
9086
* KOD::                         Kernel Object Display
9087
 
9088
@end menu
9089
 
9090
@node Active Targets
9091
@section Active targets
9092
 
9093
@cindex stacking targets
9094
@cindex active targets
9095
@cindex multiple targets
9096
 
9097
There are three classes of targets: processes, core files, and
9098
executable files.  @value{GDBN} can work concurrently on up to three
9099
active targets, one in each class.  This allows you to (for example)
9100
start a process and inspect its activity without abandoning your work on
9101
a core file.
9102
 
9103
For example, if you execute @samp{gdb a.out}, then the executable file
9104
@code{a.out} is the only active target.  If you designate a core file as
9105
well---presumably from a prior run that crashed and coredumped---then
9106
@value{GDBN} has two active targets and uses them in tandem, looking
9107
first in the corefile target, then in the executable file, to satisfy
9108
requests for memory addresses.  (Typically, these two classes of target
9109
are complementary, since core files contain only a program's
9110
read-write memory---variables and so on---plus machine status, while
9111
executable files contain only the program text and initialized data.)
9112
 
9113
When you type @code{run}, your executable file becomes an active process
9114
target as well.  When a process target is active, all @value{GDBN}
9115
commands requesting memory addresses refer to that target; addresses in
9116
an active core file or executable file target are obscured while the
9117
process target is active.
9118
 
9119
Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new
9120
core file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify
9121
files}).  To specify as a target a process that is already running, use
9122
the @code{attach} command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an already-running
9123
process}).
9124
 
9125
@node Target Commands
9126
@section Commands for managing targets
9127
 
9128
@table @code
9129
@item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
9130
Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
9131
process.  A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
9132
facilities.  You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
9133
protocol of the target machine.
9134
 
9135
Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
9136
typically include things like device names or host names to connect
9137
with, process numbers, and baud rates.
9138
 
9139
The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
9140
after executing the command.
9141
 
9142
@kindex help target
9143
@item help target
9144
Displays the names of all targets available.  To display targets
9145
currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
9146
(@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
9147
 
9148
@item help target @var{name}
9149
Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
9150
select it.
9151
 
9152
@kindex set gnutarget
9153
@item set gnutarget @var{args}
9154
@value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files.  @value{GDBN}
9155
knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
9156
a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
9157
with the @code{set gnutarget} command.  Unlike most @code{target} commands,
9158
with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
9159
 
9160
@quotation
9161
@emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
9162
you must know the actual BFD name.
9163
@end quotation
9164
 
9165
@noindent
9166
@xref{Files, , Commands to specify files}.
9167
 
9168
@kindex show gnutarget
9169
@item show gnutarget
9170
Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
9171
@code{gnutarget} is set to read.  If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
9172
@value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
9173
and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BDF target is "auto"}.
9174
@end table
9175
 
9176
Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
9177
configuration):
9178
 
9179
@table @code
9180
@kindex target exec
9181
@item target exec @var{program}
9182
An executable file.  @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
9183
@samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
9184
 
9185
@kindex target core
9186
@item target core @var{filename}
9187
A core dump file.  @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
9188
@samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
9189
 
9190
@kindex target remote
9191
@item target remote @var{dev}
9192
Remote serial target in GDB-specific protocol.  The argument @var{dev}
9193
specifies what serial device to use for the connection (e.g.
9194
@file{/dev/ttya}). @xref{Remote, ,Remote debugging}.  @code{target remote}
9195
supports the @code{load} command.  This is only useful if you have
9196
some other way of getting the stub to the target system, and you can put
9197
it somewhere in memory where it won't get clobbered by the download.
9198
 
9199
@kindex target sim
9200
@item target sim
9201
Builtin CPU simulator.  @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
9202
In general,
9203
@example
9204
        target sim
9205
        load
9206
        run
9207
@end example
9208
@noindent
9209
works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
9210
drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
9211
provide these.  For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
9212
see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
9213
Processors}.
9214
 
9215
@end table
9216
 
9217
Some configurations may include these targets as well:
9218
 
9219
@table @code
9220
 
9221
@kindex target nrom
9222
@item target nrom @var{dev}
9223
NetROM ROM emulator.  This target only supports downloading.
9224
 
9225
@end table
9226
 
9227
Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
9228
your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
9229
 
9230
Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code
9231
once you've successfully established a connection.
9232
 
9233
@table @code
9234
 
9235
@kindex load @var{filename}
9236
@item load @var{filename}
9237
Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
9238
@value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available.  Where it exists, it
9239
is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
9240
on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
9241
@code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
9242
the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
9243
 
9244
If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
9245
execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
9246
target is @dots{}}''
9247
 
9248
The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
9249
For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
9250
link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
9251
specifies a fixed address.
9252
@c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
9253
 
9254
@code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
9255
@end table
9256
 
9257
@node Byte Order
9258
@section Choosing target byte order
9259
 
9260
@cindex choosing target byte order
9261
@cindex target byte order
9262
 
9263
Some types of processors, such as the MIPS, PowerPC, and Hitachi SH,
9264
offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
9265
orders.  Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
9266
designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
9267
which to use.  However, you may still find it useful to adjust
9268
@value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
9269
 
9270
@table @code
9271
@kindex set endian big
9272
@item set endian big
9273
Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
9274
 
9275
@kindex set endian little
9276
@item set endian little
9277
Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
9278
 
9279
@kindex set endian auto
9280
@item set endian auto
9281
Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
9282
executable.
9283
 
9284
@item show endian
9285
Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
9286
 
9287
@end table
9288
 
9289
Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
9290
data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
9291
target system.
9292
 
9293
@node Remote
9294
@section Remote debugging
9295
@cindex remote debugging
9296
 
9297
If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
9298
@value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
9299
For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
9300
or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
9301
powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
9302
 
9303
Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
9304
to make this work with particular debugging targets.  In addition,
9305
@value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
9306
but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
9307
write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
9308
communicate with @value{GDBN}.
9309
 
9310
Other remote targets may be available in your
9311
configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
9312
 
9313
@menu
9314
* Remote Serial::               @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol
9315
@end menu
9316
 
9317
@node Remote Serial
9318
@subsection The @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol
9319
 
9320
@cindex remote serial debugging, overview
9321
To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
9322
@dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
9323
prerequisites for the program to run by itself.  For example, for a C
9324
program, you need:
9325
 
9326
@enumerate
9327
@item
9328
A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
9329
have a name like @file{crt0}.  The startup routine may be supplied by
9330
your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
9331
 
9332
@item
9333
A C subroutine library to support your program's
9334
subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
9335
 
9336
@item
9337
A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
9338
download program.  These are often supplied by the hardware
9339
manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
9340
documentation.
9341
@end enumerate
9342
 
9343
The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
9344
communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
9345
machine).  In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
9346
 
9347
@table @emph
9348
@item On the host,
9349
@value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
9350
else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
9351
(@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
9352
 
9353
@item On the target,
9354
you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
9355
implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol.  The file containing these
9356
subroutines is called  a @dfn{debugging stub}.
9357
 
9358
On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
9359
@code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
9360
@xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} program}, for details.
9361
@end table
9362
 
9363
The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
9364
machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
9365
@sc{sparc} boards.
9366
 
9367
@cindex remote serial stub list
9368
These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
9369
 
9370
@table @code
9371
 
9372
@item i386-stub.c
9373
@cindex @file{i386-stub.c}
9374
@cindex Intel
9375
@cindex i386
9376
For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
9377
 
9378
@item m68k-stub.c
9379
@cindex @file{m68k-stub.c}
9380
@cindex Motorola 680x0
9381
@cindex m680x0
9382
For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
9383
 
9384
@item sh-stub.c
9385
@cindex @file{sh-stub.c}
9386
@cindex Hitachi
9387
@cindex SH
9388
For Hitachi SH architectures.
9389
 
9390
@item sparc-stub.c
9391
@cindex @file{sparc-stub.c}
9392
@cindex Sparc
9393
For @sc{sparc} architectures.
9394
 
9395
@item sparcl-stub.c
9396
@cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c}
9397
@cindex Fujitsu
9398
@cindex SparcLite
9399
For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
9400
 
9401
@end table
9402
 
9403
The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
9404
recently added stubs.
9405
 
9406
@menu
9407
* Stub Contents::       What the stub can do for you
9408
* Bootstrapping::       What you must do for the stub
9409
* Debug Session::       Putting it all together
9410
* Protocol::            Definition of the communication protocol
9411
* Server::                Using the `gdbserver' program
9412
* NetWare::                Using the `gdbserve.nlm' program
9413
@end menu
9414
 
9415
@node Stub Contents
9416
@subsubsection What the stub can do for you
9417
 
9418
@cindex remote serial stub
9419
The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
9420
subroutines:
9421
 
9422
@table @code
9423
@item set_debug_traps
9424
@kindex set_debug_traps
9425
@cindex remote serial stub, initialization
9426
This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
9427
program stops.  You must call this subroutine explicitly near the
9428
beginning of your program.
9429
 
9430
@item handle_exception
9431
@kindex handle_exception
9432
@cindex remote serial stub, main routine
9433
This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
9434
explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
9435
run when a trap is triggered.
9436
 
9437
@code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
9438
execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
9439
with @value{GDBN} on the host machine.  This is where the communications
9440
protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
9441
representative on the target machine.  It begins by sending summary
9442
information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
9443
retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
9444
execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
9445
@code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
9446
machine.
9447
 
9448
@item breakpoint
9449
@cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
9450
Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
9451
breakpoint.  Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
9452
way for @value{GDBN} to get control.  For instance, if your target
9453
machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
9454
pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
9455
@code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}.  On some machines,
9456
simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
9457
again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
9458
your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
9459
@value{GDBN} session gets control.
9460
 
9461
Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
9462
to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
9463
start of your debugging session.
9464
@end table
9465
 
9466
@node Bootstrapping
9467
@subsubsection What you must do for the stub
9468
 
9469
@cindex remote stub, support routines
9470
The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
9471
chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
9472
debugging target machine.
9473
 
9474
First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
9475
serial port.
9476
 
9477
@table @code
9478
@item int getDebugChar()
9479
@kindex getDebugChar
9480
Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
9481
It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
9482
different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
9483
 
9484
@item void putDebugChar(int)
9485
@kindex putDebugChar
9486
Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
9487
It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
9488
different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
9489
@end table
9490
 
9491
@cindex control C, and remote debugging
9492
@cindex interrupting remote targets
9493
If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
9494
running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
9495
for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
9496
character).  That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
9497
remote system to stop.
9498
 
9499
Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
9500
probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
9501
is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
9502
@value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
9503
 
9504
Other routines you need to supply are:
9505
 
9506
@table @code
9507
@item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
9508
@kindex exceptionHandler
9509
Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
9510
handling tables.  You need to do this because the stub does not have any
9511
way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
9512
are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
9513
containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
9514
@var{exception_number} is the exception number which should be changed;
9515
its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
9516
might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc).  When this
9517
exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
9518
@var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
9519
and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs.  So if
9520
you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
9521
should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
9522
 
9523
For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
9524
gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs.  The gate
9525
should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level).  The
9526
@sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
9527
help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
9528
 
9529
@item void flush_i_cache()
9530
@kindex flush_i_cache
9531
On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
9532
instruction cache, if any, on your target machine.  If there is no
9533
instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
9534
 
9535
On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
9536
function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
9537
@end table
9538
 
9539
@noindent
9540
You must also make sure this library routine is available:
9541
 
9542
@table @code
9543
@item void *memset(void *, int, int)
9544
@kindex memset
9545
This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
9546
memory to a known value.  If you have one of the free versions of
9547
@code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
9548
either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
9549
@end table
9550
 
9551
If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
9552
library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
9553
but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
9554
subroutines which @code{@value{GCC}} generates as inline code.
9555
 
9556
 
9557
@node Debug Session
9558
@subsubsection Putting it all together
9559
 
9560
@cindex remote serial debugging summary
9561
In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
9562
steps.
9563
 
9564
@enumerate
9565
@item
9566
Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines
9567
(@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What you must do for the stub}):
9568
@display
9569
@code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
9570
@code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
9571
@end display
9572
 
9573
@item
9574
Insert these lines near the top of your program:
9575
 
9576
@example
9577
set_debug_traps();
9578
breakpoint();
9579
@end example
9580
 
9581
@item
9582
For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
9583
@code{exceptionHook}.  Normally you just use:
9584
 
9585
@example
9586
void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
9587
@end example
9588
 
9589
@noindent
9590
but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
9591
function in your program, that function is called when
9592
@code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
9593
error).  The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
9594
one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
9595
 
9596
@item
9597
Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
9598
your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
9599
 
9600
@item
9601
Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
9602
the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
9603
 
9604
@item
9605
@c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
9606
@c document that.  FIXME.
9607
Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
9608
whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
9609
 
9610
@item
9611
To start remote debugging, run @value{GDBN} on the host machine, and specify
9612
as an executable file the program that is running in the remote machine.
9613
This tells @value{GDBN} how to find your program's symbols and the contents
9614
of its pure text.
9615
 
9616
@item
9617
@cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
9618
Establish communication using the @code{target remote} command.
9619
Its argument specifies how to communicate with the target
9620
machine---either via a devicename attached to a direct serial line, or a
9621
TCP port (usually to a terminal server which in turn has a serial line
9622
to the target).  For example, to use a serial line connected to the
9623
device named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
9624
 
9625
@example
9626
target remote /dev/ttyb
9627
@end example
9628
 
9629
@cindex TCP port, @code{target remote}
9630
To use a TCP connection, use an argument of the form
9631
@code{@var{host}:port}.  For example, to connect to port 2828 on a
9632
terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
9633
 
9634
@example
9635
target remote manyfarms:2828
9636
@end example
9637
@end enumerate
9638
 
9639
Now you can use all the usual commands to examine and change data and to
9640
step and continue the remote program.
9641
 
9642
To resume the remote program and stop debugging it, use the @code{detach}
9643
command.
9644
 
9645
@cindex interrupting remote programs
9646
@cindex remote programs, interrupting
9647
Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
9648
interrupt character (often @key{C-C}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
9649
program.  This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
9650
and the serial drivers the remote system uses.  If you type the
9651
interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
9652
 
9653
@example
9654
Interrupted while waiting for the program.
9655
Give up (and stop debugging it)?  (y or n)
9656
@end example
9657
 
9658
If you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons the remote debugging session.
9659
(If you decide you want to try again later, you can use @samp{target
9660
remote} again to connect once more.)  If you type @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN}
9661
goes back to waiting.
9662
 
9663
@node Protocol
9664
@subsubsection Communication protocol
9665
 
9666
@cindex debugging stub, example
9667
@cindex remote stub, example
9668
@cindex stub example, remote debugging
9669
The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
9670
communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
9671
@value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}.  Normally, you can simply allow
9672
these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details.  (If you're
9673
implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
9674
with one of the existing stub files.  @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
9675
organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
9676
 
9677
However, there may be occasions when you need to know something about
9678
the protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your
9679
target machine, you might want your program to do something special if
9680
it recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
9681
 
9682
In the examples below, @samp{<-} and @samp{->} are used to indicate
9683
transmitted and received data respectfully.
9684
 
9685
@cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
9686
@cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
9687
@cindex remote serial protocol
9688
All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments) are
9689
sent as a @var{packet}.  A @var{packet} is introduced with the character
9690
@samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character
9691
@samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}:
9692
 
9693
@example
9694
@code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
9695
@end example
9696
@noindent
9697
 
9698
@cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
9699
@noindent
9700
The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
9701
characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an
9702
eight bit unsigned checksum).
9703
 
9704
Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol
9705
specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}:
9706
 
9707
@example
9708
@code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
9709
@end example
9710
 
9711
@cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
9712
@noindent
9713
That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment.  @value{GDBN}
9714
has never output @var{sequence-id}s.  Stubs that handle packets added
9715
since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}.
9716
 
9717
@cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
9718
When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
9719
response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
9720
the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
9721
retransmission):
9722
 
9723
@example
9724
<- @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
9725
-> @code{+}
9726
@end example
9727
@noindent
9728
 
9729
The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
9730
debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}.  In
9731
the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
9732
when the operation has completed (the target has again stopped).
9733
 
9734
@var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
9735
exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional
9736
exceptions).
9737
 
9738
Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or
9739
@samp{:}.  Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in
9740
HEX with leading zeros suppressed.
9741
 
9742
Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character
9743
@samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it
9744
would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}).
9745
 
9746
Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space.  A @samp{*}
9747
means that the next character is an @sc{ascii} encoding giving a repeat count
9748
which stands for that many repetitions of the character preceding the
9749
@samp{*}.  The encoding is @code{n+29}, yielding a printable character
9750
where @code{n >=3} (which is where rle starts to win).  The printable
9751
characters @samp{$}, @samp{#}, @samp{+} and @samp{-} or with a numeric
9752
value greater than 126 should not be used.
9753
 
9754
Some remote systems have used a different run-length encoding mechanism
9755
loosely refered to as the cisco encoding.  Following the @samp{*}
9756
character are two hex digits that indicate the size of the packet.
9757
 
9758
So:
9759
@example
9760
"@code{0* }"
9761
@end example
9762
@noindent
9763
means the same as "0000".
9764
 
9765
The error response returned for some packets includes a two character
9766
error number.  That number is not well defined.
9767
 
9768
For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
9769
(@samp{$#00}) should be returned.  That way it is possible to extend the
9770
protocol.  A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
9771
on that response.
9772
 
9773
A stub is required to support the @samp{g}, @samp{G}, @samp{m}, @samp{M},
9774
@samp{c}, and @samp{s} @var{command}s.  All other @var{command}s are
9775
optional.
9776
 
9777
Below is a complete list of all currently defined @var{command}s and
9778
their corresponding response @var{data}:
9779
@page
9780
@multitable @columnfractions .30 .30 .40
9781
@item Packet
9782
@tab Request
9783
@tab Description
9784
 
9785
@item extended mode
9786
@tab @code{!}
9787
@tab
9788
Enable extended mode.  In extended mode, the remote server is made
9789
persistent.  The @samp{R} packet is used to restart the program being
9790
debugged.
9791
@item
9792
@tab reply @samp{OK}
9793
@tab
9794
The remote target both supports and has enabled extended mode.
9795
 
9796
@item last signal
9797
@tab @code{?}
9798
@tab
9799
Indicate the reason the target halted.  The reply is the same as for step
9800
and continue.
9801
@item
9802
@tab reply
9803
@tab see below
9804
 
9805
 
9806
@item reserved
9807
@tab @code{a}
9808
@tab Reserved for future use
9809
 
9810
@item set program arguments @strong{(reserved)}
9811
@tab @code{A}@var{arglen}@code{,}@var{argnum}@code{,}@var{arg}@code{,...}
9812
@tab
9813
@item
9814
@tab
9815
@tab
9816
Initialized @samp{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
9817
specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream @var{arg}.
9818
See @file{gdbserver} for more details.
9819
@item
9820
@tab reply @code{OK}
9821
@item
9822
@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
9823
 
9824
@item set baud @strong{(deprecated)}
9825
@tab @code{b}@var{baud}
9826
@tab
9827
Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}.  JTC: @emph{When does the
9828
transport layer state change?  When it's received, or after the ACK is
9829
transmitted.  In either case, there are problems if the command or the
9830
acknowledgment packet is dropped.} Stan: @emph{If people really wanted
9831
to add something like this, and get it working for the first time, they
9832
ought to modify ser-unix.c to send some kind of out-of-band message to a
9833
specially-setup stub and have the switch happen "in between" packets, so
9834
that from remote protocol's point of view, nothing actually
9835
happened.}
9836
 
9837
@item set breakpoint @strong{(deprecated)}
9838
@tab @code{B}@var{addr},@var{mode}
9839
@tab
9840
Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
9841
breakpoint at @var{addr}.  @emph{This has been replaced by the @samp{Z} and
9842
@samp{z} packets.}
9843
 
9844
@item continue
9845
@tab @code{c}@var{addr}
9846
@tab
9847
@var{addr} is address to resume. If @var{addr} is omitted, resume at
9848
current address.
9849
@item
9850
@tab reply
9851
@tab see below
9852
 
9853
@item continue with signal
9854
@tab @code{C}@var{sig}@code{;}@var{addr}
9855
@tab
9856
Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number).  If
9857
@code{;}@var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
9858
@item
9859
@tab reply
9860
@tab see below
9861
 
9862
@item toggle debug @strong{(deprecated)}
9863
@tab @code{d}
9864
@tab
9865
toggle debug flag.
9866
 
9867
@item detach
9868
@tab @code{D}
9869
@tab
9870
Detach @value{GDBN} from the remote system.  Sent to the remote target before
9871
@value{GDBN} disconnects.
9872
@item
9873
@tab reply @emph{no response}
9874
@tab
9875
@value{GDBN} does not check for any response after sending this packet.
9876
 
9877
@item reserved
9878
@tab @code{e}
9879
@tab Reserved for future use
9880
 
9881
@item reserved
9882
@tab @code{E}
9883
@tab Reserved for future use
9884
 
9885
@item reserved
9886
@tab @code{f}
9887
@tab Reserved for future use
9888
 
9889
@item reserved
9890
@tab @code{F}
9891
@tab Reserved for future use
9892
 
9893
@item read registers
9894
@tab @code{g}
9895
@tab Read general registers.
9896
@item
9897
@tab reply @var{XX...}
9898
@tab
9899
Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits.  The bytes
9900
with the register are transmitted in target byte order.  The size of
9901
each register and their position within the @samp{g} @var{packet} are
9902
determined by the @value{GDBN} internal macros @var{REGISTER_RAW_SIZE} and
9903
@var{REGISTER_NAME} macros.  The specification of several standard
9904
@code{g} packets is specified below.
9905
@item
9906
@tab @code{E}@var{NN}
9907
@tab for an error.
9908
 
9909
@item write regs
9910
@tab @code{G}@var{XX...}
9911
@tab
9912
See @samp{g} for a description of the @var{XX...} data.
9913
@item
9914
@tab reply @code{OK}
9915
@tab for success
9916
@item
9917
@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
9918
@tab for an error
9919
 
9920
@item reserved
9921
@tab @code{h}
9922
@tab Reserved for future use
9923
 
9924
@item set thread
9925
@tab @code{H}@var{c}@var{t...}
9926
@tab
9927
Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
9928
@samp{G}, et.al.).  @var{c} = @samp{c} for thread used in step and
9929
continue; @var{t...} can be -1 for all threads.  @var{c} = @samp{g} for
9930
thread used in other operations.  If zero, pick a thread, any thread.
9931
@item
9932
@tab reply @code{OK}
9933
@tab for success
9934
@item
9935
@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
9936
@tab for an error
9937
 
9938
@c FIXME: JTC:
9939
@c   'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model.  If a
9940
@c        thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
9941
@c        to continue to execute?  As I mentioned above, I think the
9942
@c        semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
9943
@c        described.  For example:
9944
@c
9945
@c        'g':    If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
9946
@c                selected, returns the register block from that thread;
9947
@c                otherwise returns current registers.
9948
@c
9949
@c        'G'     If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
9950
@c                selected, sets the registers of the register block of
9951
@c                that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
9952
 
9953
@item cycle step @strong{(draft)}
9954
@tab @code{i}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{nnn}
9955
@tab
9956
Step the remote target by a single clock cycle.  If @code{,}@var{nnn} is
9957
present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles.  If @var{addr} is present, cycle
9958
step starting at that address.
9959
 
9960
@item signal then cycle step @strong{(reserved)}
9961
@tab @code{I}
9962
@tab
9963
See @samp{i} and @samp{S} for likely syntax and semantics.
9964
 
9965
@item reserved
9966
@tab @code{j}
9967
@tab Reserved for future use
9968
 
9969
@item reserved
9970
@tab @code{J}
9971
@tab Reserved for future use
9972
 
9973
@item kill request
9974
@tab @code{k}
9975
@tab
9976
FIXME: @emph{There is no description of how operate when a specific
9977
thread context has been selected (ie. does 'k' kill only that thread?)}.
9978
 
9979
@item reserved
9980
@tab @code{l}
9981
@tab Reserved for future use
9982
 
9983
@item reserved
9984
@tab @code{L}
9985
@tab Reserved for future use
9986
 
9987
@item read memory
9988
@tab @code{m}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}
9989
@tab
9990
Read @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
9991
Neither @value{GDBN} nor the stub assume that sized memory transfers are assumed
9992
using word alligned accesses. FIXME: @emph{A word aligned memory
9993
transfer mechanism is needed.}
9994
@item
9995
@tab reply @var{XX...}
9996
@tab
9997
@var{XX...} is mem contents. Can be fewer bytes than requested if able
9998
to read only part of the data.  Neither @value{GDBN} nor the stub assume that
9999
sized memory transfers are assumed using word alligned accesses. FIXME:
10000
@emph{A word aligned memory transfer mechanism is needed.}
10001
@item
10002
@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
10003
@tab @var{NN} is errno
10004
 
10005
@item write mem
10006
@tab @code{M}@var{addr},@var{length}@code{:}@var{XX...}
10007
@tab
10008
Write @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
10009
@var{XX...} is the data.
10010
@item
10011
@tab reply @code{OK}
10012
@tab for success
10013
@item
10014
@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
10015
@tab
10016
for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
10017
written).
10018
 
10019
@item reserved
10020
@tab @code{n}
10021
@tab Reserved for future use
10022
 
10023
@item reserved
10024
@tab @code{N}
10025
@tab Reserved for future use
10026
 
10027
@item reserved
10028
@tab @code{o}
10029
@tab Reserved for future use
10030
 
10031
@item reserved
10032
@tab @code{O}
10033
@tab Reserved for future use
10034
 
10035
@item read reg @strong{(reserved)}
10036
@tab @code{p}@var{n...}
10037
@tab
10038
See write register.
10039
@item
10040
@tab return @var{r....}
10041
@tab The hex encoded value of the register in target byte order.
10042
 
10043
@item write reg
10044
@tab @code{P}@var{n...}@code{=}@var{r...}
10045
@tab
10046
Write register @var{n...} with value @var{r...}, which contains two hex
10047
digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
10048
@item
10049
@tab reply @code{OK}
10050
@tab for success
10051
@item
10052
@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
10053
@tab for an error
10054
 
10055
@item general query
10056
@tab @code{q}@var{query}
10057
@tab
10058
Request info about @var{query}.  In general @value{GDBN} queries
10059
have a leading upper case letter.  Custom vendor queries should use a
10060
company prefix (in lower case) ex: @samp{qfsf.var}.  @var{query} may
10061
optionally be followed by a @samp{,} or @samp{;} separated list.  Stubs
10062
must ensure that they match the full @var{query} name.
10063
@item
10064
@tab reply @code{XX...}
10065
@tab Hex encoded data from query.  The reply can not be empty.
10066
@item
10067
@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
10068
@tab error reply
10069
@item
10070
@tab reply @samp{}
10071
@tab Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
10072
 
10073
@item general set
10074
@tab @code{Q}@var{var}@code{=}@var{val}
10075
@tab
10076
Set value of @var{var} to @var{val}.  See @samp{q} for a discussing of
10077
naming conventions.
10078
 
10079
@item reset @strong{(deprecated)}
10080
@tab @code{r}
10081
@tab
10082
Reset the entire system.
10083
 
10084
@item remote restart
10085
@tab @code{R}@var{XX}
10086
@tab
10087
Restart the program being debugged.  @var{XX}, while needed, is ignored.
10088
This packet is only available in extended mode.
10089
@item
10090
@tab
10091
no reply
10092
@tab
10093
The @samp{R} packet has no reply.
10094
 
10095
@item step
10096
@tab @code{s}@var{addr}
10097
@tab
10098
@var{addr} is address to resume.  If @var{addr} is omitted, resume at
10099
same address.
10100
@item
10101
@tab reply
10102
@tab see below
10103
 
10104
@item step with signal
10105
@tab @code{S}@var{sig}@code{;}@var{addr}
10106
@tab
10107
Like @samp{C} but step not continue.
10108
@item
10109
@tab reply
10110
@tab see below
10111
 
10112
@item search
10113
@tab @code{t}@var{addr}@code{:}@var{PP}@code{,}@var{MM}
10114
@tab
10115
Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
10116
@var{PP} and mask @var{MM}.  @var{PP} and @var{MM} are 4
10117
bytes.  @var{addr} must be at least 3 digits.
10118
 
10119
@item thread alive
10120
@tab @code{T}@var{XX}
10121
@tab Find out if the thread XX is alive.
10122
@item
10123
@tab reply @code{OK}
10124
@tab thread is still alive
10125
@item
10126
@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
10127
@tab thread is dead
10128
 
10129
@item reserved
10130
@tab @code{u}
10131
@tab Reserved for future use
10132
 
10133
@item reserved
10134
@tab @code{U}
10135
@tab Reserved for future use
10136
 
10137
@item reserved
10138
@tab @code{v}
10139
@tab Reserved for future use
10140
 
10141
@item reserved
10142
@tab @code{V}
10143
@tab Reserved for future use
10144
 
10145
@item reserved
10146
@tab @code{w}
10147
@tab Reserved for future use
10148
 
10149
@item reserved
10150
@tab @code{W}
10151
@tab Reserved for future use
10152
 
10153
@item reserved
10154
@tab @code{x}
10155
@tab Reserved for future use
10156
 
10157
@item write mem (binary)
10158
@tab @code{X}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}@var{:}@var{XX...}
10159
@tab
10160
@var{addr} is address, @var{length} is number of bytes, @var{XX...} is
10161
binary data.  The characters @code{$}, @code{#}, and @code{0x7d} are
10162
escaped using @code{0x7d}.
10163
@item
10164
@tab reply @code{OK}
10165
@tab for success
10166
@item
10167
@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
10168
@tab for an error
10169
 
10170
@item reserved
10171
@tab @code{y}
10172
@tab Reserved for future use
10173
 
10174
@item reserved
10175
@tab @code{Y}
10176
@tab Reserved for future use
10177
 
10178
@item remove break or watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
10179
@tab @code{z}@var{t}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}
10180
@tab
10181
See @samp{Z}.
10182
 
10183
@item insert break or watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
10184
@tab @code{Z}@var{t}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}
10185
@tab
10186
@var{t} is type: @samp{0} - software breakpoint, @samp{1} - hardware
10187
breakpoint, @samp{2} - write watchpoint, @samp{3} - read watchpoint,
10188
@samp{4} - access watchpoint; @var{addr} is address; @var{length} is in
10189
bytes.  For a software breakpoint, @var{length} specifies the size of
10190
the instruction to be patched.  For hardware breakpoints and watchpoints
10191
@var{length} specifies the memory region to be monitored.  To avoid
10192
potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should be
10193
implemented in an idempotent way.
10194
@item
10195
@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
10196
@tab for an error
10197
@item
10198
@tab reply @code{OK}
10199
@tab for success
10200
@item
10201
@tab @samp{}
10202
@tab If not supported.
10203
 
10204
@item reserved
10205
@tab <other>
10206
@tab Reserved for future use
10207
 
10208
@end multitable
10209
 
10210
The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s} and @samp{?} packets can
10211
receive any of the below as a reply.  In the case of the @samp{C},
10212
@samp{c}, @samp{S} and @samp{s} packets, that reply is only returned
10213
when the target halts.  In the below the exact meaning of @samp{signal
10214
number} is poorly defined.  In general one of the UNIX signal numbering
10215
conventions is used.
10216
 
10217
@multitable @columnfractions .4 .6
10218
 
10219
@item @code{S}@var{AA}
10220
@tab @var{AA} is the signal number
10221
 
10222
@item @code{T}@var{AA}@var{n...}@code{:}@var{r...}@code{;}@var{n...}@code{:}@var{r...}@code{;}@var{n...}@code{:}@var{r...}@code{;}
10223
@tab
10224
@var{AA} = two hex digit signal number; @var{n...} = register number
10225
(hex), @var{r...}  = target byte ordered register contents, size defined
10226
by @code{REGISTER_RAW_SIZE}; @var{n...} = @samp{thread}, @var{r...} =
10227
thread process ID, this is a hex integer; @var{n...} = other string not
10228
starting with valid hex digit.  @value{GDBN} should ignore this
10229
@var{n...}, @var{r...} pair and go on to the next.  This way we can
10230
extend the protocol.
10231
 
10232
@item @code{W}@var{AA}
10233
@tab
10234
The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status.  This is only
10235
applicable for certains sorts of targets.
10236
 
10237
@item @code{X}@var{AA}
10238
@tab
10239
The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
10240
 
10241
@item @code{N}@var{AA}@code{;}@var{t...}@code{;}@var{d...}@code{;}@var{b...} @strong{(obsolete)}
10242
@tab
10243
@var{AA} = signal number; @var{t...} = address of symbol "_start";
10244
@var{d...} = base of data section; @var{b...} = base of bss section.
10245
@emph{Note: only used by Cisco Systems targets.  The difference between
10246
this reply and the "qOffsets" query is that the 'N' packet may arrive
10247
spontaneously whereas the 'qOffsets' is a query initiated by the host
10248
debugger.}
10249
 
10250
@item @code{O}@var{XX...}
10251
@tab
10252
@var{XX...} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data.  This can happen at any time
10253
while the program is running and the debugger should continue to wait
10254
for 'W', 'T', etc.
10255
 
10256
@end multitable
10257
 
10258
The following set and query packets have already been defined.
10259
 
10260
@multitable @columnfractions .2 .2 .6
10261
 
10262
@item current thread
10263
@tab @code{q}@code{C}
10264
@tab Return the current thread id.
10265
@item
10266
@tab reply @code{QC}@var{pid}
10267
@tab
10268
Where @var{pid} is a HEX encoded 16 bit process id.
10269
@item
10270
@tab reply *
10271
@tab Any other reply implies the old pid.
10272
 
10273
@item all thread ids
10274
@tab @code{q}@code{fThreadInfo}
10275
@item
10276
@tab @code{q}@code{sThreadInfo}
10277
@tab
10278
Obtain a list of active thread ids from the target (OS).  Since there
10279
may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query
10280
works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to
10281
obtain the entire list of threads.  The first query of the sequence will
10282
be the @code{qf}@code{ThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the
10283
sequence will be the @code{qs}@code{ThreadInfo} query.
10284
@item
10285
@tab
10286
@tab NOTE: replaces the @code{qL} query (see below).
10287
@item
10288
@tab reply @code{m}@var{<id>}
10289
@tab A single thread id
10290
@item
10291
@tab reply @code{m}@var{<id>},@var{<id>...}
10292
@tab a comma-separated list of thread ids
10293
@item
10294
@tab reply @code{l}
10295
@tab (lower case 'el') denotes end of list.
10296
@item
10297
@tab
10298
@tab
10299
In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one
10300
or more thread ids, in big-endian hex, separated by commas.  GDB will
10301
respond to each reply with a request for more thread ids (using the
10302
@code{qs} form of the query), until the target responds with @code{l}
10303
(lower-case el, for @code{'last'}).
10304
 
10305
@item extra thread info
10306
@tab @code{q}@code{ThreadExtraInfo}@code{,}@var{id}
10307
@tab
10308
@item
10309
@tab
10310
@tab
10311
Where @var{<id>} is a thread-id in big-endian hex.
10312
Obtain a printable string description of a thread's attributes from
10313
the target OS.  This string may contain anything that the target OS
10314
thinks is interesting for @value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread.
10315
The string is displayed in @value{GDBN}'s @samp{info threads} display.
10316
Some examples of possible thread extra info strings are "Runnable", or
10317
"Blocked on Mutex".
10318
@item
10319
@tab reply @var{XX...}
10320
@tab
10321
Where @var{XX...} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, comprising the
10322
printable string containing the extra information about the thread's
10323
attributes.
10324
 
10325
@item query @var{LIST} or @var{threadLIST} @strong{(deprecated)}
10326
@tab @code{q}@code{L}@var{startflag}@var{threadcount}@var{nextthread}
10327
@tab
10328
@item
10329
@tab
10330
@tab
10331
Obtain thread information from RTOS.  Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
10332
digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
10333
subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
10334
number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
10335
(eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
10336
returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
10337
@item
10338
@tab
10339
@tab NOTE: this query is replaced by the @code{q}@code{fThreadInfo}
10340
query (see above).
10341
@item
10342
@tab reply @code{q}@code{M}@var{count}@var{done}@var{argthread}@var{thread...}
10343
@tab
10344
@item
10345
@tab
10346
@tab
10347
Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
10348
returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
10349
and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
10350
digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread...} is
10351
a sequence of thread IDs from the target.  @var{threadid} (eight hex
10352
digits).  See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
10353
 
10354
@item compute CRC of memory block
10355
@tab @code{q}@code{CRC:}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}
10356
@tab
10357
@item
10358
@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
10359
@tab An error (such as memory fault)
10360
@item
10361
@tab reply @code{C}@var{CRC32}
10362
@tab A 32 bit cyclic redundancy check of the specified memory region.
10363
 
10364
@item query sect offs
10365
@tab @code{q}@code{Offsets}
10366
@tab
10367
Get section offsets that the target used when re-locating the downloaded
10368
image.  @emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset is included in the
10369
response, @value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data}
10370
offset to the @code{Bss} section.}
10371
@item
10372
@tab reply @code{Text=}@var{xxx}@code{;Data=}@var{yyy}@code{;Bss=}@var{zzz}
10373
 
10374
@item thread info request
10375
@tab @code{q}@code{P}@var{mode}@var{threadid}
10376
@tab
10377
@item
10378
@tab
10379
@tab
10380
Returns information on @var{threadid}.  Where: @var{mode} is a hex
10381
encoded 32 bit mode; @var{threadid} is a hex encoded 64 bit thread ID.
10382
@item
10383
@tab reply *
10384
@tab
10385
See @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
10386
 
10387
@item remote command
10388
@tab @code{q}@code{Rcmd,}@var{COMMAND}
10389
@tab
10390
@item
10391
@tab
10392
@tab
10393
@var{COMMAND} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
10394
execution.  Invalid commands should be reported using the output string.
10395
Before the final result packet, the target may also respond with a
10396
number of intermediate @code{O}@var{OUTPUT} console output
10397
packets.  @emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a
10398
stubs's interpreter may have security implications}.
10399
@item
10400
@tab reply @code{OK}
10401
@tab
10402
A command response with no output.
10403
@item
10404
@tab reply @var{OUTPUT}
10405
@tab
10406
A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
10407
@item
10408
@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
10409
@tab
10410
Indicate a badly formed request.
10411
 
10412
@item
10413
@tab reply @samp{}
10414
@tab
10415
When @samp{q}@samp{Rcmd} is not recognized.
10416
 
10417
@item symbol lookup
10418
@tab @code{qSymbol::}
10419
@tab
10420
Notify the target that @value{GDBN} is prepared to serve symbol lookup
10421
requests.  Accept requests from the target for the values of symbols.
10422
@item
10423
@tab
10424
@tab
10425
@item
10426
@tab reply @code{OK}
10427
@tab
10428
The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
10429
@item
10430
@tab reply @code{qSymbol:}@var{sym_name}
10431
@tab
10432
The target requests the value of symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
10433
@value{GDBN} may provide the value by using the
10434
@code{qSymbol:}@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}
10435
message, described below.
10436
 
10437
@item symbol value
10438
@tab @code{qSymbol:}@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}
10439
@tab
10440
Set the value of SYM_NAME to SYM_VALUE.
10441
@item
10442
@tab
10443
@tab
10444
@var{sym_name} (hex encoded) is the name of a symbol whose value
10445
the target has previously requested.
10446
@item
10447
@tab
10448
@tab
10449
@var{sym_value} (hex) is the value for symbol @var{sym_name}.
10450
If @value{GDBN} cannot supply a value for @var{sym_name}, then this
10451
field will be empty.
10452
@item
10453
@tab reply @code{OK}
10454
@tab
10455
The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
10456
@item
10457
@tab reply @code{qSymbol:}@var{sym_name}
10458
@tab
10459
The target requests the value of a new symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
10460
@value{GDBN} will continue to supply the values of symbols (if available),
10461
until the target ceases to request them.
10462
 
10463
@end multitable
10464
 
10465
The following @samp{g}/@samp{G} packets have previously been defined.
10466
In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as sixty-four
10467
bits.  Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?) to fill the
10468
space allocated.  Register bytes are transfered in target byte order.
10469
The two nibbles within a register byte are transfered most-significant -
10470
least-significant.
10471
 
10472
@multitable @columnfractions .5 .5
10473
 
10474
@item MIPS32
10475
@tab
10476
All registers are transfered as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
10477
32 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
10478
registers; fsr; fir; fp.
10479
 
10480
@item MIPS64
10481
@tab
10482
All registers are transfered as sixty-four bit quantities (including
10483
thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}).  The ordering is the same
10484
as @code{MIPS32}.
10485
 
10486
@end multitable
10487
 
10488
Example sequence of a target being re-started.  Notice how the restart
10489
does not get any direct output:
10490
 
10491
@example
10492
<- @code{R00}
10493
-> @code{+}
10494
@emph{target restarts}
10495
<- @code{?}
10496
-> @code{+}
10497
-> @code{T001:1234123412341234}
10498
<- @code{+}
10499
@end example
10500
 
10501
Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
10502
 
10503
@example
10504
<- @code{G1445...}
10505
-> @code{+}
10506
<- @code{s}
10507
-> @code{+}
10508
@emph{time passes}
10509
-> @code{T001:1234123412341234}
10510
<- @code{+}
10511
<- @code{g}
10512
-> @code{+}
10513
-> @code{1455...}
10514
<- @code{+}
10515
@end example
10516
 
10517
@node Server
10518
@subsubsection Using the @code{gdbserver} program
10519
 
10520
@kindex gdbserver
10521
@cindex remote connection without stubs
10522
@code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
10523
allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
10524
@code{target remote}---but without linking in the usual debugging stub.
10525
 
10526
@code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
10527
because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
10528
that @value{GDBN} itself does.  In fact, a system that can run
10529
@code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
10530
@value{GDBN} locally!  @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
10531
because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself.  It is
10532
also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
10533
started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
10534
Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
10535
the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
10536
do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
10537
by cross-compiling.  You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
10538
choice for debugging.
10539
 
10540
@value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
10541
or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
10542
protocol.
10543
 
10544
@table @emph
10545
@item On the target machine,
10546
you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug.
10547
@code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
10548
strip the program if necessary to save space.  @value{GDBN} on the host
10549
system does all the symbol handling.
10550
 
10551
To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
10552
the name of your program; and the arguments for your program.  The
10553
syntax is:
10554
 
10555
@smallexample
10556
target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
10557
@end smallexample
10558
 
10559
@var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line) or a TCP
10560
hostname and portnumber.  For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
10561
@samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
10562
@file{/dev/com1}:
10563
 
10564
@smallexample
10565
target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
10566
@end smallexample
10567
 
10568
@code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
10569
with it.
10570
 
10571
To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
10572
 
10573
@smallexample
10574
target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
10575
@end smallexample
10576
 
10577
The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
10578
specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
10579
TCP.  The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
10580
expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
10581
(Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.)  You can choose any number
10582
you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
10583
TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
10584
reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
10585
conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
10586
and exits.}  You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
10587
@code{target remote} command.
10588
 
10589
@item On the @value{GDBN} host machine,
10590
you need an unstripped copy of your program, since @value{GDBN} needs
10591
symbols and debugging information.  Start up @value{GDBN} as usual,
10592
using the name of the local copy of your program as the first argument.
10593
(You may also need the @w{@samp{--baud}} option if the serial line is
10594
running at anything other than 9600@dmn{bps}.)  After that, use @code{target
10595
remote} to establish communications with @code{gdbserver}.  Its argument
10596
is either a device name (usually a serial device, like
10597
@file{/dev/ttyb}), or a TCP port descriptor in the form
10598
@code{@var{host}:@var{PORT}}.  For example:
10599
 
10600
@smallexample
10601
(@value{GDBP}) target remote /dev/ttyb
10602
@end smallexample
10603
 
10604
@noindent
10605
communicates with the server via serial line @file{/dev/ttyb}, and
10606
 
10607
@smallexample
10608
(@value{GDBP}) target remote the-target:2345
10609
@end smallexample
10610
 
10611
@noindent
10612
communicates via a TCP connection to port 2345 on host @w{@file{the-target}}.
10613
For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
10614
the @code{target remote} command.  Otherwise you may get an error whose
10615
text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
10616
@samp{Connection refused}.
10617
@end table
10618
 
10619
@node NetWare
10620
@subsubsection Using the @code{gdbserve.nlm} program
10621
 
10622
@kindex gdbserve.nlm
10623
@code{gdbserve.nlm} is a control program for NetWare systems, which
10624
allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
10625
@code{target remote}.
10626
 
10627
@value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserve.nlm} communicate via a serial line,
10628
using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol.
10629
 
10630
@table @emph
10631
@item On the target machine,
10632
you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug.
10633
@code{gdbserve.nlm} does not need your program's symbol table, so you
10634
can strip the program if necessary to save space.  @value{GDBN} on the
10635
host system does all the symbol handling.
10636
 
10637
To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with
10638
@value{GDBN}; the name of your program; and the arguments for your
10639
program.  The syntax is:
10640
 
10641
@smallexample
10642
load gdbserve [ BOARD=@var{board} ] [ PORT=@var{port} ]
10643
              [ BAUD=@var{baud} ] @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
10644
@end smallexample
10645
 
10646
@var{board} and @var{port} specify the serial line; @var{baud} specifies
10647
the baud rate used by the connection.  @var{port} and @var{node} default
10648
to 0, @var{baud} defaults to 9600@dmn{bps}.
10649
 
10650
For example, to debug Emacs with the argument @samp{foo.txt}and
10651
communicate with @value{GDBN} over serial port number 2 or board 1
10652
using a 19200@dmn{bps} connection:
10653
 
10654
@smallexample
10655
load gdbserve BOARD=1 PORT=2 BAUD=19200 emacs foo.txt
10656
@end smallexample
10657
 
10658
@item On the @value{GDBN} host machine,
10659
you need an unstripped copy of your program, since @value{GDBN} needs
10660
symbols and debugging information.  Start up @value{GDBN} as usual,
10661
using the name of the local copy of your program as the first argument.
10662
(You may also need the @w{@samp{--baud}} option if the serial line is
10663
running at anything other than 9600@dmn{bps}.  After that, use @code{target
10664
remote} to establish communications with @code{gdbserve.nlm}.  Its
10665
argument is a device name (usually a serial device, like
10666
@file{/dev/ttyb}).  For example:
10667
 
10668
@smallexample
10669
(@value{GDBP}) target remote /dev/ttyb
10670
@end smallexample
10671
 
10672
@noindent
10673
communications with the server via serial line @file{/dev/ttyb}.
10674
@end table
10675
 
10676
@node KOD
10677
@section Kernel Object Display
10678
 
10679
@cindex kernel object display
10680
@cindex kernel object
10681
@cindex KOD
10682
 
10683
Some targets support kernel object display.  Using this facility,
10684
@value{GDBN} communicates specially with the underlying operating system
10685
and can display information about operating system-level objects such as
10686
mutexes and other synchronization objects.  Exactly which objects can be
10687
displayed is determined on a per-OS basis.
10688
 
10689
Use the @code{set os} command to set the operating system.  This tells
10690
@value{GDBN} which kernel object display module to initialize:
10691
 
10692
@example
10693
(@value{GDBP}) set os cisco
10694
@end example
10695
 
10696
If @code{set os} succeeds, @value{GDBN} will display some information
10697
about the operating system, and will create a new @code{info} command
10698
which can be used to query the target.  The @code{info} command is named
10699
after the operating system:
10700
 
10701
@example
10702
(@value{GDBP}) info cisco
10703
List of Cisco Kernel Objects
10704
Object     Description
10705
any        Any and all objects
10706
@end example
10707
 
10708
Further subcommands can be used to query about particular objects known
10709
by the kernel.
10710
 
10711
There is currently no way to determine whether a given operating system
10712
is supported other than to try it.
10713
 
10714
 
10715
@node Configurations
10716
@chapter Configuration-Specific Information
10717
 
10718
While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
10719
cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions.  This chapter
10720
describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
10721
 
10722
There are three major categories of configurations: native
10723
configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
10724
operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
10725
different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
10726
are quite different from each other.
10727
 
10728
@menu
10729
* Native::
10730
* Embedded OS::
10731
* Embedded Processors::
10732
* Architectures::
10733
@end menu
10734
 
10735
@node Native
10736
@section Native
10737
 
10738
This section describes details specific to particular native
10739
configurations.
10740
 
10741
@menu
10742
* HP-UX::                       HP-UX
10743
* SVR4 Process Information::    SVR4 process information
10744
@end menu
10745
 
10746
@node HP-UX
10747
@subsection HP-UX
10748
 
10749
On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
10750
begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
10751
name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
10752
 
10753
@node SVR4 Process Information
10754
@subsection SVR4 process information
10755
 
10756
@kindex /proc
10757
@cindex process image
10758
 
10759
Many versions of SVR4 provide a facility called @samp{/proc} that can be
10760
used to examine the image of a running process using file-system
10761
subroutines.  If @value{GDBN} is configured for an operating system with
10762
this facility, the command @code{info proc} is available to report on
10763
several kinds of information about the process running your program.
10764
@code{info proc} works only on SVR4 systems that include the
10765
@code{procfs} code.  This includes OSF/1 (Digital Unix), Solaris, Irix,
10766
and Unixware, but not HP-UX or Linux, for example.
10767
 
10768
@table @code
10769
@kindex info proc
10770
@item info proc
10771
Summarize available information about the process.
10772
 
10773
@kindex info proc mappings
10774
@item info proc mappings
10775
Report on the address ranges accessible in the program, with information
10776
on whether your program may read, write, or execute each range.
10777
 
10778
@kindex info proc times
10779
@item info proc times
10780
Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
10781
its children.
10782
 
10783
@kindex info proc id
10784
@item info proc id
10785
Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
10786
the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
10787
 
10788
@kindex info proc status
10789
@item info proc status
10790
General information on the state of the process.  If the process is
10791
stopped, this report includes the reason for stopping, and any signal
10792
received.
10793
 
10794
@item info proc all
10795
Show all the above information about the process.
10796
@end table
10797
 
10798
@node Embedded OS
10799
@section Embedded Operating Systems
10800
 
10801
This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
10802
embedded operating systems that are available for several different
10803
architectures.
10804
 
10805
@menu
10806
* VxWorks::                     Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
10807
@end menu
10808
 
10809
@value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
10810
various real-time operating systems.
10811
 
10812
@node VxWorks
10813
@subsection Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
10814
 
10815
@cindex VxWorks
10816
 
10817
@table @code
10818
 
10819
@kindex target vxworks
10820
@item target vxworks @var{machinename}
10821
A VxWorks system, attached via TCP/IP.  The argument @var{machinename}
10822
is the target system's machine name or IP address.
10823
 
10824
@end table
10825
 
10826
On VxWorks, @code{load} links @var{filename} dynamically on the
10827
current target system as well as adding its symbols in @value{GDBN}.
10828
 
10829
@value{GDBN} enables developers to spawn and debug tasks running on networked
10830
VxWorks targets from a Unix host.  Already-running tasks spawned from
10831
the VxWorks shell can also be debugged.  @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
10832
both the Unix host and on the VxWorks target.  The program
10833
@code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host.  (It may be
10834
installed with the name @code{vxgdb}, to distinguish it from a
10835
@value{GDBN} for debugging programs on the host itself.)
10836
 
10837
@table @code
10838
@item VxWorks-timeout @var{args}
10839
@kindex vxworks-timeout
10840
All VxWorks-based targets now support the option @code{vxworks-timeout}.
10841
This option is set by the user, and  @var{args} represents the number of
10842
seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses to rpc's.  You might use this if
10843
your VxWorks target is a slow software simulator or is on the far side
10844
of a thin network line.
10845
@end table
10846
 
10847
The following information on connecting to VxWorks was current when
10848
this manual was produced; newer releases of VxWorks may use revised
10849
procedures.
10850
 
10851
@kindex INCLUDE_RDB
10852
To use @value{GDBN} with VxWorks, you must rebuild your VxWorks kernel
10853
to include the remote debugging interface routines in the VxWorks
10854
library @file{rdb.a}.  To do this, define @code{INCLUDE_RDB} in the
10855
VxWorks configuration file @file{configAll.h} and rebuild your VxWorks
10856
kernel.  The resulting kernel contains @file{rdb.a}, and spawns the
10857
source debugging task @code{tRdbTask} when VxWorks is booted.  For more
10858
information on configuring and remaking VxWorks, see the manufacturer's
10859
manual.
10860
@c VxWorks, see the @cite{VxWorks Programmer's Guide}.
10861
 
10862
Once you have included @file{rdb.a} in your VxWorks system image and set
10863
your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
10864
run @value{GDBN}.  From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}} (or
10865
@code{vxgdb}, depending on your installation).
10866
 
10867
@value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
10868
 
10869
@example
10870
(vxgdb)
10871
@end example
10872
 
10873
@menu
10874
* VxWorks Connection::          Connecting to VxWorks
10875
* VxWorks Download::            VxWorks download
10876
* VxWorks Attach::              Running tasks
10877
@end menu
10878
 
10879
@node VxWorks Connection
10880
@subsubsection Connecting to VxWorks
10881
 
10882
The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a VxWorks target on the
10883
network.  To connect to a target whose host name is ``@code{tt}'', type:
10884
 
10885
@example
10886
(vxgdb) target vxworks tt
10887
@end example
10888
 
10889
@need 750
10890
@value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
10891
 
10892
@smallexample
10893
Attaching remote machine across net...
10894
Connected to tt.
10895
@end smallexample
10896
 
10897
@need 1000
10898
@value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol tables of any object modules
10899
loaded into the VxWorks target since it was last booted.  @value{GDBN} locates
10900
these files by searching the directories listed in the command search
10901
path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}); if it fails
10902
to find an object file, it displays a message such as:
10903
 
10904
@example
10905
prog.o: No such file or directory.
10906
@end example
10907
 
10908
When this happens, add the appropriate directory to the search path with
10909
the @value{GDBN} command @code{path}, and execute the @code{target}
10910
command again.
10911
 
10912
@node VxWorks Download
10913
@subsubsection VxWorks download
10914
 
10915
@cindex download to VxWorks
10916
If you have connected to the VxWorks target and you want to debug an
10917
object that has not yet been loaded, you can use the @value{GDBN}
10918
@code{load} command to download a file from Unix to VxWorks
10919
incrementally.  The object file given as an argument to the @code{load}
10920
command is actually opened twice: first by the VxWorks target in order
10921
to download the code, then by @value{GDBN} in order to read the symbol
10922
table.  This can lead to problems if the current working directories on
10923
the two systems differ.  If both systems have NFS mounted the same
10924
filesystems, you can avoid these problems by using absolute paths.
10925
Otherwise, it is simplest to set the working directory on both systems
10926
to the directory in which the object file resides, and then to reference
10927
the file by its name, without any path.  For instance, a program
10928
@file{prog.o} may reside in @file{@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb} in VxWorks
10929
and in @file{@var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb} on the host.  To load this
10930
program, type this on VxWorks:
10931
 
10932
@example
10933
-> cd "@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb"
10934
@end example
10935
 
10936
@noindent
10937
Then, in @value{GDBN}, type:
10938
 
10939
@example
10940
(vxgdb) cd @var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb
10941
(vxgdb) load prog.o
10942
@end example
10943
 
10944
@value{GDBN} displays a response similar to this:
10945
 
10946
@smallexample
10947
Reading symbol data from wherever/vw/demo/rdb/prog.o... done.
10948
@end smallexample
10949
 
10950
You can also use the @code{load} command to reload an object module
10951
after editing and recompiling the corresponding source file.  Note that
10952
this makes @value{GDBN} delete all currently-defined breakpoints,
10953
auto-displays, and convenience variables, and to clear the value
10954
history.  (This is necessary in order to preserve the integrity of
10955
debugger's data structures that reference the target system's symbol
10956
table.)
10957
 
10958
@node VxWorks Attach
10959
@subsubsection Running tasks
10960
 
10961
@cindex running VxWorks tasks
10962
You can also attach to an existing task using the @code{attach} command as
10963
follows:
10964
 
10965
@example
10966
(vxgdb) attach @var{task}
10967
@end example
10968
 
10969
@noindent
10970
where @var{task} is the VxWorks hexadecimal task ID.  The task can be running
10971
or suspended when you attach to it.  Running tasks are suspended at
10972
the time of attachment.
10973
 
10974
@node Embedded Processors
10975
@section Embedded Processors
10976
 
10977
This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
10978
configurations.
10979
 
10980
@menu
10981
* A29K Embedded::               AMD A29K Embedded
10982
* ARM::                         ARM
10983
* H8/300::                      Hitachi H8/300
10984
* H8/500::                      Hitachi H8/500
10985
* i960::                        Intel i960
10986
* M32R/D::                      Mitsubishi M32R/D
10987
* M68K::                        Motorola M68K
10988
* M88K::                        Motorola M88K
10989
* MIPS Embedded::               MIPS Embedded
10990
* PA::                          HP PA Embedded
10991
* PowerPC:                      PowerPC
10992
* SH::                          Hitachi SH
10993
* Sparclet::                    Tsqware Sparclet
10994
* Sparclite::                   Fujitsu Sparclite
10995
* ST2000::                      Tandem ST2000
10996
* Z8000::                       Zilog Z8000
10997
@end menu
10998
 
10999
@node A29K Embedded
11000
@subsection AMD A29K Embedded
11001
 
11002
@menu
11003
* A29K UDI::
11004
* A29K EB29K::
11005
* Comms (EB29K)::               Communications setup
11006
* gdb-EB29K::                   EB29K cross-debugging
11007
* Remote Log::                  Remote log
11008
@end menu
11009
 
11010
@table @code
11011
 
11012
@kindex target adapt
11013
@item target adapt @var{dev}
11014
Adapt monitor for A29K.
11015
 
11016
@kindex target amd-eb
11017
@item target amd-eb @var{dev} @var{speed} @var{PROG}
11018
@cindex AMD EB29K
11019
Remote PC-resident AMD EB29K board, attached over serial lines.
11020
@var{dev} is the serial device, as for @code{target remote};
11021
@var{speed} allows you to specify the linespeed; and @var{PROG} is the
11022
name of the program to be debugged, as it appears to DOS on the PC.
11023
@xref{A29K EB29K, ,EBMON protocol for AMD29K}.
11024
 
11025
@end table
11026
 
11027
@node A29K UDI
11028
@subsubsection A29K UDI
11029
 
11030
@cindex UDI
11031
@cindex AMD29K via UDI
11032
 
11033
@value{GDBN} supports AMD's UDI (``Universal Debugger Interface'')
11034
protocol for debugging the a29k processor family.  To use this
11035
configuration with AMD targets running the MiniMON monitor, you need the
11036
program @code{MONTIP}, available from AMD at no charge.  You can also
11037
use @value{GDBN} with the UDI-conformant a29k simulator program
11038
@code{ISSTIP}, also available from AMD.
11039
 
11040
@table @code
11041
@item target udi @var{keyword}
11042
@kindex udi
11043
Select the UDI interface to a remote a29k board or simulator, where
11044
@var{keyword} is an entry in the AMD configuration file @file{udi_soc}.
11045
This file contains keyword entries which specify parameters used to
11046
connect to a29k targets.  If the @file{udi_soc} file is not in your
11047
working directory, you must set the environment variable @samp{UDICONF}
11048
to its pathname.
11049
@end table
11050
 
11051
@node A29K EB29K
11052
@subsubsection EBMON protocol for AMD29K
11053
 
11054
@cindex EB29K board
11055
@cindex running 29K programs
11056
 
11057
AMD distributes a 29K development board meant to fit in a PC, together
11058
with a DOS-hosted monitor program called @code{EBMON}.  As a shorthand
11059
term, this development system is called the ``EB29K''.  To use
11060
@value{GDBN} from a Unix system to run programs on the EB29K board, you
11061
must first connect a serial cable between the PC (which hosts the EB29K
11062
board) and a serial port on the Unix system.  In the following, we
11063
assume you've hooked the cable between the PC's @file{COM1} port and
11064
@file{/dev/ttya} on the Unix system.
11065
 
11066
@node Comms (EB29K)
11067
@subsubsection Communications setup
11068
 
11069
The next step is to set up the PC's port, by doing something like this
11070
in DOS on the PC:
11071
 
11072
@example
11073
C:\> MODE com1:9600,n,8,1,none
11074
@end example
11075
 
11076
@noindent
11077
This example---run on an MS DOS 4.0 system---sets the PC port to 9600
11078
bps, no parity, eight data bits, one stop bit, and no ``retry'' action;
11079
you must match the communications parameters when establishing the Unix
11080
end of the connection as well.
11081
@c FIXME: Who knows what this "no retry action" crud from the DOS manual may
11082
@c       mean?  It's optional; leave it out? ---doc@cygnus.com, 25feb91
11083
@c
11084
@c It's optional, but it's unwise to omit it: who knows what is the
11085
@c default value set when the DOS machines boots?  "No retry" means that
11086
@c the DOS serial device driver won't retry the operation if it fails;
11087
@c I understand that this is needed because the GDB serial protocol
11088
@c handles any errors and retransmissions itself. ---Eli Zaretskii, 3sep99
11089
 
11090
To give control of the PC to the Unix side of the serial line, type
11091
the following at the DOS console:
11092
 
11093
@example
11094
C:\> CTTY com1
11095
@end example
11096
 
11097
@noindent
11098
(Later, if you wish to return control to the DOS console, you can use
11099
the command @code{CTTY con}---but you must send it over the device that
11100
had control, in our example over the @file{COM1} serial line.)
11101
 
11102
From the Unix host, use a communications program such as @code{tip} or
11103
@code{cu} to communicate with the PC; for example,
11104
 
11105
@example
11106
cu -s 9600 -l /dev/ttya
11107
@end example
11108
 
11109
@noindent
11110
The @code{cu} options shown specify, respectively, the linespeed and the
11111
serial port to use.  If you use @code{tip} instead, your command line
11112
may look something like the following:
11113
 
11114
@example
11115
tip -9600 /dev/ttya
11116
@end example
11117
 
11118
@noindent
11119
Your system may require a different name where we show
11120
@file{/dev/ttya} as the argument to @code{tip}.  The communications
11121
parameters, including which port to use, are associated with the
11122
@code{tip} argument in the ``remote'' descriptions file---normally the
11123
system table @file{/etc/remote}.
11124
@c FIXME: What if anything needs doing to match the "n,8,1,none" part of
11125
@c the DOS side's comms setup?  cu can support -o (odd
11126
@c parity), -e (even parity)---apparently no settings for no parity or
11127
@c for character size.  Taken from stty maybe...?  John points out tip
11128
@c can set these as internal variables, eg ~s parity=none; man stty
11129
@c suggests that it *might* work to stty these options with stdin or
11130
@c stdout redirected... ---doc@cygnus.com, 25feb91
11131
@c
11132
@c There's nothing to be done for the "none" part of the DOS MODE
11133
@c command.  The rest of the parameters should be matched by the
11134
@c baudrate, bits, and parity used by the Unix side. ---Eli Zaretskii, 3Sep99
11135
 
11136
@kindex EBMON
11137
Using the @code{tip} or @code{cu} connection, change the DOS working
11138
directory to the directory containing a copy of your 29K program, then
11139
start the PC program @code{EBMON} (an EB29K control program supplied
11140
with your board by AMD).  You should see an initial display from
11141
@code{EBMON} similar to the one that follows, ending with the
11142
@code{EBMON} prompt @samp{#}---
11143
 
11144
@example
11145
C:\> G:
11146
 
11147
G:\> CD \usr\joe\work29k
11148
 
11149
G:\USR\JOE\WORK29K> EBMON
11150
Am29000 PC Coprocessor Board Monitor, version 3.0-18
11151
Copyright 1990 Advanced Micro Devices, Inc.
11152
Written by Gibbons and Associates, Inc.
11153
 
11154
Enter '?' or 'H' for help
11155
 
11156
PC Coprocessor Type   = EB29K
11157
I/O Base              = 0x208
11158
Memory Base           = 0xd0000
11159
 
11160
Data Memory Size      = 2048KB
11161
Available I-RAM Range = 0x8000 to 0x1fffff
11162
Available D-RAM Range = 0x80002000 to 0x801fffff
11163
 
11164
PageSize              = 0x400
11165
Register Stack Size   = 0x800
11166
Memory Stack Size     = 0x1800
11167
 
11168
CPU PRL               = 0x3
11169
Am29027 Available     = No
11170
Byte Write Available  = Yes
11171
 
11172
# ~.
11173
@end example
11174
 
11175
Then exit the @code{cu} or @code{tip} program (done in the example by
11176
typing @code{~.} at the @code{EBMON} prompt).  @code{EBMON} keeps
11177
running, ready for @value{GDBN} to take over.
11178
 
11179
For this example, we've assumed what is probably the most convenient
11180
way to make sure the same 29K program is on both the PC and the Unix
11181
system: a PC/NFS connection that establishes ``drive @file{G:}'' on the
11182
PC as a file system on the Unix host.  If you do not have PC/NFS or
11183
something similar connecting the two systems, you must arrange some
11184
other way---perhaps floppy-disk transfer---of getting the 29K program
11185
from the Unix system to the PC; @value{GDBN} does @emph{not} download it over the
11186
serial line.
11187
 
11188
@node gdb-EB29K
11189
@subsubsection EB29K cross-debugging
11190
 
11191
Finally, @code{cd} to the directory containing an image of your 29K
11192
program on the Unix system, and start @value{GDBN}---specifying as argument the
11193
name of your 29K program:
11194
 
11195
@example
11196
cd /usr/joe/work29k
11197
@value{GDBP} myfoo
11198
@end example
11199
 
11200
@need 500
11201
Now you can use the @code{target} command:
11202
 
11203
@example
11204
target amd-eb /dev/ttya 9600 MYFOO
11205
@c FIXME: test above 'target amd-eb' as spelled, with caps!  caps are meant to
11206
@c emphasize that this is the name as seen by DOS (since I think DOS is
11207
@c single-minded about case of letters).  ---doc@cygnus.com, 25feb91
11208
@end example
11209
 
11210
@noindent
11211
In this example, we've assumed your program is in a file called
11212
@file{myfoo}.  Note that the filename given as the last argument to
11213
@code{target amd-eb} should be the name of the program as it appears to DOS.
11214
In our example this is simply @code{MYFOO}, but in general it can include
11215
a DOS path, and depending on your transfer mechanism may not resemble
11216
the name on the Unix side.
11217
 
11218
At this point, you can set any breakpoints you wish; when you are ready
11219
to see your program run on the 29K board, use the @value{GDBN} command
11220
@code{run}.
11221
 
11222
To stop debugging the remote program, use the @value{GDBN} @code{detach}
11223
command.
11224
 
11225
To return control of the PC to its console, use @code{tip} or @code{cu}
11226
once again, after your @value{GDBN} session has concluded, to attach to
11227
@code{EBMON}.  You can then type the command @code{q} to shut down
11228
@code{EBMON}, returning control to the DOS command-line interpreter.
11229
Type @kbd{CTTY con} to return command input to the main DOS console,
11230
and type @kbd{~.} to leave @code{tip} or @code{cu}.
11231
 
11232
@node Remote Log
11233
@subsubsection Remote log
11234
@cindex @file{eb.log}, a log file for EB29K
11235
@cindex log file for EB29K
11236
 
11237
The @code{target amd-eb} command creates a file @file{eb.log} in the
11238
current working directory, to help debug problems with the connection.
11239
@file{eb.log} records all the output from @code{EBMON}, including echoes
11240
of the commands sent to it.  Running @samp{tail -f} on this file in
11241
another window often helps to understand trouble with @code{EBMON}, or
11242
unexpected events on the PC side of the connection.
11243
 
11244
@node ARM
11245
@subsection ARM
11246
 
11247
@table @code
11248
 
11249
@kindex target rdi
11250
@item target rdi @var{dev}
11251
ARM Angel monitor, via RDI library interface to ADP protocol.  You may
11252
use this target to communicate with both boards running the Angel
11253
monitor, or with the EmbeddedICE JTAG debug device.
11254
 
11255
@kindex target rdp
11256
@item target rdp @var{dev}
11257
ARM Demon monitor.
11258
 
11259
@end table
11260
 
11261
@node H8/300
11262
@subsection Hitachi H8/300
11263
 
11264
@table @code
11265
 
11266
@kindex target hms@r{, with H8/300}
11267
@item target hms @var{dev}
11268
A Hitachi SH, H8/300, or H8/500 board, attached via serial line to your host.
11269
Use special commands @code{device} and @code{speed} to control the serial
11270
line and the communications speed used.
11271
 
11272
@kindex target e7000@r{, with H8/300}
11273
@item target e7000 @var{dev}
11274
E7000 emulator for Hitachi H8 and SH.
11275
 
11276
@kindex target sh3@r{, with H8/300}
11277
@kindex target sh3e@r{, with H8/300}
11278
@item target sh3 @var{dev}
11279
@itemx target sh3e @var{dev}
11280
Hitachi SH-3 and SH-3E target systems.
11281
 
11282
@end table
11283
 
11284
@cindex download to H8/300 or H8/500
11285
@cindex H8/300 or H8/500 download
11286
@cindex download to Hitachi SH
11287
@cindex Hitachi SH download
11288
When you select remote debugging to a Hitachi SH, H8/300, or H8/500
11289
board, the @code{load} command downloads your program to the Hitachi
11290
board and also opens it as the current executable target for
11291
@value{GDBN} on your host (like the @code{file} command).
11292
 
11293
@value{GDBN} needs to know these things to talk to your
11294
Hitachi SH, H8/300, or H8/500:
11295
 
11296
@enumerate
11297
@item
11298
that you want to use @samp{target hms}, the remote debugging interface
11299
for Hitachi microprocessors, or @samp{target e7000}, the in-circuit
11300
emulator for the Hitachi SH and the Hitachi 300H.  (@samp{target hms} is
11301
the default when @value{GDBN} is configured specifically for the Hitachi SH,
11302
H8/300, or H8/500.)
11303
 
11304
@item
11305
what serial device connects your host to your Hitachi board (the first
11306
serial device available on your host is the default).
11307
 
11308
@item
11309
what speed to use over the serial device.
11310
@end enumerate
11311
 
11312
@menu
11313
* Hitachi Boards::      Connecting to Hitachi boards.
11314
* Hitachi ICE::         Using the E7000 In-Circuit Emulator.
11315
* Hitachi Special::     Special @value{GDBN} commands for Hitachi micros.
11316
@end menu
11317
 
11318
@node Hitachi Boards
11319
@subsubsection Connecting to Hitachi boards
11320
 
11321
@c only for Unix hosts
11322
@kindex device
11323
@cindex serial device, Hitachi micros
11324
Use the special @code{@value{GDBN}} command @samp{device @var{port}} if you
11325
need to explicitly set the serial device.  The default @var{port} is the
11326
first available port on your host.  This is only necessary on Unix
11327
hosts, where it is typically something like @file{/dev/ttya}.
11328
 
11329
@kindex speed
11330
@cindex serial line speed, Hitachi micros
11331
@code{@value{GDBN}} has another special command to set the communications
11332
speed: @samp{speed @var{bps}}.  This command also is only used from Unix
11333
hosts; on DOS hosts, set the line speed as usual from outside @value{GDBN} with
11334
the DOS @code{mode} command (for instance,
11335
@w{@kbd{mode com2:9600,n,8,1,p}} for a 9600@dmn{bps} connection).
11336
 
11337
The @samp{device} and @samp{speed} commands are available only when you
11338
use a Unix host to debug your Hitachi microprocessor programs.  If you
11339
use a DOS host,
11340
@value{GDBN} depends on an auxiliary terminate-and-stay-resident program
11341
called @code{asynctsr} to communicate with the development board
11342
through a PC serial port.  You must also use the DOS @code{mode} command
11343
to set up the serial port on the DOS side.
11344
 
11345
The following sample session illustrates the steps needed to start a
11346
program under @value{GDBN} control on an H8/300.  The example uses a
11347
sample H8/300 program called @file{t.x}.  The procedure is the same for
11348
the Hitachi SH and the H8/500.
11349
 
11350
First hook up your development board.  In this example, we use a
11351
board attached to serial port @code{COM2}; if you use a different serial
11352
port, substitute its name in the argument of the @code{mode} command.
11353
When you call @code{asynctsr}, the auxiliary comms program used by the
11354
debugger, you give it just the numeric part of the serial port's name;
11355
for example, @samp{asyncstr 2} below runs @code{asyncstr} on
11356
@code{COM2}.
11357
 
11358
@example
11359
C:\H8300\TEST> asynctsr 2
11360
C:\H8300\TEST> mode com2:9600,n,8,1,p
11361
 
11362
Resident portion of MODE loaded
11363
 
11364
COM2: 9600, n, 8, 1, p
11365
 
11366
@end example
11367
 
11368
@quotation
11369
@emph{Warning:} We have noticed a bug in PC-NFS that conflicts with
11370
@code{asynctsr}.  If you also run PC-NFS on your DOS host, you may need to
11371
disable it, or even boot without it, to use @code{asynctsr} to control
11372
your development board.
11373
@end quotation
11374
 
11375
@kindex target hms@r{, and serial protocol}
11376
Now that serial communications are set up, and the development board is
11377
connected, you can start up @value{GDBN}.  Call @code{@value{GDBP}} with
11378
the name of your program as the argument.  @code{@value{GDBN}} prompts
11379
you, as usual, with the prompt @samp{(@value{GDBP})}.  Use two special
11380
commands to begin your debugging session: @samp{target hms} to specify
11381
cross-debugging to the Hitachi board, and the @code{load} command to
11382
download your program to the board.  @code{load} displays the names of
11383
the program's sections, and a @samp{*} for each 2K of data downloaded.
11384
(If you want to refresh @value{GDBN} data on symbols or on the
11385
executable file without downloading, use the @value{GDBN} commands
11386
@code{file} or @code{symbol-file}.  These commands, and @code{load}
11387
itself, are described in @ref{Files,,Commands to specify files}.)
11388
 
11389
@smallexample
11390
(eg-C:\H8300\TEST) @value{GDBP} t.x
11391
@value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
11392
 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
11393
 the conditions.
11394
There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
11395
for details.
11396
@value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1992 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
11397
(@value{GDBP}) target hms
11398
Connected to remote H8/300 HMS system.
11399
(@value{GDBP}) load t.x
11400
.text   : 0x8000 .. 0xabde ***********
11401
.data   : 0xabde .. 0xad30 *
11402
.stack  : 0xf000 .. 0xf014 *
11403
@end smallexample
11404
 
11405
At this point, you're ready to run or debug your program.  From here on,
11406
you can use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands.  The @code{break} command
11407
sets breakpoints; the @code{run} command starts your program;
11408
@code{print} or @code{x} display data; the @code{continue} command
11409
resumes execution after stopping at a breakpoint.  You can use the
11410
@code{help} command at any time to find out more about @value{GDBN} commands.
11411
 
11412
Remember, however, that @emph{operating system} facilities aren't
11413
available on your development board; for example, if your program hangs,
11414
you can't send an interrupt---but you can press the @sc{reset} switch!
11415
 
11416
Use the @sc{reset} button on the development board
11417
@itemize @bullet
11418
@item
11419
to interrupt your program (don't use @kbd{ctl-C} on the DOS host---it has
11420
no way to pass an interrupt signal to the development board); and
11421
 
11422
@item
11423
to return to the @value{GDBN} command prompt after your program finishes
11424
normally.  The communications protocol provides no other way for @value{GDBN}
11425
to detect program completion.
11426
@end itemize
11427
 
11428
In either case, @value{GDBN} sees the effect of a @sc{reset} on the
11429
development board as a ``normal exit'' of your program.
11430
 
11431
@node Hitachi ICE
11432
@subsubsection Using the E7000 in-circuit emulator
11433
 
11434
@kindex target e7000@r{, with Hitachi ICE}
11435
You can use the E7000 in-circuit emulator to develop code for either the
11436
Hitachi SH or the H8/300H.  Use one of these forms of the @samp{target
11437
e7000} command to connect @value{GDBN} to your E7000:
11438
 
11439
@table @code
11440
@item target e7000 @var{port} @var{speed}
11441
Use this form if your E7000 is connected to a serial port.  The
11442
@var{port} argument identifies what serial port to use (for example,
11443
@samp{com2}).  The third argument is the line speed in bits per second
11444
(for example, @samp{9600}).
11445
 
11446
@item target e7000 @var{hostname}
11447
If your E7000 is installed as a host on a TCP/IP network, you can just
11448
specify its hostname; @value{GDBN} uses @code{telnet} to connect.
11449
@end table
11450
 
11451
@node Hitachi Special
11452
@subsubsection Special @value{GDBN} commands for Hitachi micros
11453
 
11454
Some @value{GDBN} commands are available only for the H8/300:
11455
 
11456
@table @code
11457
 
11458
@kindex set machine
11459
@kindex show machine
11460
@item set machine h8300
11461
@itemx set machine h8300h
11462
Condition @value{GDBN} for one of the two variants of the H8/300
11463
architecture with @samp{set machine}.  You can use @samp{show machine}
11464
to check which variant is currently in effect.
11465
 
11466
@end table
11467
 
11468
@node H8/500
11469
@subsection H8/500
11470
 
11471
@table @code
11472
 
11473
@kindex set memory @var{mod}
11474
@cindex memory models, H8/500
11475
@item set memory @var{mod}
11476
@itemx show memory
11477
Specify which H8/500 memory model (@var{mod}) you are using with
11478
@samp{set memory}; check which memory model is in effect with @samp{show
11479
memory}.  The accepted values for @var{mod} are @code{small},
11480
@code{big}, @code{medium}, and @code{compact}.
11481
 
11482
@end table
11483
 
11484
@node i960
11485
@subsection Intel i960
11486
 
11487
@table @code
11488
 
11489
@kindex target mon960
11490
@item target mon960 @var{dev}
11491
MON960 monitor for Intel i960.
11492
 
11493
@kindex target nindy
11494
@item target nindy @var{devicename}
11495
An Intel 960 board controlled by a Nindy Monitor.  @var{devicename} is
11496
the name of the serial device to use for the connection, e.g.
11497
@file{/dev/ttya}.
11498
 
11499
@end table
11500
 
11501
@cindex Nindy
11502
@cindex i960
11503
@dfn{Nindy} is a ROM Monitor program for Intel 960 target systems.  When
11504
@value{GDBN} is configured to control a remote Intel 960 using Nindy, you can
11505
tell @value{GDBN} how to connect to the 960 in several ways:
11506
 
11507
@itemize @bullet
11508
@item
11509
Through command line options specifying serial port, version of the
11510
Nindy protocol, and communications speed;
11511
 
11512
@item
11513
By responding to a prompt on startup;
11514
 
11515
@item
11516
By using the @code{target} command at any point during your @value{GDBN}
11517
session.  @xref{Target Commands, ,Commands for managing targets}.
11518
 
11519
@end itemize
11520
 
11521
@cindex download to Nindy-960
11522
With the Nindy interface to an Intel 960 board, @code{load}
11523
downloads @var{filename} to the 960 as well as adding its symbols in
11524
@value{GDBN}.
11525
 
11526
@menu
11527
* Nindy Startup::               Startup with Nindy
11528
* Nindy Options::               Options for Nindy
11529
* Nindy Reset::                 Nindy reset command
11530
@end menu
11531
 
11532
@node Nindy Startup
11533
@subsubsection Startup with Nindy
11534
 
11535
If you simply start @code{@value{GDBP}} without using any command-line
11536
options, you are prompted for what serial port to use, @emph{before} you
11537
reach the ordinary @value{GDBN} prompt:
11538
 
11539
@example
11540
Attach /dev/ttyNN -- specify NN, or "quit" to quit:
11541
@end example
11542
 
11543
@noindent
11544
Respond to the prompt with whatever suffix (after @samp{/dev/tty})
11545
identifies the serial port you want to use.  You can, if you choose,
11546
simply start up with no Nindy connection by responding to the prompt
11547
with an empty line.  If you do this and later wish to attach to Nindy,
11548
use @code{target} (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for managing targets}).
11549
 
11550
@node Nindy Options
11551
@subsubsection Options for Nindy
11552
 
11553
These are the startup options for beginning your @value{GDBN} session with a
11554
Nindy-960 board attached:
11555
 
11556
@table @code
11557
@item -r @var{port}
11558
Specify the serial port name of a serial interface to be used to connect
11559
to the target system.  This option is only available when @value{GDBN} is
11560
configured for the Intel 960 target architecture.  You may specify
11561
@var{port} as any of: a full pathname (e.g. @samp{-r /dev/ttya}), a
11562
device name in @file{/dev} (e.g. @samp{-r ttya}), or simply the unique
11563
suffix for a specific @code{tty} (e.g. @samp{-r a}).
11564
 
11565
@item -O
11566
(An uppercase letter ``O'', not a zero.)  Specify that @value{GDBN} should use
11567
the ``old'' Nindy monitor protocol to connect to the target system.
11568
This option is only available when @value{GDBN} is configured for the Intel 960
11569
target architecture.
11570
 
11571
@quotation
11572
@emph{Warning:} if you specify @samp{-O}, but are actually trying to
11573
connect to a target system that expects the newer protocol, the connection
11574
fails, appearing to be a speed mismatch.  @value{GDBN} repeatedly
11575
attempts to reconnect at several different line speeds.  You can abort
11576
this process with an interrupt.
11577
@end quotation
11578
 
11579
@item -brk
11580
Specify that @value{GDBN} should first send a @code{BREAK} signal to the target
11581
system, in an attempt to reset it, before connecting to a Nindy target.
11582
 
11583
@quotation
11584
@emph{Warning:} Many target systems do not have the hardware that this
11585
requires; it only works with a few boards.
11586
@end quotation
11587
@end table
11588
 
11589
The standard @samp{-b} option controls the line speed used on the serial
11590
port.
11591
 
11592
@c @group
11593
@node Nindy Reset
11594
@subsubsection Nindy reset command
11595
 
11596
@table @code
11597
@item reset
11598
@kindex reset
11599
For a Nindy target, this command sends a ``break'' to the remote target
11600
system; this is only useful if the target has been equipped with a
11601
circuit to perform a hard reset (or some other interesting action) when
11602
a break is detected.
11603
@end table
11604
@c @end group
11605
 
11606
@node M32R/D
11607
@subsection Mitsubishi M32R/D
11608
 
11609
@table @code
11610
 
11611
@kindex target m32r
11612
@item target m32r @var{dev}
11613
Mitsubishi M32R/D ROM monitor.
11614
 
11615
@end table
11616
 
11617
@node M68K
11618
@subsection M68k
11619
 
11620
The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support, and
11621
target command for the following ROM monitors.
11622
 
11623
@table @code
11624
 
11625
@kindex target abug
11626
@item target abug @var{dev}
11627
ABug ROM monitor for M68K.
11628
 
11629
@kindex target cpu32bug
11630
@item target cpu32bug @var{dev}
11631
CPU32BUG monitor, running on a CPU32 (M68K) board.
11632
 
11633
@kindex target dbug
11634
@item target dbug @var{dev}
11635
dBUG ROM monitor for Motorola ColdFire.
11636
 
11637
@kindex target est
11638
@item target est @var{dev}
11639
EST-300 ICE monitor, running on a CPU32 (M68K) board.
11640
 
11641
@kindex target rom68k
11642
@item target rom68k @var{dev}
11643
ROM 68K monitor, running on an M68K IDP board.
11644
 
11645
@end table
11646
 
11647
If @value{GDBN} is configured with @code{m68*-ericsson-*}, it will
11648
instead have only a single special target command:
11649
 
11650
@table @code
11651
 
11652
@kindex target es1800
11653
@item target es1800 @var{dev}
11654
ES-1800 emulator for M68K.
11655
 
11656
@end table
11657
 
11658
[context?]
11659
 
11660
@table @code
11661
 
11662
@kindex target rombug
11663
@item target rombug @var{dev}
11664
ROMBUG ROM monitor for OS/9000.
11665
 
11666
@end table
11667
 
11668
@node M88K
11669
@subsection M88K
11670
 
11671
@table @code
11672
 
11673
@kindex target bug
11674
@item target bug @var{dev}
11675
BUG monitor, running on a MVME187 (m88k) board.
11676
 
11677
@end table
11678
 
11679
@node MIPS Embedded
11680
@subsection MIPS Embedded
11681
 
11682
@cindex MIPS boards
11683
@value{GDBN} can use the MIPS remote debugging protocol to talk to a
11684
MIPS board attached to a serial line.  This is available when
11685
you configure @value{GDBN} with @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.
11686
 
11687
@need 1000
11688
Use these @value{GDBN} commands to specify the connection to your target board:
11689
 
11690
@table @code
11691
@item target mips @var{port}
11692
@kindex target mips @var{port}
11693
To run a program on the board, start up @code{@value{GDBP}} with the
11694
name of your program as the argument.  To connect to the board, use the
11695
command @samp{target mips @var{port}}, where @var{port} is the name of
11696
the serial port connected to the board.  If the program has not already
11697
been downloaded to the board, you may use the @code{load} command to
11698
download it.  You can then use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands.
11699
 
11700
For example, this sequence connects to the target board through a serial
11701
port, and loads and runs a program called @var{prog} through the
11702
debugger:
11703
 
11704
@example
11705
host$ @value{GDBP} @var{prog}
11706
@value{GDBN} is free software and @dots{}
11707
(@value{GDBP}) target mips /dev/ttyb
11708
(@value{GDBP}) load @var{prog}
11709
(@value{GDBP}) run
11710
@end example
11711
 
11712
@item target mips @var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}
11713
On some @value{GDBN} host configurations, you can specify a TCP
11714
connection (for instance, to a serial line managed by a terminal
11715
concentrator) instead of a serial port, using the syntax
11716
@samp{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
11717
 
11718
@item target pmon @var{port}
11719
@kindex target pmon @var{port}
11720
PMON ROM monitor.
11721
 
11722
@item target ddb @var{port}
11723
@kindex target ddb @var{port}
11724
NEC's DDB variant of PMON for Vr4300.
11725
 
11726
@item target lsi @var{port}
11727
@kindex target lsi @var{port}
11728
LSI variant of PMON.
11729
 
11730
@kindex target r3900
11731
@item target r3900 @var{dev}
11732
Densan DVE-R3900 ROM monitor for Toshiba R3900 Mips.
11733
 
11734
@kindex target array
11735
@item target array @var{dev}
11736
Array Tech LSI33K RAID controller board.
11737
 
11738
@end table
11739
 
11740
 
11741
@noindent
11742
@value{GDBN} also supports these special commands for MIPS targets:
11743
 
11744
@table @code
11745
@item set processor @var{args}
11746
@itemx show processor
11747
@kindex set processor @var{args}
11748
@kindex show processor
11749
Use the @code{set processor} command to set the type of MIPS
11750
processor when you want to access processor-type-specific registers.
11751
For example, @code{set processor @var{r3041}} tells @value{GDBN}
11752
to use the CPU registers appropriate for the 3041 chip.
11753
Use the @code{show processor} command to see what MIPS processor @value{GDBN}
11754
is using.  Use the @code{info reg} command to see what registers
11755
@value{GDBN} is using.
11756
 
11757
@item set mipsfpu double
11758
@itemx set mipsfpu single
11759
@itemx set mipsfpu none
11760
@itemx show mipsfpu
11761
@kindex set mipsfpu
11762
@kindex show mipsfpu
11763
@cindex MIPS remote floating point
11764
@cindex floating point, MIPS remote
11765
If your target board does not support the MIPS floating point
11766
coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
11767
need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init
11768
file).  This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
11769
functions which return floating point values.  It also allows
11770
@value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
11771
functions on the board.  If you are using a floating point coprocessor
11772
with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
11773
processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}.  The default
11774
double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
11775
@samp{set mipsfpu double}.
11776
 
11777
In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
11778
floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
11779
and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
11780
 
11781
As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
11782
@samp{show mipsfpu}.
11783
 
11784
@item set remotedebug @var{n}
11785
@itemx show remotedebug
11786
@kindex set remotedebug@r{, MIPS protocol}
11787
@kindex show remotedebug@r{, MIPS protocol}
11788
@cindex @code{remotedebug}, MIPS protocol
11789
@cindex MIPS @code{remotedebug} protocol
11790
@c FIXME! For this to be useful, you must know something about the MIPS
11791
@c FIXME...protocol.  Where is it described?
11792
You can see some debugging information about communications with the board
11793
by setting the @code{remotedebug} variable.  If you set it to @code{1} using
11794
@samp{set remotedebug 1}, every packet is displayed.  If you set it
11795
to @code{2}, every character is displayed.  You can check the current value
11796
at any time with the command @samp{show remotedebug}.
11797
 
11798
@item set timeout @var{seconds}
11799
@itemx set retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}
11800
@itemx show timeout
11801
@itemx show retransmit-timeout
11802
@cindex @code{timeout}, MIPS protocol
11803
@cindex @code{retransmit-timeout}, MIPS protocol
11804
@kindex set timeout
11805
@kindex show timeout
11806
@kindex set retransmit-timeout
11807
@kindex show retransmit-timeout
11808
You can control the timeout used while waiting for a packet, in the MIPS
11809
remote protocol, with the @code{set timeout @var{seconds}} command.  The
11810
default is 5 seconds.  Similarly, you can control the timeout used while
11811
waiting for an acknowledgement of a packet with the @code{set
11812
retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}} command.  The default is 3 seconds.
11813
You can inspect both values with @code{show timeout} and @code{show
11814
retransmit-timeout}.  (These commands are @emph{only} available when
11815
@value{GDBN} is configured for @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.)
11816
 
11817
The timeout set by @code{set timeout} does not apply when @value{GDBN}
11818
is waiting for your program to stop.  In that case, @value{GDBN} waits
11819
forever because it has no way of knowing how long the program is going
11820
to run before stopping.
11821
@end table
11822
 
11823
@node PowerPC
11824
@subsection PowerPC
11825
 
11826
@table @code
11827
 
11828
@kindex target dink32
11829
@item target dink32 @var{dev}
11830
DINK32 ROM monitor.
11831
 
11832
@kindex target ppcbug
11833
@item target ppcbug @var{dev}
11834
@kindex target ppcbug1
11835
@item target ppcbug1 @var{dev}
11836
PPCBUG ROM monitor for PowerPC.
11837
 
11838
@kindex target sds
11839
@item target sds @var{dev}
11840
SDS monitor, running on a PowerPC board (such as Motorola's ADS).
11841
 
11842
@end table
11843
 
11844
@node PA
11845
@subsection HP PA Embedded
11846
 
11847
@table @code
11848
 
11849
@kindex target op50n
11850
@item target op50n @var{dev}
11851
OP50N monitor, running on an OKI HPPA board.
11852
 
11853
@kindex target w89k
11854
@item target w89k @var{dev}
11855
W89K monitor, running on a Winbond HPPA board.
11856
 
11857
@end table
11858
 
11859
@node SH
11860
@subsection Hitachi SH
11861
 
11862
@table @code
11863
 
11864
@kindex target hms@r{, with Hitachi SH}
11865
@item target hms @var{dev}
11866
A Hitachi SH board attached via serial line to your host.  Use special
11867
commands @code{device} and @code{speed} to control the serial line and
11868
the communications speed used.
11869
 
11870
@kindex target e7000@r{, with Hitachi SH}
11871
@item target e7000 @var{dev}
11872
E7000 emulator for Hitachi SH.
11873
 
11874
@kindex target sh3@r{, with SH}
11875
@kindex target sh3e@r{, with SH}
11876
@item target sh3 @var{dev}
11877
@item target sh3e @var{dev}
11878
Hitachi SH-3 and SH-3E target systems.
11879
 
11880
@end table
11881
 
11882
@node Sparclet
11883
@subsection Tsqware Sparclet
11884
 
11885
@cindex Sparclet
11886
 
11887
@value{GDBN} enables developers to debug tasks running on
11888
Sparclet targets from a Unix host.
11889
@value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
11890
both the Unix host and on the Sparclet target.  The program
11891
@code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host.
11892
 
11893
@table @code
11894
@item remotetimeout @var{args}
11895
@kindex remotetimeout
11896
@value{GDBN} supports the option @code{remotetimeout}.
11897
This option is set by the user, and  @var{args} represents the number of
11898
seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses.
11899
@end table
11900
 
11901
@cindex compiling, on Sparclet
11902
When compiling for debugging, include the options @samp{-g} to get debug
11903
information and @samp{-Ttext} to relocate the program to where you wish to
11904
load it on the target.  You may also want to add the options @samp{-n} or
11905
@samp{-N} in order to reduce the size of the sections.  Example:
11906
 
11907
@example
11908
sparclet-aout-gcc prog.c -Ttext 0x12010000 -g -o prog -N
11909
@end example
11910
 
11911
You can use @code{objdump} to verify that the addresses are what you intended:
11912
 
11913
@example
11914
sparclet-aout-objdump --headers --syms prog
11915
@end example
11916
 
11917
@cindex running, on Sparclet
11918
Once you have set
11919
your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
11920
run @value{GDBN}.  From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}}
11921
(or @code{sparclet-aout-gdb}, depending on your installation).
11922
 
11923
@value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
11924
 
11925
@example
11926
(gdbslet)
11927
@end example
11928
 
11929
@menu
11930
* Sparclet File::                Setting the file to debug
11931
* Sparclet Connection::          Connecting to Sparclet
11932
* Sparclet Download::            Sparclet download
11933
* Sparclet Execution::           Running and debugging
11934
@end menu
11935
 
11936
@node Sparclet File
11937
@subsubsection Setting file to debug
11938
 
11939
The @value{GDBN} command @code{file} lets you choose with program to debug.
11940
 
11941
@example
11942
(gdbslet) file prog
11943
@end example
11944
 
11945
@need 1000
11946
@value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol table of @file{prog}.
11947
@value{GDBN} locates
11948
the file by searching the directories listed in the command search
11949
path.
11950
If the file was compiled with debug information (option "-g"), source
11951
files will be searched as well.
11952
@value{GDBN} locates
11953
the source files by searching the directories listed in the directory search
11954
path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}).
11955
If it fails
11956
to find a file, it displays a message such as:
11957
 
11958
@example
11959
prog: No such file or directory.
11960
@end example
11961
 
11962
When this happens, add the appropriate directories to the search paths with
11963
the @value{GDBN} commands @code{path} and @code{dir}, and execute the
11964
@code{target} command again.
11965
 
11966
@node Sparclet Connection
11967
@subsubsection Connecting to Sparclet
11968
 
11969
The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a Sparclet target.
11970
To connect to a target on serial port ``@code{ttya}'', type:
11971
 
11972
@example
11973
(gdbslet) target sparclet /dev/ttya
11974
Remote target sparclet connected to /dev/ttya
11975
main () at ../prog.c:3
11976
@end example
11977
 
11978
@need 750
11979
@value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
11980
 
11981
@example
11982
Connected to ttya.
11983
@end example
11984
 
11985
@node Sparclet Download
11986
@subsubsection Sparclet download
11987
 
11988
@cindex download to Sparclet
11989
Once connected to the Sparclet target,
11990
you can use the @value{GDBN}
11991
@code{load} command to download the file from the host to the target.
11992
The file name and load offset should be given as arguments to the @code{load}
11993
command.
11994
Since the file format is aout, the program must be loaded to the starting
11995
address.  You can use @code{objdump} to find out what this value is.  The load
11996
offset is an offset which is added to the VMA (virtual memory address)
11997
of each of the file's sections.
11998
For instance, if the program
11999
@file{prog} was linked to text address 0x1201000, with data at 0x12010160
12000
and bss at 0x12010170, in @value{GDBN}, type:
12001
 
12002
@example
12003
(gdbslet) load prog 0x12010000
12004
Loading section .text, size 0xdb0 vma 0x12010000
12005
@end example
12006
 
12007
If the code is loaded at a different address then what the program was linked
12008
to, you may need to use the @code{section} and @code{add-symbol-file} commands
12009
to tell @value{GDBN} where to map the symbol table.
12010
 
12011
@node Sparclet Execution
12012
@subsubsection Running and debugging
12013
 
12014
@cindex running and debugging Sparclet programs
12015
You can now begin debugging the task using @value{GDBN}'s execution control
12016
commands, @code{b}, @code{step}, @code{run}, etc.  See the @value{GDBN}
12017
manual for the list of commands.
12018
 
12019
@example
12020
(gdbslet) b main
12021
Breakpoint 1 at 0x12010000: file prog.c, line 3.
12022
(gdbslet) run
12023
Starting program: prog
12024
Breakpoint 1, main (argc=1, argv=0xeffff21c) at prog.c:3
12025
3        char *symarg = 0;
12026
(gdbslet) step
12027
4        char *execarg = "hello!";
12028
(gdbslet)
12029
@end example
12030
 
12031
@node Sparclite
12032
@subsection Fujitsu Sparclite
12033
 
12034
@table @code
12035
 
12036
@kindex target sparclite
12037
@item target sparclite @var{dev}
12038
Fujitsu sparclite boards, used only for the purpose of loading.
12039
You must use an additional command to debug the program.
12040
For example: target remote @var{dev} using @value{GDBN} standard
12041
remote protocol.
12042
 
12043
@end table
12044
 
12045
@node ST2000
12046
@subsection Tandem ST2000
12047
 
12048
@value{GDBN} may be used with a Tandem ST2000 phone switch, running Tandem's
12049
STDBUG protocol.
12050
 
12051
To connect your ST2000 to the host system, see the manufacturer's
12052
manual.  Once the ST2000 is physically attached, you can run:
12053
 
12054
@example
12055
target st2000 @var{dev} @var{speed}
12056
@end example
12057
 
12058
@noindent
12059
to establish it as your debugging environment.  @var{dev} is normally
12060
the name of a serial device, such as @file{/dev/ttya}, connected to the
12061
ST2000 via a serial line.  You can instead specify @var{dev} as a TCP
12062
connection (for example, to a serial line attached via a terminal
12063
concentrator) using the syntax @code{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
12064
 
12065
The @code{load} and @code{attach} commands are @emph{not} defined for
12066
this target; you must load your program into the ST2000 as you normally
12067
would for standalone operation.  @value{GDBN} reads debugging information
12068
(such as symbols) from a separate, debugging version of the program
12069
available on your host computer.
12070
@c FIXME!! This is terribly vague; what little content is here is
12071
@c basically hearsay.
12072
 
12073
@cindex ST2000 auxiliary commands
12074
These auxiliary @value{GDBN} commands are available to help you with the ST2000
12075
environment:
12076
 
12077
@table @code
12078
@item st2000 @var{command}
12079
@kindex st2000 @var{cmd}
12080
@cindex STDBUG commands (ST2000)
12081
@cindex commands to STDBUG (ST2000)
12082
Send a @var{command} to the STDBUG monitor.  See the manufacturer's
12083
manual for available commands.
12084
 
12085
@item connect
12086
@cindex connect (to STDBUG)
12087
Connect the controlling terminal to the STDBUG command monitor.  When
12088
you are done interacting with STDBUG, typing either of two character
12089
sequences gets you back to the @value{GDBN} command prompt:
12090
@kbd{@key{RET}~.} (Return, followed by tilde and period) or
12091
@kbd{@key{RET}~@key{C-d}} (Return, followed by tilde and control-D).
12092
@end table
12093
 
12094
@node Z8000
12095
@subsection Zilog Z8000
12096
 
12097
@cindex Z8000
12098
@cindex simulator, Z8000
12099
@cindex Zilog Z8000 simulator
12100
 
12101
When configured for debugging Zilog Z8000 targets, @value{GDBN} includes
12102
a Z8000 simulator.
12103
 
12104
For the Z8000 family, @samp{target sim} simulates either the Z8002 (the
12105
unsegmented variant of the Z8000 architecture) or the Z8001 (the
12106
segmented variant).  The simulator recognizes which architecture is
12107
appropriate by inspecting the object code.
12108
 
12109
@table @code
12110
@item target sim @var{args}
12111
@kindex sim
12112
@kindex target sim@r{, with Z8000}
12113
Debug programs on a simulated CPU.  If the simulator supports setup
12114
options, specify them via @var{args}.
12115
@end table
12116
 
12117
@noindent
12118
After specifying this target, you can debug programs for the simulated
12119
CPU in the same style as programs for your host computer; use the
12120
@code{file} command to load a new program image, the @code{run} command
12121
to run your program, and so on.
12122
 
12123
As well as making available all the usual machine registers
12124
(@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}), the Z8000 simulator provides three
12125
additional items of information as specially named registers:
12126
 
12127
@table @code
12128
 
12129
@item cycles
12130
Counts clock-ticks in the simulator.
12131
 
12132
@item insts
12133
Counts instructions run in the simulator.
12134
 
12135
@item time
12136
Execution time in 60ths of a second.
12137
 
12138
@end table
12139
 
12140
You can refer to these values in @value{GDBN} expressions with the usual
12141
conventions; for example, @w{@samp{b fputc if $cycles>5000}} sets a
12142
conditional breakpoint that suspends only after at least 5000
12143
simulated clock ticks.
12144
 
12145
@node Architectures
12146
@section Architectures
12147
 
12148
This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
12149
all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
12150
 
12151
@menu
12152
* A29K::
12153
* Alpha::
12154
* MIPS::
12155
@end menu
12156
 
12157
@node A29K
12158
@subsection A29K
12159
 
12160
@table @code
12161
 
12162
@kindex set rstack_high_address
12163
@cindex AMD 29K register stack
12164
@cindex register stack, AMD29K
12165
@item set rstack_high_address @var{address}
12166
On AMD 29000 family processors, registers are saved in a separate
12167
@dfn{register stack}.  There is no way for @value{GDBN} to determine the
12168
extent of this stack.  Normally, @value{GDBN} just assumes that the
12169
stack is ``large enough''.  This may result in @value{GDBN} referencing
12170
memory locations that do not exist.  If necessary, you can get around
12171
this problem by specifying the ending address of the register stack with
12172
the @code{set rstack_high_address} command.  The argument should be an
12173
address, which you probably want to precede with @samp{0x} to specify in
12174
hexadecimal.
12175
 
12176
@kindex show rstack_high_address
12177
@item show rstack_high_address
12178
Display the current limit of the register stack, on AMD 29000 family
12179
processors.
12180
 
12181
@end table
12182
 
12183
@node Alpha
12184
@subsection Alpha
12185
 
12186
See the following section.
12187
 
12188
@node MIPS
12189
@subsection MIPS
12190
 
12191
@cindex stack on Alpha
12192
@cindex stack on MIPS
12193
@cindex Alpha stack
12194
@cindex MIPS stack
12195
Alpha- and MIPS-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
12196
sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
12197
find the beginning of a function.
12198
 
12199
@cindex response time, MIPS debugging
12200
To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
12201
@value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
12202
you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
12203
commands:
12204
 
12205
@table @code
12206
@cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, MIPS)
12207
@item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
12208
Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
12209
search for the beginning of a function.  A value of @var{0} (the
12210
default) means there is no limit.  However, except for @var{0}, the
12211
larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
12212
and therefore the longer it takes to run.
12213
 
12214
@item show heuristic-fence-post
12215
Display the current limit.
12216
@end table
12217
 
12218
@noindent
12219
These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
12220
for debugging programs on Alpha or MIPS processors.
12221
 
12222
 
12223
@node Controlling GDB
12224
@chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
12225
 
12226
You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
12227
@code{set} command.  For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
12228
data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.  Other settings are
12229
described here.
12230
 
12231
@menu
12232
* Prompt::                      Prompt
12233
* Editing::                     Command editing
12234
* History::                     Command history
12235
* Screen Size::                 Screen size
12236
* Numbers::                     Numbers
12237
* Messages/Warnings::           Optional warnings and messages
12238
* Debugging Output::            Optional messages about internal happenings
12239
@end menu
12240
 
12241
@node Prompt
12242
@section Prompt
12243
 
12244
@cindex prompt
12245
 
12246
@value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
12247
called the @dfn{prompt}.  This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}.  You
12248
can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command.  For
12249
instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
12250
the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
12251
which one you are talking to.
12252
 
12253
@emph{Note:}  @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
12254
prompt you set.  This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
12255
or a prompt that does not.
12256
 
12257
@table @code
12258
@kindex set prompt
12259
@item set prompt @var{newprompt}
12260
Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
12261
 
12262
@kindex show prompt
12263
@item show prompt
12264
Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
12265
@end table
12266
 
12267
@node Editing
12268
@section Command editing
12269
@cindex readline
12270
@cindex command line editing
12271
 
12272
@value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{readline} interface.  This
12273
@sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
12274
command line interface to the user.  Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
12275
or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
12276
substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
12277
debugging sessions.
12278
 
12279
You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
12280
command @code{set}.
12281
 
12282
@table @code
12283
@kindex set editing
12284
@cindex editing
12285
@item set editing
12286
@itemx set editing on
12287
Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
12288
 
12289
@item set editing off
12290
Disable command line editing.
12291
 
12292
@kindex show editing
12293
@item show editing
12294
Show whether command line editing is enabled.
12295
@end table
12296
 
12297
@node History
12298
@section Command history
12299
 
12300
@value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
12301
debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
12302
happened.  Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
12303
history facility.
12304
 
12305
@table @code
12306
@cindex history substitution
12307
@cindex history file
12308
@kindex set history filename
12309
@kindex GDBHISTFILE
12310
@item set history filename @var{fname}
12311
Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
12312
This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
12313
list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
12314
exits.  You can access this list through history expansion or through
12315
the history command editing characters listed below.  This file defaults
12316
to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
12317
@file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
12318
is not set.
12319
 
12320
@cindex history save
12321
@kindex set history save
12322
@item set history save
12323
@itemx set history save on
12324
Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
12325
@code{set history filename} command.  By default, this option is disabled.
12326
 
12327
@item set history save off
12328
Stop recording command history in a file.
12329
 
12330
@cindex history size
12331
@kindex set history size
12332
@item set history size @var{size}
12333
Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
12334
This defaults to the value of the environment variable
12335
@code{HISTSIZE}, or to 256 if this variable is not set.
12336
@end table
12337
 
12338
@cindex history expansion
12339
History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
12340
@ifset have-readline-appendices
12341
@xref{Event Designators}.
12342
@end ifset
12343
 
12344
Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
12345
is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
12346
@code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
12347
follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
12348
a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded.  The readline
12349
history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
12350
@kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
12351
 
12352
The commands to control history expansion are:
12353
 
12354
@table @code
12355
@kindex set history expansion
12356
@item set history expansion on
12357
@itemx set history expansion
12358
Enable history expansion.  History expansion is off by default.
12359
 
12360
@item set history expansion off
12361
Disable history expansion.
12362
 
12363
The readline code comes with more complete documentation of
12364
editing and history expansion features.  Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs
12365
or @code{vi} may wish to read it.
12366
@ifset have-readline-appendices
12367
@xref{Command Line Editing}.
12368
@end ifset
12369
 
12370
@c @group
12371
@kindex show history
12372
@item show history
12373
@itemx show history filename
12374
@itemx show history save
12375
@itemx show history size
12376
@itemx show history expansion
12377
These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
12378
@code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
12379
@c @end group
12380
@end table
12381
 
12382
@table @code
12383
@kindex shows
12384
@item show commands
12385
Display the last ten commands in the command history.
12386
 
12387
@item show commands @var{n}
12388
Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
12389
 
12390
@item show commands +
12391
Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
12392
@end table
12393
 
12394
@node Screen Size
12395
@section Screen size
12396
@cindex size of screen
12397
@cindex pauses in output
12398
 
12399
Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
12400
information output to the screen.  To help you read all of it,
12401
@value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
12402
output.  Type @key{RET} when you want to continue the output, or @kbd{q}
12403
to discard the remaining output.  Also, the screen width setting
12404
determines when to wrap lines of output.  Depending on what is being
12405
printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a readable place,
12406
rather than simply letting it overflow onto the following line.
12407
 
12408
Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
12409
driver software.  For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
12410
together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
12411
@code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings.  If this is not correct,
12412
you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
12413
width} commands:
12414
 
12415
@table @code
12416
@kindex set height
12417
@kindex set width
12418
@kindex show width
12419
@kindex show height
12420
@item set height @var{lpp}
12421
@itemx show height
12422
@itemx set width @var{cpl}
12423
@itemx show width
12424
These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
12425
a screen width of @var{cpl} characters.  The associated @code{show}
12426
commands display the current settings.
12427
 
12428
If you specify a height of zero lines, @value{GDBN} does not pause during
12429
output no matter how long the output is.  This is useful if output is to a
12430
file or to an editor buffer.
12431
 
12432
Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN}
12433
from wrapping its output.
12434
@end table
12435
 
12436
@node Numbers
12437
@section Numbers
12438
@cindex number representation
12439
@cindex entering numbers
12440
 
12441
You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
12442
@value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
12443
@samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
12444
begin with @samp{0x}.  Numbers that begin with none of these are, by
12445
default, entered in base 10; likewise, the default display for
12446
numbers---when no particular format is specified---is base 10.  You can
12447
change the default base for both input and output with the @code{set
12448
radix} command.
12449
 
12450
@table @code
12451
@kindex set input-radix
12452
@item set input-radix @var{base}
12453
Set the default base for numeric input.  Supported choices
12454
for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16.  @var{base} must itself be
12455
specified either unambiguously or using the current default radix; for
12456
example, any of
12457
 
12458
@smallexample
12459
set radix 012
12460
set radix 10.
12461
set radix 0xa
12462
@end smallexample
12463
 
12464
@noindent
12465
sets the base to decimal.  On the other hand, @samp{set radix 10}
12466
leaves the radix unchanged no matter what it was.
12467
 
12468
@kindex set output-radix
12469
@item set output-radix @var{base}
12470
Set the default base for numeric display.  Supported choices
12471
for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16.  @var{base} must itself be
12472
specified either unambiguously or using the current default radix.
12473
 
12474
@kindex show input-radix
12475
@item show input-radix
12476
Display the current default base for numeric input.
12477
 
12478
@kindex show output-radix
12479
@item show output-radix
12480
Display the current default base for numeric display.
12481
@end table
12482
 
12483
@node Messages/Warnings
12484
@section Optional warnings and messages
12485
 
12486
By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings.  If you are
12487
running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
12488
command.  This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
12489
internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
12490
 
12491
Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
12492
which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
12493
see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}.
12494
 
12495
@table @code
12496
@kindex set verbose
12497
@item set verbose on
12498
Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
12499
 
12500
@item set verbose off
12501
Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
12502
 
12503
@kindex show verbose
12504
@item show verbose
12505
Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
12506
@end table
12507
 
12508
By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
12509
object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
12510
find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors reading
12511
symbol files}).
12512
 
12513
@table @code
12514
 
12515
@kindex set complaints
12516
@item set complaints @var{limit}
12517
Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
12518
unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem.  Set
12519
@var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
12520
to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
12521
 
12522
@kindex show complaints
12523
@item show complaints
12524
Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
12525
 
12526
@end table
12527
 
12528
By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
12529
lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands.  For example, if
12530
you try to run a program which is already running:
12531
 
12532
@example
12533
(@value{GDBP}) run
12534
The program being debugged has been started already.
12535
Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
12536
@end example
12537
 
12538
If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
12539
commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
12540
 
12541
@table @code
12542
 
12543
@kindex set confirm
12544
@cindex flinching
12545
@cindex confirmation
12546
@cindex stupid questions
12547
@item set confirm off
12548
Disables confirmation requests.
12549
 
12550
@item set confirm on
12551
Enables confirmation requests (the default).
12552
 
12553
@kindex show confirm
12554
@item show confirm
12555
Displays state of confirmation requests.
12556
 
12557
@end table
12558
 
12559
@node Debugging Output
12560
@section Optional messages about internal happenings
12561
@table @code
12562
@kindex set debug arch
12563
@item set debug arch
12564
Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info. The default is off
12565
@kindex show debug arch
12566
@item show debug arch
12567
Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info.
12568
@kindex set debug event
12569
@item set debug event
12570
Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info. The
12571
default is off.
12572
@kindex show debug event
12573
@item show debug event
12574
Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging
12575
info.
12576
@kindex set debug expression
12577
@item set debug expression
12578
Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} expression debugging info. The
12579
default is off.
12580
@kindex show debug expression
12581
@item show debug expression
12582
Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} expression
12583
debugging info.
12584
@kindex set debug overload
12585
@item set debug overload
12586
Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload debugging
12587
info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc. The default
12588
is off.
12589
@kindex show debug overload
12590
@item show debug overload
12591
Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload
12592
debugging info.
12593
@kindex set debug remote
12594
@cindex packets, reporting on stdout
12595
@cindex serial connections, debugging
12596
@item set debug remote
12597
Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across
12598
the serial line to the remote machine.  The info is printed on the
12599
@value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off.
12600
@kindex show debug remote
12601
@item show debug remote
12602
Displays the state of display of remote packets.
12603
@kindex set debug serial
12604
@item set debug serial
12605
Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The
12606
default is off.
12607
@kindex show debug serial
12608
@item show debug serial
12609
Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging
12610
info.
12611
@kindex set debug target
12612
@item set debug target
12613
Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info
12614
includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The
12615
default is off.
12616
@kindex show debug target
12617
@item show debug target
12618
Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging
12619
info.
12620
@kindex set debug varobj
12621
@item set debug varobj
12622
Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging
12623
info. The default is off.
12624
@kindex show debug varobj
12625
@item show debug varobj
12626
Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object
12627
debugging info.
12628
@end table
12629
 
12630
@node Sequences
12631
@chapter Canned Sequences of Commands
12632
 
12633
Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
12634
command lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
12635
commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
12636
files.
12637
 
12638
@menu
12639
* Define::                      User-defined commands
12640
* Hooks::                       User-defined command hooks
12641
* Command Files::               Command files
12642
* Output::                      Commands for controlled output
12643
@end menu
12644
 
12645
@node Define
12646
@section User-defined commands
12647
 
12648
@cindex user-defined command
12649
A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
12650
which you assign a new name as a command.  This is done with the
12651
@code{define} command.  User commands may accept up to 10 arguments
12652
separated by whitespace.  Arguments are accessed within the user command
12653
via @var{$arg0@dots{}$arg9}.  A trivial example:
12654
 
12655
@smallexample
12656
define adder
12657
  print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
12658
@end smallexample
12659
 
12660
@noindent
12661
To execute the command use:
12662
 
12663
@smallexample
12664
adder 1 2 3
12665
@end smallexample
12666
 
12667
@noindent
12668
This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
12669
its three arguments.  Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
12670
reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
12671
functions calls.
12672
 
12673
@table @code
12674
 
12675
@kindex define
12676
@item define @var{commandname}
12677
Define a command named @var{commandname}.  If there is already a command
12678
by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
12679
 
12680
The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
12681
which are given following the @code{define} command.  The end of these
12682
commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
12683
 
12684
@kindex if
12685
@kindex else
12686
@item if
12687
Takes a single argument, which is an expression to evaluate.
12688
It is followed by a series of commands that are executed
12689
only if the expression is true (nonzero).
12690
There can then optionally be a line @code{else}, followed
12691
by a series of commands that are only executed if the expression
12692
was false.  The end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
12693
 
12694
@kindex while
12695
@item while
12696
The syntax is similar to @code{if}: the command takes a single argument,
12697
which is an expression to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to
12698
execute, one per line, terminated by an @code{end}.
12699
The commands are executed repeatedly as long as the expression
12700
evaluates to true.
12701
 
12702
@kindex document
12703
@item document @var{commandname}
12704
Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
12705
accessed by @code{help}.  The command @var{commandname} must already be
12706
defined.  This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
12707
reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
12708
After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
12709
@var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
12710
 
12711
You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
12712
documentation of a command.  Redefining the command with @code{define}
12713
does not change the documentation.
12714
 
12715
@kindex help user-defined
12716
@item help user-defined
12717
List all user-defined commands, with the first line of the documentation
12718
(if any) for each.
12719
 
12720
@kindex show user
12721
@item show user
12722
@itemx show user @var{commandname}
12723
Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
12724
not its documentation).  If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
12725
definitions for all user-defined commands.
12726
 
12727
@end table
12728
 
12729
When user-defined commands are executed, the
12730
commands of the definition are not printed.  An error in any command
12731
stops execution of the user-defined command.
12732
 
12733
If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
12734
without asking when used inside a user-defined command.  Many @value{GDBN}
12735
commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
12736
messages when used in a user-defined command.
12737
 
12738
@node Hooks
12739
@section User-defined command hooks
12740
@cindex command hooks
12741
@cindex hooks, for commands
12742
@cindex hooks, pre-command
12743
 
12744
@kindex hook
12745
@kindex hook-
12746
You may define @dfn{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
12747
command.  Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
12748
command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
12749
before that command.
12750
 
12751
@cindex hooks, post-command
12752
@kindex hookpost
12753
@kindex hookpost-
12754
A hook may also be defined which is run after the command you executed.
12755
Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined command
12756
@samp{hookpost-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) after
12757
that command.  Post-execution hooks may exist simultaneously with
12758
pre-execution hooks, for the same command.
12759
 
12760
It is valid for a hook to call the command which it hooks.  If this
12761
occurs, the hook is not re-executed, thereby avoiding infinte recursion.
12762
 
12763
@c It would be nice if hookpost could be passed a parameter indicating
12764
@c if the command it hooks executed properly or not.  FIXME!
12765
 
12766
@kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
12767
In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists.  Defining
12768
(@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
12769
execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
12770
displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
12771
 
12772
For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
12773
single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
12774
you could define:
12775
 
12776
@example
12777
define hook-stop
12778
handle SIGALRM nopass
12779
end
12780
 
12781
define hook-run
12782
handle SIGALRM pass
12783
end
12784
 
12785
define hook-continue
12786
handle SIGLARM pass
12787
end
12788
@end example
12789
 
12790
As a further example, to hook at the begining and end of the @code{echo}
12791
command, and to add extra text to the beginning and end of the message,
12792
you could define:
12793
 
12794
@example
12795
define hook-echo
12796
echo <<<---
12797
end
12798
 
12799
define hookpost-echo
12800
echo --->>>\n
12801
end
12802
 
12803
(@value{GDBP}) echo Hello World
12804
<<<---Hello World--->>>
12805
(@value{GDBP})
12806
 
12807
@end example
12808
 
12809
You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
12810
not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
12811
name, e.g.  @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
12812
@c FIXME!  So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
12813
@c or not?
12814
If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
12815
@value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
12816
(before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
12817
 
12818
If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
12819
get a warning from the @code{define} command.
12820
 
12821
@node Command Files
12822
@section Command files
12823
 
12824
@cindex command files
12825
A command file for @value{GDBN} is a file of lines that are @value{GDBN}
12826
commands.  Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may also be included.
12827
An empty line in a command file does nothing; it does not mean to repeat
12828
the last command, as it would from the terminal.
12829
 
12830
@cindex init file
12831
@cindex @file{.gdbinit}
12832
@cindex @file{gdb.ini}
12833
When you start @value{GDBN}, it automatically executes commands from its
12834
@dfn{init files}.  These are files named @file{.gdbinit} on Unix and
12835
@file{gdb.ini} on DOS/Windows.  During startup, @value{GDBN} does the
12836
following:
12837
 
12838
@enumerate
12839
@item
12840
Reads the init file (if any) in your home directory@footnote{On
12841
DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the one pointed to by the
12842
@code{HOME} environment variable.}.
12843
 
12844
@item
12845
Processes command line options and operands.
12846
 
12847
@item
12848
Reads the init file (if any) in the current working directory.
12849
 
12850
@item
12851
Reads command files specified by the @samp{-x} option.
12852
@end enumerate
12853
 
12854
The init file in your home directory can set options (such as @samp{set
12855
complaints}) that affect subsequent processing of command line options
12856
and operands.  Init files are not executed if you use the @samp{-nx}
12857
option (@pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing modes}).
12858
 
12859
@cindex init file name
12860
On some configurations of @value{GDBN}, the init file is known by a
12861
different name (these are typically environments where a specialized
12862
form of @value{GDBN} may need to coexist with other forms, hence a
12863
different name for the specialized version's init file).  These are the
12864
environments with special init file names:
12865
 
12866
@cindex @file{.vxgdbinit}
12867
@itemize @bullet
12868
@item
12869
VxWorks (Wind River Systems real-time OS): @file{.vxgdbinit}
12870
 
12871
@cindex @file{.os68gdbinit}
12872
@item
12873
OS68K (Enea Data Systems real-time OS): @file{.os68gdbinit}
12874
 
12875
@cindex @file{.esgdbinit}
12876
@item
12877
ES-1800 (Ericsson Telecom AB M68000 emulator): @file{.esgdbinit}
12878
@end itemize
12879
 
12880
You can also request the execution of a command file with the
12881
@code{source} command:
12882
 
12883
@table @code
12884
@kindex source
12885
@item source @var{filename}
12886
Execute the command file @var{filename}.
12887
@end table
12888
 
12889
The lines in a command file are executed sequentially.  They are not
12890
printed as they are executed.  An error in any command terminates execution
12891
of the command file.
12892
 
12893
Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
12894
without asking when used in a command file.  Many @value{GDBN} commands that
12895
normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
12896
when called from command files.
12897
 
12898
@node Output
12899
@section Commands for controlled output
12900
 
12901
During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
12902
@value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
12903
explicitly printed by the commands in the definition.  This section
12904
describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
12905
want.
12906
 
12907
@table @code
12908
@kindex echo
12909
@item echo @var{text}
12910
@c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
12911
@c because it is not in ANSI.
12912
Print @var{text}.  Nonprinting characters can be included in
12913
@var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
12914
newline.  @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
12915
In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
12916
by a space stands for a space.  This is useful for displaying a
12917
string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
12918
trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
12919
To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
12920
@samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
12921
 
12922
A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
12923
the command onto subsequent lines.  For example,
12924
 
12925
@example
12926
echo This is some text\n\
12927
which is continued\n\
12928
onto several lines.\n
12929
@end example
12930
 
12931
produces the same output as
12932
 
12933
@example
12934
echo This is some text\n
12935
echo which is continued\n
12936
echo onto several lines.\n
12937
@end example
12938
 
12939
@kindex output
12940
@item output @var{expression}
12941
Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
12942
newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }.  The value is not entered in the
12943
value history either.  @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
12944
on expressions.
12945
 
12946
@item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
12947
Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}.  You can use
12948
the same formats as for @code{print}.  @xref{Output Formats,,Output
12949
formats}, for more information.
12950
 
12951
@kindex printf
12952
@item printf @var{string}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
12953
Print the values of the @var{expressions} under the control of
12954
@var{string}.  The @var{expressions} are separated by commas and may be
12955
either numbers or pointers.  Their values are printed as specified by
12956
@var{string}, exactly as if your program were to execute the C
12957
subroutine
12958
@c FIXME: the above implies that at least all ANSI C formats are
12959
@c supported, but it isn't true: %E and %G don't work (or so it seems).
12960
@c Either this is a bug, or the manual should document what formats are
12961
@c supported.
12962
 
12963
@example
12964
printf (@var{string}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
12965
@end example
12966
 
12967
For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
12968
 
12969
@smallexample
12970
printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
12971
@end smallexample
12972
 
12973
The only backslash-escape sequences that you can use in the format
12974
string are the simple ones that consist of backslash followed by a
12975
letter.
12976
@end table
12977
 
12978
@node Emacs
12979
@chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
12980
 
12981
@cindex Emacs
12982
@cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
12983
A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
12984
edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
12985
@value{GDBN}.
12986
 
12987
To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs.  Give the
12988
executable file you want to debug as an argument.  This command starts
12989
@value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
12990
created Emacs buffer.
12991
@c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
12992
 
12993
Using @value{GDBN} under Emacs is just like using @value{GDBN} normally except for two
12994
things:
12995
 
12996
@itemize @bullet
12997
@item
12998
All ``terminal'' input and output goes through the Emacs buffer.
12999
@end itemize
13000
 
13001
This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
13002
and output done by the program you are debugging.
13003
 
13004
This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
13005
commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
13006
in this way.
13007
 
13008
All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
13009
with your program.  In particular, you can send signals the usual
13010
way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
13011
stop.
13012
 
13013
@itemize @bullet
13014
@item
13015
@value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
13016
@end itemize
13017
 
13018
Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
13019
source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
13020
left margin of the current line.  Emacs uses a separate buffer for
13021
source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
13022
and the source.
13023
 
13024
Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
13025
usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
13026
 
13027
@quotation
13028
@emph{Warning:} If the directory where your program resides is not your
13029
current directory, it can be easy to confuse Emacs about the location of
13030
the source files, in which case the auxiliary display buffer does not
13031
appear to show your source.  @value{GDBN} can find programs by searching your
13032
environment's @code{PATH} variable, so the @value{GDBN} input and output
13033
session proceeds normally; but Emacs does not get enough information
13034
back from @value{GDBN} to locate the source files in this situation.  To
13035
avoid this problem, either start @value{GDBN} mode from the directory where
13036
your program resides, or specify an absolute file name when prompted for the
13037
@kbd{M-x gdb} argument.
13038
 
13039
A similar confusion can result if you use the @value{GDBN} @code{file} command to
13040
switch to debugging a program in some other location, from an existing
13041
@value{GDBN} buffer in Emacs.
13042
@end quotation
13043
 
13044
By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}.  If
13045
you need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you keep
13046
several configurations around, with different names) you can set the
13047
Emacs variable @code{gdb-command-name}; for example,
13048
 
13049
@example
13050
(setq gdb-command-name "mygdb")
13051
@end example
13052
 
13053
@noindent
13054
(preceded by @kbd{M-:} or @kbd{ESC :}, or typed in the @code{*scratch*} buffer, or
13055
in your @file{.emacs} file) makes Emacs call the program named
13056
``@code{mygdb}'' instead.
13057
 
13058
In the @value{GDBN} I/O buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
13059
addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
13060
 
13061
@table @kbd
13062
@item C-h m
13063
Describe the features of Emacs' @value{GDBN} Mode.
13064
 
13065
@item M-s
13066
Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
13067
update the display window to show the current file and location.
13068
 
13069
@item M-n
13070
Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
13071
calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command.  Then update the display window
13072
to show the current file and location.
13073
 
13074
@item M-i
13075
Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
13076
display window accordingly.
13077
 
13078
@item M-x gdb-nexti
13079
Execute to next instruction, using the @value{GDBN} @code{nexti} command; update
13080
display window accordingly.
13081
 
13082
@item C-c C-f
13083
Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
13084
@code{finish} command.
13085
 
13086
@item M-c
13087
Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
13088
command.
13089
 
13090
@emph{Warning:} In Emacs v19, this command is @kbd{C-c C-p}.
13091
 
13092
@item M-u
13093
Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
13094
(@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
13095
like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
13096
 
13097
@emph{Warning:} In Emacs v19, this command is @kbd{C-c C-u}.
13098
 
13099
@item M-d
13100
Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
13101
@value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
13102
 
13103
@emph{Warning:} In Emacs v19, this command is @kbd{C-c C-d}.
13104
 
13105
@item C-x &
13106
Read the number where the cursor is positioned, and insert it at the end
13107
of the @value{GDBN} I/O buffer.  For example, if you wish to disassemble code
13108
around an address that was displayed earlier, type @kbd{disassemble};
13109
then move the cursor to the address display, and pick up the
13110
argument for @code{disassemble} by typing @kbd{C-x &}.
13111
 
13112
You can customize this further by defining elements of the list
13113
@code{gdb-print-command}; once it is defined, you can format or
13114
otherwise process numbers picked up by @kbd{C-x &} before they are
13115
inserted.  A numeric argument to @kbd{C-x &} indicates that you
13116
wish special formatting, and also acts as an index to pick an element of the
13117
list.  If the list element is a string, the number to be inserted is
13118
formatted using the Emacs function @code{format}; otherwise the number
13119
is passed as an argument to the corresponding list element.
13120
@end table
13121
 
13122
In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x SPC} (@code{gdb-break})
13123
tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
13124
 
13125
If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
13126
it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
13127
request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
13128
the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
13129
frame.
13130
 
13131
The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
13132
which are visiting the source files in the usual way.  You can edit
13133
the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
13134
communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers.  If you add or
13135
delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
13136
to correspond properly with the code.
13137
 
13138
@c The following dropped because Epoch is nonstandard.  Reactivate
13139
@c if/when v19 does something similar. ---doc@cygnus.com 19dec1990
13140
@ignore
13141
@kindex Emacs Epoch environment
13142
@kindex Epoch
13143
@kindex inspect
13144
 
13145
Version 18 of @sc{gnu} Emacs has a built-in window system
13146
called the @code{epoch}
13147
environment.  Users of this environment can use a new command,
13148
@code{inspect} which performs identically to @code{print} except that
13149
each value is printed in its own window.
13150
@end ignore
13151
 
13152
@include annotate.texi
13153
@include gdbmi.texinfo
13154
 
13155
@node GDB Bugs
13156
@chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
13157
@cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
13158
@cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
13159
 
13160
Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
13161
 
13162
Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
13163
may not.  But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
13164
the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better.  Bug
13165
reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
13166
 
13167
In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
13168
information that enables us to fix the bug.
13169
 
13170
@menu
13171
* Bug Criteria::                Have you found a bug?
13172
* Bug Reporting::               How to report bugs
13173
@end menu
13174
 
13175
@node Bug Criteria
13176
@section Have you found a bug?
13177
@cindex bug criteria
13178
 
13179
If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
13180
 
13181
@itemize @bullet
13182
@cindex fatal signal
13183
@cindex debugger crash
13184
@cindex crash of debugger
13185
@item
13186
If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
13187
@value{GDBN} bug.  Reliable debuggers never crash.
13188
 
13189
@cindex error on valid input
13190
@item
13191
If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
13192
bug.  (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
13193
somewhere in the connection to the target.)
13194
 
13195
@cindex invalid input
13196
@item
13197
If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
13198
that is a bug.  However, you should note that your idea of
13199
``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
13200
for traditional practice''.
13201
 
13202
@item
13203
If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
13204
for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
13205
@end itemize
13206
 
13207
@node Bug Reporting
13208
@section How to report bugs
13209
@cindex bug reports
13210
@cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
13211
 
13212
A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
13213
If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
13214
contact that organization first.
13215
 
13216
You can find contact information for many support companies and
13217
individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
13218
distribution.
13219
@c should add a web page ref...
13220
 
13221
In any event, we also recommend that you send bug reports for
13222
@value{GDBN} to this addresses:
13223
 
13224
@example
13225
bug-gdb@@gnu.org
13226
@end example
13227
 
13228
@strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
13229
@samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.}  Most users of @value{GDBN} do
13230
not want to receive bug reports.  Those that do have arranged to receive
13231
@samp{bug-gdb}.
13232
 
13233
The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
13234
serves as a repeater.  The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
13235
the same messages.  Often people think of posting bug reports to the
13236
newsgroup instead of mailing them.  This appears to work, but it has one
13237
problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
13238
path back to the sender.  Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
13239
we may be unable to reach you.  For this reason, it is better to send
13240
bug reports to the mailing list.
13241
 
13242
As a last resort, send bug reports on paper to:
13243
 
13244
@example
13245
@sc{gnu} Debugger Bugs
13246
Free Software Foundation Inc.
13247
59 Temple Place - Suite 330
13248
Boston, MA 02111-1307
13249
USA
13250
@end example
13251
 
13252
The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
13253
@strong{report all the facts}.  If you are not sure whether to state a
13254
fact or leave it out, state it!
13255
 
13256
Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
13257
problem and assume that some details do not matter.  Thus, you might
13258
assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
13259
Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure.  Perhaps the bug is a
13260
stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
13261
name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
13262
of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
13263
the bug.  Play it safe and give a specific, complete example.  That is the
13264
easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
13265
 
13266
Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
13267
bug.  It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
13268
you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
13269
self-contained.
13270
 
13271
Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
13272
bell?''  Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
13273
@emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
13274
bugs properly.
13275
 
13276
To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
13277
 
13278
@itemize @bullet
13279
@item
13280
The version of @value{GDBN}.  @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
13281
with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
13282
version}.
13283
 
13284
Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
13285
the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
13286
 
13287
@item
13288
The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
13289
version number.
13290
 
13291
@item
13292
What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.
13293
``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
13294
 
13295
@item
13296
What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
13297
debugging---e.g.  ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
13298
C Compiler''.  For GCC, you can say @code{gcc --version} to get this
13299
information; for other compilers, see the documentation for those
13300
compilers.
13301
 
13302
@item
13303
The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
13304
observe the bug.  For example, did you use @samp{-O}?  To guarantee
13305
you will not omit something important, list them all.  A copy of the
13306
Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
13307
 
13308
If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
13309
and then we might not encounter the bug.
13310
 
13311
@item
13312
A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
13313
reproduce the bug.
13314
 
13315
@item
13316
A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
13317
incorrect.  For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
13318
 
13319
Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
13320
will certainly notice it.  But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
13321
not notice unless it is glaringly wrong.  You might as well not give us
13322
a chance to make a mistake.
13323
 
13324
Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
13325
say so explicitly.  Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
13326
copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
13327
the C library on your system.  (This has happened!)  Your copy might
13328
crash and ours would not.  If you told us to expect a crash, then when
13329
ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
13330
us.  If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
13331
to draw any conclusion from our observations.
13332
 
13333
@item
13334
If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
13335
diffs.  If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
13336
it by context, not by line number.
13337
 
13338
The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
13339
sources.  Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
13340
 
13341
@end itemize
13342
 
13343
Here are some things that are not necessary:
13344
 
13345
@itemize @bullet
13346
@item
13347
A description of the envelope of the bug.
13348
 
13349
Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
13350
which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
13351
changes will not affect it.
13352
 
13353
This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
13354
will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
13355
with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
13356
We recommend that you save your time for something else.
13357
 
13358
Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
13359
of the original one, that is a convenience for us.  Errors in the
13360
output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
13361
less time, and so on.
13362
 
13363
However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
13364
report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
13365
 
13366
@item
13367
A patch for the bug.
13368
 
13369
A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one.  But do not omit
13370
the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
13371
a patch is all we need.  We might see problems with your patch and decide
13372
to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
13373
 
13374
Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
13375
construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
13376
through the code.  If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
13377
to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
13378
 
13379
And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
13380
patch should be an improvement, we will not install it.  A test case will
13381
help us to understand.
13382
 
13383
@item
13384
A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
13385
 
13386
Such guesses are usually wrong.  Even we cannot guess right about such
13387
things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
13388
@end itemize
13389
 
13390
@c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
13391
@c and consists of the two following files:
13392
@c     rluser.texinfo
13393
@c     inc-hist.texinfo
13394
@c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
13395
@c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
13396
@include rluser.texinfo
13397
@include inc-hist.texinfo
13398
 
13399
 
13400
@node Formatting Documentation
13401
@appendix Formatting Documentation
13402
 
13403
@cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
13404
@cindex reference card
13405
The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
13406
for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
13407
subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
13408
@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
13409
release.}.  If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
13410
you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
13411
 
13412
The release also includes the source for the reference card.  You
13413
can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
13414
 
13415
@example
13416
make refcard.dvi
13417
@end example
13418
 
13419
The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
13420
mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
13421
that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
13422
high.  You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
13423
your @sc{dvi} output program.
13424
 
13425
@cindex documentation
13426
 
13427
All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
13428
distribution.  The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
13429
a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
13430
on-line information and a printed manual.  You can use one of the Info
13431
formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
13432
and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
13433
 
13434
@value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
13435
version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory.  The main Info
13436
file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
13437
subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory.  If
13438
necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
13439
but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
13440
Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
13441
@sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
13442
 
13443
If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
13444
Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
13445
@code{makeinfo}.
13446
 
13447
If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
13448
@value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
13449
version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
13450
 
13451
@example
13452
cd gdb
13453
make gdb.info
13454
@end example
13455
 
13456
If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
13457
a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
13458
Texinfo definitions file.
13459
 
13460
@TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
13461
produces output files called @sc{dvi} files.  To print a typeset
13462
document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files.  If your system
13463
has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program.  The precise
13464
command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
13465
(for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}.  The @sc{dvi} print command may
13466
require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
13467
 
13468
@TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
13469
@file{texinfo.tex}.  This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
13470
written in Texinfo format.  On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
13471
typeset a Texinfo file.  @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
13472
and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
13473
directory.
13474
 
13475
If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
13476
typeset and print this manual.  First switch to the the @file{gdb}
13477
subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
13478
@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
13479
 
13480
@example
13481
make gdb.dvi
13482
@end example
13483
 
13484
Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
13485
 
13486
@node Installing GDB
13487
@appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
13488
@cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
13489
@cindex installation
13490
 
13491
@value{GDBN} comes with a @code{configure} script that automates the process
13492
of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
13493
build the @code{gdb} program.
13494
@iftex
13495
@c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
13496
@footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
13497
look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
13498
installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
13499
@end iftex
13500
 
13501
The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
13502
@value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
13503
appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
13504
 
13505
For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
13506
@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.  That directory contains:
13507
 
13508
@table @code
13509
@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
13510
script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
13511
 
13512
@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
13513
the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
13514
 
13515
@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
13516
source for the Binary File Descriptor library
13517
 
13518
@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
13519
@sc{gnu} include files
13520
 
13521
@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
13522
source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
13523
 
13524
@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
13525
source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
13526
 
13527
@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
13528
source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
13529
 
13530
@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/glob
13531
source for the @sc{gnu} filename pattern-matching subroutine
13532
 
13533
@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/mmalloc
13534
source for the @sc{gnu} memory-mapped malloc package
13535
@end table
13536
 
13537
The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @code{configure}
13538
from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
13539
this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
13540
 
13541
First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
13542
if you are not already in it; then run @code{configure}.  Pass the
13543
identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
13544
argument.
13545
 
13546
For example:
13547
 
13548
@example
13549
cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
13550
./configure @var{host}
13551
make
13552
@end example
13553
 
13554
@noindent
13555
where @var{host} is an identifier such as @samp{sun4} or
13556
@samp{decstation}, that identifies the platform where @value{GDBN} will run.
13557
(You can often leave off @var{host}; @code{configure} tries to guess the
13558
correct value by examining your system.)
13559
 
13560
Running @samp{configure @var{host}} and then running @code{make} builds the
13561
@file{bfd}, @file{readline}, @file{mmalloc}, and @file{libiberty}
13562
libraries, then @code{gdb} itself.  The configured source files, and the
13563
binaries, are left in the corresponding source directories.
13564
 
13565
@need 750
13566
@code{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
13567
system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
13568
shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
13569
 
13570
@example
13571
sh configure @var{host}
13572
@end example
13573
 
13574
If you run @code{configure} from a directory that contains source
13575
directories for multiple libraries or programs, such as the
13576
@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} source directory for version @value{GDBVN}, @code{configure}
13577
creates configuration files for every directory level underneath (unless
13578
you tell it not to, with the @samp{--norecursion} option).
13579
 
13580
You can run the @code{configure} script from any of the
13581
subordinate directories in the @value{GDBN} distribution if you only want to
13582
configure that subdirectory, but be sure to specify a path to it.
13583
 
13584
For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, type the following to configure only
13585
the @code{bfd} subdirectory:
13586
 
13587
@example
13588
@group
13589
cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
13590
../configure @var{host}
13591
@end group
13592
@end example
13593
 
13594
You can install @code{@value{GDBP}} anywhere; it has no hardwired paths.
13595
However, you should make sure that the shell on your path (named by
13596
the @samp{SHELL} environment variable) is publicly readable.  Remember
13597
that @value{GDBN} uses the shell to start your program---some systems refuse to
13598
let @value{GDBN} debug child processes whose programs are not readable.
13599
 
13600
@menu
13601
* Separate Objdir::             Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
13602
* Config Names::                Specifying names for hosts and targets
13603
* Configure Options::           Summary of options for configure
13604
@end menu
13605
 
13606
@node Separate Objdir
13607
@section Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
13608
 
13609
If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
13610
you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
13611
host and target.  @code{configure} is designed to make this easy by
13612
allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
13613
rather than in the source directory.  If your @code{make} program
13614
handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
13615
@code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
13616
program specified there.
13617
 
13618
To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @code{configure}
13619
with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
13620
(You also need to specify a path to find @code{configure}
13621
itself from your working directory.  If the path to @code{configure}
13622
would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
13623
the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
13624
 
13625
For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
13626
separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
13627
 
13628
@example
13629
@group
13630
cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
13631
mkdir ../gdb-sun4
13632
cd ../gdb-sun4
13633
../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure sun4
13634
make
13635
@end group
13636
@end example
13637
 
13638
When @code{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
13639
directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
13640
(and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory.  In
13641
the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
13642
directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
13643
@file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
13644
 
13645
One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
13646
directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
13647
@value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
13648
programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
13649
You specify a cross-debugging target by
13650
giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @code{configure}.
13651
 
13652
When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
13653
it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
13654
called @code{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
13655
 
13656
The @code{Makefile} that @code{configure} generates in each source
13657
directory also runs recursively.  If you type @code{make} in a source
13658
directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
13659
directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
13660
will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
13661
 
13662
When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
13663
directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
13664
if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
13665
with each other.
13666
 
13667
@node Config Names
13668
@section Specifying names for hosts and targets
13669
 
13670
The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @code{configure}
13671
script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
13672
aliases are also supported.  The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
13673
of information in the following pattern:
13674
 
13675
@example
13676
@var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
13677
@end example
13678
 
13679
For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
13680
or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
13681
option.  The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
13682
 
13683
The @code{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
13684
any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
13685
aliases.  @code{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
13686
@code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
13687
script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
13688
abbreviations---for example:
13689
 
13690
@smallexample
13691
% sh config.sub i386-linux
13692
i386-pc-linux-gnu
13693
% sh config.sub alpha-linux
13694
alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
13695
% sh config.sub hp9k700
13696
hppa1.1-hp-hpux
13697
% sh config.sub sun4
13698
sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
13699
% sh config.sub sun3
13700
m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
13701
% sh config.sub i986v
13702
Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
13703
@end smallexample
13704
 
13705
@noindent
13706
@code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
13707
directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
13708
 
13709
@node Configure Options
13710
@section @code{configure} options
13711
 
13712
Here is a summary of the @code{configure} options and arguments that
13713
are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}.  @code{configure} also has
13714
several other options not listed here.  @inforef{What Configure
13715
Does,,configure.info}, for a full explanation of @code{configure}.
13716
 
13717
@example
13718
configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
13719
          @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
13720
          @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
13721
          @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
13722
          @r{[}--norecursion@r{]} @r{[}--rm@r{]}
13723
          @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
13724
          @var{host}
13725
@end example
13726
 
13727
@noindent
13728
You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
13729
@samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
13730
@samp{--}.
13731
 
13732
@table @code
13733
@item --help
13734
Display a quick summary of how to invoke @code{configure}.
13735
 
13736
@item --prefix=@var{dir}
13737
Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
13738
@file{@var{dir}}.
13739
 
13740
@item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
13741
Configure the source to install programs under directory
13742
@file{@var{dir}}.
13743
 
13744
@c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
13745
@need 2000
13746
@item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
13747
@strong{Warning: using this option requires @sc{gnu} @code{make}, or another
13748
@code{make} that implements the @code{VPATH} feature.}@*
13749
Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
13750
@value{GDBN} source directories.  Among other things, you can use this to
13751
build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
13752
directories.  @code{configure} writes configuration specific files in
13753
the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
13754
directory @var{dirname}.  @code{configure} creates directories under
13755
the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
13756
@var{dirname}.
13757
 
13758
@item --norecursion
13759
Configure only the directory level where @code{configure} is executed; do not
13760
propagate configuration to subdirectories.
13761
 
13762
@item --target=@var{target}
13763
Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
13764
@var{target}.  Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
13765
programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
13766
 
13767
There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available targets.
13768
 
13769
@item @var{host} @dots{}
13770
Configure @value{GDBN} to run on the specified @var{host}.
13771
 
13772
There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available hosts.
13773
@end table
13774
 
13775
There are many other options available as well, but they are generally
13776
needed for special purposes only.
13777
 
13778
@node Index
13779
@unnumbered Index
13780
 
13781
@printindex cp
13782
 
13783
@tex
13784
% I think something like @colophon should be in texinfo.  In the
13785
% meantime:
13786
\long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
13787
\centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
13788
\centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
13789
\centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
13790
\centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
13791
\centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
13792
\centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
13793
\centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
13794
\centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
13795
\page\colophon
13796
% Blame: doc@cygnus.com, 1991.
13797
@end tex
13798
 
13799
@c TeX can handle the contents at the start but makeinfo 3.12 can not
13800
@ifinfo
13801
@contents
13802
@end ifinfo
13803
@ifhtml
13804
@contents
13805
@end ifhtml
13806
 
13807
@bye

powered by: WebSVN 2.1.0

© copyright 1999-2024 OpenCores.org, equivalent to Oliscience, all rights reserved. OpenCores®, registered trademark.